OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/openrisc_me/openrisc_me/trunk

Subversion Repositories openrisc_me

[/] [openrisc/] [trunk/] [gnu-src/] [binutils-2.18.50/] [gas/] [config/] [tc-ia64.c] - Blame information for rev 455

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 38 julius
/* tc-ia64.c -- Assembler for the HP/Intel IA-64 architecture.
2
   Copyright 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008
3
   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
   Contributed by David Mosberger-Tang <davidm@hpl.hp.com>
5
 
6
   This file is part of GAS, the GNU Assembler.
7
 
8
   GAS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9
   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10
   the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
11
   any later version.
12
 
13
   GAS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14
   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15
   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
16
   GNU General Public License for more details.
17
 
18
   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19
   along with GAS; see the file COPYING.  If not, write to
20
   the Free Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
21
   Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
22
 
23
/*
24
  TODO:
25
 
26
  - optional operands
27
  - directives:
28
        .eb
29
        .estate
30
        .lb
31
        .popsection
32
        .previous
33
        .psr
34
        .pushsection
35
  - labels are wrong if automatic alignment is introduced
36
    (e.g., checkout the second real10 definition in test-data.s)
37
  - DV-related stuff:
38
        <reg>.safe_across_calls and any other DV-related directives I don't
39
          have documentation for.
40
        verify mod-sched-brs reads/writes are checked/marked (and other
41
        notes)
42
 
43
 */
44
 
45
#include "as.h"
46
#include "safe-ctype.h"
47
#include "dwarf2dbg.h"
48
#include "subsegs.h"
49
 
50
#include "opcode/ia64.h"
51
 
52
#include "elf/ia64.h"
53
 
54
#ifdef HAVE_LIMITS_H
55
#include <limits.h>
56
#endif
57
 
58
#define NELEMS(a)       ((int) (sizeof (a)/sizeof ((a)[0])))
59
 
60
/* Some systems define MIN in, e.g., param.h.  */
61
#undef MIN
62
#define MIN(a,b)        ((a) < (b) ? (a) : (b))
63
 
64
#define NUM_SLOTS       4
65
#define PREV_SLOT       md.slot[(md.curr_slot + NUM_SLOTS - 1) % NUM_SLOTS]
66
#define CURR_SLOT       md.slot[md.curr_slot]
67
 
68
#define O_pseudo_fixup (O_max + 1)
69
 
70
enum special_section
71
  {
72
    /* IA-64 ABI section pseudo-ops.  */
73
    SPECIAL_SECTION_BSS = 0,
74
    SPECIAL_SECTION_SBSS,
75
    SPECIAL_SECTION_SDATA,
76
    SPECIAL_SECTION_RODATA,
77
    SPECIAL_SECTION_COMMENT,
78
    SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND,
79
    SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO,
80
    /* HPUX specific section pseudo-ops.  */
81
    SPECIAL_SECTION_INIT_ARRAY,
82
    SPECIAL_SECTION_FINI_ARRAY,
83
  };
84
 
85
enum reloc_func
86
  {
87
    FUNC_DTP_MODULE,
88
    FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE,
89
    FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE,
90
    FUNC_GP_RELATIVE,
91
    FUNC_LT_RELATIVE,
92
    FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X,
93
    FUNC_PC_RELATIVE,
94
    FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE,
95
    FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE,
96
    FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE,
97
    FUNC_TP_RELATIVE,
98
    FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE,
99
    FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE,
100
    FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE,
101
    FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE,
102
    FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE,
103
    FUNC_IPLT_RELOC,
104
  };
105
 
106
enum reg_symbol
107
  {
108
    REG_GR      = 0,
109
    REG_FR      = (REG_GR + 128),
110
    REG_AR      = (REG_FR + 128),
111
    REG_CR      = (REG_AR + 128),
112
    REG_P       = (REG_CR + 128),
113
    REG_BR      = (REG_P  + 64),
114
    REG_IP      = (REG_BR + 8),
115
    REG_CFM,
116
    REG_PR,
117
    REG_PR_ROT,
118
    REG_PSR,
119
    REG_PSR_L,
120
    REG_PSR_UM,
121
    /* The following are pseudo-registers for use by gas only.  */
122
    IND_CPUID,
123
    IND_DBR,
124
    IND_DTR,
125
    IND_ITR,
126
    IND_IBR,
127
    IND_MSR,
128
    IND_PKR,
129
    IND_PMC,
130
    IND_PMD,
131
    IND_RR,
132
    /* The following pseudo-registers are used for unwind directives only:  */
133
    REG_PSP,
134
    REG_PRIUNAT,
135
    REG_NUM
136
  };
137
 
138
enum dynreg_type
139
  {
140
    DYNREG_GR = 0,       /* dynamic general purpose register */
141
    DYNREG_FR,          /* dynamic floating point register */
142
    DYNREG_PR,          /* dynamic predicate register */
143
    DYNREG_NUM_TYPES
144
  };
145
 
146
enum operand_match_result
147
  {
148
    OPERAND_MATCH,
149
    OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE,
150
    OPERAND_MISMATCH
151
  };
152
 
153
/* On the ia64, we can't know the address of a text label until the
154
   instructions are packed into a bundle.  To handle this, we keep
155
   track of the list of labels that appear in front of each
156
   instruction.  */
157
struct label_fix
158
{
159
  struct label_fix *next;
160
  struct symbol *sym;
161
  bfd_boolean dw2_mark_labels;
162
};
163
 
164
/* This is the endianness of the current section.  */
165
extern int target_big_endian;
166
 
167
/* This is the default endianness.  */
168
static int default_big_endian = TARGET_BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN;
169
 
170
void (*ia64_number_to_chars) PARAMS ((char *, valueT, int));
171
 
172
static void ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian
173
  PARAMS ((char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int));
174
static void ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian
175
  PARAMS ((char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int));
176
static void (*ia64_float_to_chars)
177
  PARAMS ((char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int));
178
 
179
static struct hash_control *alias_hash;
180
static struct hash_control *alias_name_hash;
181
static struct hash_control *secalias_hash;
182
static struct hash_control *secalias_name_hash;
183
 
184
/* List of chars besides those in app.c:symbol_chars that can start an
185
   operand.  Used to prevent the scrubber eating vital white-space.  */
186
const char ia64_symbol_chars[] = "@?";
187
 
188
/* Characters which always start a comment.  */
189
const char comment_chars[] = "";
190
 
191
/* Characters which start a comment at the beginning of a line.  */
192
const char line_comment_chars[] = "#";
193
 
194
/* Characters which may be used to separate multiple commands on a
195
   single line.  */
196
const char line_separator_chars[] = ";{}";
197
 
198
/* Characters which are used to indicate an exponent in a floating
199
   point number.  */
200
const char EXP_CHARS[] = "eE";
201
 
202
/* Characters which mean that a number is a floating point constant,
203
   as in 0d1.0.  */
204
const char FLT_CHARS[] = "rRsSfFdDxXpP";
205
 
206
/* ia64-specific option processing:  */
207
 
208
const char *md_shortopts = "m:N:x::";
209
 
210
struct option md_longopts[] =
211
  {
212
#define OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP (OPTION_MD_BASE + 1)
213
    {"mconstant-gp", no_argument, NULL, OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP},
214
#define OPTION_MAUTO_PIC (OPTION_MD_BASE + 2)
215
    {"mauto-pic", no_argument, NULL, OPTION_MAUTO_PIC}
216
  };
217
 
218
size_t md_longopts_size = sizeof (md_longopts);
219
 
220
static struct
221
  {
222
    struct hash_control *pseudo_hash;   /* pseudo opcode hash table */
223
    struct hash_control *reg_hash;      /* register name hash table */
224
    struct hash_control *dynreg_hash;   /* dynamic register hash table */
225
    struct hash_control *const_hash;    /* constant hash table */
226
    struct hash_control *entry_hash;    /* code entry hint hash table */
227
 
228
    /* If X_op is != O_absent, the registername for the instruction's
229
       qualifying predicate.  If NULL, p0 is assumed for instructions
230
       that are predictable.  */
231
    expressionS qp;
232
 
233
    /* Optimize for which CPU.  */
234
    enum
235
      {
236
        itanium1,
237
        itanium2
238
      } tune;
239
 
240
    /* What to do when hint.b is used.  */
241
    enum
242
      {
243
        hint_b_error,
244
        hint_b_warning,
245
        hint_b_ok
246
      } hint_b;
247
 
248
    unsigned int
249
      manual_bundling : 1,
250
      debug_dv: 1,
251
      detect_dv: 1,
252
      explicit_mode : 1,            /* which mode we're in */
253
      default_explicit_mode : 1,    /* which mode is the default */
254
      mode_explicitly_set : 1,      /* was the current mode explicitly set? */
255
      auto_align : 1,
256
      keep_pending_output : 1;
257
 
258
    /* What to do when something is wrong with unwind directives.  */
259
    enum
260
      {
261
        unwind_check_warning,
262
        unwind_check_error
263
      } unwind_check;
264
 
265
    /* Each bundle consists of up to three instructions.  We keep
266
       track of four most recent instructions so we can correctly set
267
       the end_of_insn_group for the last instruction in a bundle.  */
268
    int curr_slot;
269
    int num_slots_in_use;
270
    struct slot
271
      {
272
        unsigned int
273
          end_of_insn_group : 1,
274
          manual_bundling_on : 1,
275
          manual_bundling_off : 1,
276
          loc_directive_seen : 1;
277
        signed char user_template;      /* user-selected template, if any */
278
        unsigned char qp_regno;         /* qualifying predicate */
279
        /* This duplicates a good fraction of "struct fix" but we
280
           can't use a "struct fix" instead since we can't call
281
           fix_new_exp() until we know the address of the instruction.  */
282
        int num_fixups;
283
        struct insn_fix
284
          {
285
            bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
286
            enum ia64_opnd opnd;        /* type of operand in need of fix */
287
            unsigned int is_pcrel : 1;  /* is operand pc-relative? */
288
            expressionS expr;           /* the value to be inserted */
289
          }
290
        fixup[2];                       /* at most two fixups per insn */
291
        struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
292
        struct label_fix *label_fixups;
293
        struct label_fix *tag_fixups;
294
        struct unw_rec_list *unwind_record;     /* Unwind directive.  */
295
        expressionS opnd[6];
296
        char *src_file;
297
        unsigned int src_line;
298
        struct dwarf2_line_info debug_line;
299
      }
300
    slot[NUM_SLOTS];
301
 
302
    segT last_text_seg;
303
 
304
    struct dynreg
305
      {
306
        struct dynreg *next;            /* next dynamic register */
307
        const char *name;
308
        unsigned short base;            /* the base register number */
309
        unsigned short num_regs;        /* # of registers in this set */
310
      }
311
    *dynreg[DYNREG_NUM_TYPES], in, loc, out, rot;
312
 
313
    flagword flags;                     /* ELF-header flags */
314
 
315
    struct mem_offset {
316
      unsigned hint:1;              /* is this hint currently valid? */
317
      bfd_vma offset;               /* mem.offset offset */
318
      bfd_vma base;                 /* mem.offset base */
319
    } mem_offset;
320
 
321
    int path;                       /* number of alt. entry points seen */
322
    const char **entry_labels;      /* labels of all alternate paths in
323
                                       the current DV-checking block.  */
324
    int maxpaths;                   /* size currently allocated for
325
                                       entry_labels */
326
 
327
    int pointer_size;       /* size in bytes of a pointer */
328
    int pointer_size_shift; /* shift size of a pointer for alignment */
329
 
330
    symbolS *indregsym[IND_RR - IND_CPUID + 1];
331
  }
332
md;
333
 
334
/* These are not const, because they are modified to MMI for non-itanium1
335
   targets below.  */
336
/* MFI bundle of nops.  */
337
static unsigned char le_nop[16] =
338
{
339
  0x0c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,
340
  0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x04, 0x00
341
};
342
/* MFI bundle of nops with stop-bit.  */
343
static unsigned char le_nop_stop[16] =
344
{
345
  0x0d, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,
346
  0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x04, 0x00
347
};
348
 
349
/* application registers:  */
350
 
351
#define AR_K0           0
352
#define AR_K7           7
353
#define AR_RSC          16
354
#define AR_BSP          17
355
#define AR_BSPSTORE     18
356
#define AR_RNAT         19
357
#define AR_FCR          21
358
#define AR_EFLAG        24
359
#define AR_CSD          25
360
#define AR_SSD          26
361
#define AR_CFLG         27
362
#define AR_FSR          28
363
#define AR_FIR          29
364
#define AR_FDR          30
365
#define AR_CCV          32
366
#define AR_UNAT         36
367
#define AR_FPSR         40
368
#define AR_ITC          44
369
#define AR_RUC          45
370
#define AR_PFS          64
371
#define AR_LC           65
372
#define AR_EC           66
373
 
374
static const struct
375
  {
376
    const char *name;
377
    unsigned int regnum;
378
  }
379
ar[] =
380
  {
381
    {"ar.k0",           AR_K0},         {"ar.k1",       AR_K0 + 1},
382
    {"ar.k2",           AR_K0 + 2},     {"ar.k3",       AR_K0 + 3},
383
    {"ar.k4",           AR_K0 + 4},     {"ar.k5",       AR_K0 + 5},
384
    {"ar.k6",           AR_K0 + 6},     {"ar.k7",       AR_K7},
385
    {"ar.rsc",          AR_RSC},        {"ar.bsp",      AR_BSP},
386
    {"ar.bspstore",     AR_BSPSTORE},   {"ar.rnat",     AR_RNAT},
387
    {"ar.fcr",          AR_FCR},        {"ar.eflag",    AR_EFLAG},
388
    {"ar.csd",          AR_CSD},        {"ar.ssd",      AR_SSD},
389
    {"ar.cflg",         AR_CFLG},       {"ar.fsr",      AR_FSR},
390
    {"ar.fir",          AR_FIR},        {"ar.fdr",      AR_FDR},
391
    {"ar.ccv",          AR_CCV},        {"ar.unat",     AR_UNAT},
392
    {"ar.fpsr",         AR_FPSR},       {"ar.itc",      AR_ITC},
393
    {"ar.ruc",          AR_RUC},        {"ar.pfs",      AR_PFS},
394
    {"ar.lc",           AR_LC},         {"ar.ec",       AR_EC},
395
  };
396
 
397
/* control registers:  */
398
 
399
#define CR_DCR           0
400
#define CR_ITM           1
401
#define CR_IVA           2
402
#define CR_PTA           8
403
#define CR_GPTA          9
404
#define CR_IPSR         16
405
#define CR_ISR          17
406
#define CR_IIP          19
407
#define CR_IFA          20
408
#define CR_ITIR         21
409
#define CR_IIPA         22
410
#define CR_IFS          23
411
#define CR_IIM          24
412
#define CR_IHA          25
413
#define CR_LID          64
414
#define CR_IVR          65
415
#define CR_TPR          66
416
#define CR_EOI          67
417
#define CR_IRR0         68
418
#define CR_IRR3         71
419
#define CR_ITV          72
420
#define CR_PMV          73
421
#define CR_CMCV         74
422
#define CR_LRR0         80
423
#define CR_LRR1         81
424
 
425
static const struct
426
  {
427
    const char *name;
428
    unsigned int regnum;
429
  }
430
cr[] =
431
  {
432
    {"cr.dcr",  CR_DCR},
433
    {"cr.itm",  CR_ITM},
434
    {"cr.iva",  CR_IVA},
435
    {"cr.pta",  CR_PTA},
436
    {"cr.gpta", CR_GPTA},
437
    {"cr.ipsr", CR_IPSR},
438
    {"cr.isr",  CR_ISR},
439
    {"cr.iip",  CR_IIP},
440
    {"cr.ifa",  CR_IFA},
441
    {"cr.itir", CR_ITIR},
442
    {"cr.iipa", CR_IIPA},
443
    {"cr.ifs",  CR_IFS},
444
    {"cr.iim",  CR_IIM},
445
    {"cr.iha",  CR_IHA},
446
    {"cr.lid",  CR_LID},
447
    {"cr.ivr",  CR_IVR},
448
    {"cr.tpr",  CR_TPR},
449
    {"cr.eoi",  CR_EOI},
450
    {"cr.irr0", CR_IRR0},
451
    {"cr.irr1", CR_IRR0 + 1},
452
    {"cr.irr2", CR_IRR0 + 2},
453
    {"cr.irr3", CR_IRR3},
454
    {"cr.itv",  CR_ITV},
455
    {"cr.pmv",  CR_PMV},
456
    {"cr.cmcv", CR_CMCV},
457
    {"cr.lrr0", CR_LRR0},
458
    {"cr.lrr1", CR_LRR1}
459
  };
460
 
461
#define PSR_MFL         4
462
#define PSR_IC          13
463
#define PSR_DFL         18
464
#define PSR_CPL         32
465
 
466
static const struct const_desc
467
  {
468
    const char *name;
469
    valueT value;
470
  }
471
const_bits[] =
472
  {
473
    /* PSR constant masks:  */
474
 
475
    /* 0: reserved */
476
    {"psr.be",  ((valueT) 1) << 1},
477
    {"psr.up",  ((valueT) 1) << 2},
478
    {"psr.ac",  ((valueT) 1) << 3},
479
    {"psr.mfl", ((valueT) 1) << 4},
480
    {"psr.mfh", ((valueT) 1) << 5},
481
    /* 6-12: reserved */
482
    {"psr.ic",  ((valueT) 1) << 13},
483
    {"psr.i",   ((valueT) 1) << 14},
484
    {"psr.pk",  ((valueT) 1) << 15},
485
    /* 16: reserved */
486
    {"psr.dt",  ((valueT) 1) << 17},
487
    {"psr.dfl", ((valueT) 1) << 18},
488
    {"psr.dfh", ((valueT) 1) << 19},
489
    {"psr.sp",  ((valueT) 1) << 20},
490
    {"psr.pp",  ((valueT) 1) << 21},
491
    {"psr.di",  ((valueT) 1) << 22},
492
    {"psr.si",  ((valueT) 1) << 23},
493
    {"psr.db",  ((valueT) 1) << 24},
494
    {"psr.lp",  ((valueT) 1) << 25},
495
    {"psr.tb",  ((valueT) 1) << 26},
496
    {"psr.rt",  ((valueT) 1) << 27},
497
    /* 28-31: reserved */
498
    /* 32-33: cpl (current privilege level) */
499
    {"psr.is",  ((valueT) 1) << 34},
500
    {"psr.mc",  ((valueT) 1) << 35},
501
    {"psr.it",  ((valueT) 1) << 36},
502
    {"psr.id",  ((valueT) 1) << 37},
503
    {"psr.da",  ((valueT) 1) << 38},
504
    {"psr.dd",  ((valueT) 1) << 39},
505
    {"psr.ss",  ((valueT) 1) << 40},
506
    /* 41-42: ri (restart instruction) */
507
    {"psr.ed",  ((valueT) 1) << 43},
508
    {"psr.bn",  ((valueT) 1) << 44},
509
  };
510
 
511
/* indirect register-sets/memory:  */
512
 
513
static const struct
514
  {
515
    const char *name;
516
    unsigned int regnum;
517
  }
518
indirect_reg[] =
519
  {
520
    { "CPUID",  IND_CPUID },
521
    { "cpuid",  IND_CPUID },
522
    { "dbr",    IND_DBR },
523
    { "dtr",    IND_DTR },
524
    { "itr",    IND_ITR },
525
    { "ibr",    IND_IBR },
526
    { "msr",    IND_MSR },
527
    { "pkr",    IND_PKR },
528
    { "pmc",    IND_PMC },
529
    { "pmd",    IND_PMD },
530
    { "rr",     IND_RR },
531
  };
532
 
533
/* Pseudo functions used to indicate relocation types (these functions
534
   start with an at sign (@).  */
535
static struct
536
  {
537
    const char *name;
538
    enum pseudo_type
539
      {
540
        PSEUDO_FUNC_NONE,
541
        PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC,
542
        PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,
543
        PSEUDO_FUNC_REG,
544
        PSEUDO_FUNC_FLOAT
545
      }
546
    type;
547
    union
548
      {
549
        unsigned long ival;
550
        symbolS *sym;
551
      }
552
    u;
553
  }
554
pseudo_func[] =
555
  {
556
    /* reloc pseudo functions (these must come first!):  */
557
    { "dtpmod", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
558
    { "dtprel", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
559
    { "fptr",   PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
560
    { "gprel",  PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
561
    { "ltoff",  PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
562
    { "ltoffx", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
563
    { "pcrel",  PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
564
    { "pltoff", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
565
    { "secrel", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
566
    { "segrel", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
567
    { "tprel",  PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
568
    { "ltv",    PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
569
    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },   /* placeholder for FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE */
570
    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },   /* placeholder for FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE */
571
    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },   /* placeholder for FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE */
572
    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },   /* placeholder for FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE */
573
    { "iplt",   PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
574
 
575
    /* mbtype4 constants:  */
576
    { "alt",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0xa } },
577
    { "brcst",  PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x0 } },
578
    { "mix",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x8 } },
579
    { "rev",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0xb } },
580
    { "shuf",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x9 } },
581
 
582
    /* fclass constants:  */
583
    { "nat",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x100 } },
584
    { "qnan",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x080 } },
585
    { "snan",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x040 } },
586
    { "pos",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x001 } },
587
    { "neg",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x002 } },
588
    { "zero",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x004 } },
589
    { "unorm",  PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x008 } },
590
    { "norm",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x010 } },
591
    { "inf",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x020 } },
592
 
593
    { "natval", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x100 } }, /* old usage */
594
 
595
    /* hint constants: */
596
    { "pause",  PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x0 } },
597
 
598
    /* unwind-related constants:  */
599
    { "svr4",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { ELFOSABI_NONE } },
600
    { "hpux",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { ELFOSABI_HPUX } },
601
    { "nt",     PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { 2 } },                /* conflicts w/ELFOSABI_NETBSD */
602
    { "linux",  PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { ELFOSABI_LINUX } },
603
    { "freebsd", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,     { ELFOSABI_FREEBSD } },
604
    { "openvms", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,     { ELFOSABI_OPENVMS } },
605
    { "nsk",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { ELFOSABI_NSK } },
606
 
607
    /* unwind-related registers:  */
608
    { "priunat",PSEUDO_FUNC_REG, { REG_PRIUNAT } }
609
  };
610
 
611
/* 41-bit nop opcodes (one per unit):  */
612
static const bfd_vma nop[IA64_NUM_UNITS] =
613
  {
614
    0x0000000000LL,     /* NIL => break 0 */
615
    0x0008000000LL,     /* I-unit nop */
616
    0x0008000000LL,     /* M-unit nop */
617
    0x4000000000LL,     /* B-unit nop */
618
    0x0008000000LL,     /* F-unit nop */
619
    0x0000000000LL,     /* L-"unit" nop immediate */
620
    0x0008000000LL,     /* X-unit nop */
621
  };
622
 
623
/* Can't be `const' as it's passed to input routines (which have the
624
   habit of setting temporary sentinels.  */
625
static char special_section_name[][20] =
626
  {
627
    {".bss"}, {".sbss"}, {".sdata"}, {".rodata"}, {".comment"},
628
    {".IA_64.unwind"}, {".IA_64.unwind_info"},
629
    {".init_array"}, {".fini_array"}
630
  };
631
 
632
/* The best template for a particular sequence of up to three
633
   instructions:  */
634
#define N       IA64_NUM_TYPES
635
static unsigned char best_template[N][N][N];
636
#undef N
637
 
638
/* Resource dependencies currently in effect */
639
static struct rsrc {
640
  int depind;                       /* dependency index */
641
  const struct ia64_dependency *dependency; /* actual dependency */
642
  unsigned specific:1,              /* is this a specific bit/regno? */
643
    link_to_qp_branch:1;           /* will a branch on the same QP clear it?*/
644
  int index;                        /* specific regno/bit within dependency */
645
  int note;                         /* optional qualifying note (0 if none) */
646
#define STATE_NONE 0
647
#define STATE_STOP 1
648
#define STATE_SRLZ 2
649
  int insn_srlz;                    /* current insn serialization state */
650
  int data_srlz;                    /* current data serialization state */
651
  int qp_regno;                     /* qualifying predicate for this usage */
652
  char *file;                       /* what file marked this dependency */
653
  unsigned int line;                /* what line marked this dependency */
654
  struct mem_offset mem_offset;     /* optional memory offset hint */
655
  enum { CMP_NONE, CMP_OR, CMP_AND } cmp_type; /* OR or AND compare? */
656
  int path;                         /* corresponding code entry index */
657
} *regdeps = NULL;
658
static int regdepslen = 0;
659
static int regdepstotlen = 0;
660
static const char *dv_mode[] = { "RAW", "WAW", "WAR" };
661
static const char *dv_sem[] = { "none", "implied", "impliedf",
662
                                "data", "instr", "specific", "stop", "other" };
663
static const char *dv_cmp_type[] = { "none", "OR", "AND" };
664
 
665
/* Current state of PR mutexation */
666
static struct qpmutex {
667
  valueT prmask;
668
  int path;
669
} *qp_mutexes = NULL;          /* QP mutex bitmasks */
670
static int qp_mutexeslen = 0;
671
static int qp_mutexestotlen = 0;
672
static valueT qp_safe_across_calls = 0;
673
 
674
/* Current state of PR implications */
675
static struct qp_imply {
676
  unsigned p1:6;
677
  unsigned p2:6;
678
  unsigned p2_branched:1;
679
  int path;
680
} *qp_implies = NULL;
681
static int qp_implieslen = 0;
682
static int qp_impliestotlen = 0;
683
 
684
/* Keep track of static GR values so that indirect register usage can
685
   sometimes be tracked.  */
686
static struct gr {
687
  unsigned known:1;
688
  int path;
689
  valueT value;
690
} gr_values[128] = {
691
  {
692
    1,
693
#ifdef INT_MAX
694
    INT_MAX,
695
#else
696
    (((1 << (8 * sizeof(gr_values->path) - 2)) - 1) << 1) + 1,
697
#endif
698
 
699
  }
700
};
701
 
702
/* Remember the alignment frag.  */
703
static fragS *align_frag;
704
 
705
/* These are the routines required to output the various types of
706
   unwind records.  */
707
 
708
/* A slot_number is a frag address plus the slot index (0-2).  We use the
709
   frag address here so that if there is a section switch in the middle of
710
   a function, then instructions emitted to a different section are not
711
   counted.  Since there may be more than one frag for a function, this
712
   means we also need to keep track of which frag this address belongs to
713
   so we can compute inter-frag distances.  This also nicely solves the
714
   problem with nops emitted for align directives, which can't easily be
715
   counted, but can easily be derived from frag sizes.  */
716
 
717
typedef struct unw_rec_list {
718
  unwind_record r;
719
  unsigned long slot_number;
720
  fragS *slot_frag;
721
  struct unw_rec_list *next;
722
} unw_rec_list;
723
 
724
#define SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET        (unsigned)-1
725
 
726
/* Linked list of saved prologue counts.  A very poor
727
   implementation of a map from label numbers to prologue counts.  */
728
typedef struct label_prologue_count
729
{
730
  struct label_prologue_count *next;
731
  unsigned long label_number;
732
  unsigned int prologue_count;
733
} label_prologue_count;
734
 
735
typedef struct proc_pending
736
{
737
  symbolS *sym;
738
  struct proc_pending *next;
739
} proc_pending;
740
 
741
static struct
742
{
743
  /* Maintain a list of unwind entries for the current function.  */
744
  unw_rec_list *list;
745
  unw_rec_list *tail;
746
 
747
  /* Any unwind entries that should be attached to the current slot
748
     that an insn is being constructed for.  */
749
  unw_rec_list *current_entry;
750
 
751
  /* These are used to create the unwind table entry for this function.  */
752
  proc_pending proc_pending;
753
  symbolS *info;                /* pointer to unwind info */
754
  symbolS *personality_routine;
755
  segT saved_text_seg;
756
  subsegT saved_text_subseg;
757
  unsigned int force_unwind_entry : 1;  /* force generation of unwind entry? */
758
 
759
  /* TRUE if processing unwind directives in a prologue region.  */
760
  unsigned int prologue : 1;
761
  unsigned int prologue_mask : 4;
762
  unsigned int prologue_gr : 7;
763
  unsigned int body : 1;
764
  unsigned int insn : 1;
765
  unsigned int prologue_count;  /* number of .prologues seen so far */
766
  /* Prologue counts at previous .label_state directives.  */
767
  struct label_prologue_count * saved_prologue_counts;
768
 
769
  /* List of split up .save-s.  */
770
  unw_p_record *pending_saves;
771
} unwind;
772
 
773
/* The input value is a negated offset from psp, and specifies an address
774
   psp - offset.  The encoded value is psp + 16 - (4 * offset).  Thus we
775
   must add 16 and divide by 4 to get the encoded value.  */
776
 
777
#define ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET(OFFSET) (((OFFSET) + 16) / 4)
778
 
779
typedef void (*vbyte_func) PARAMS ((int, char *, char *));
780
 
781
/* Forward declarations:  */
782
static void set_section PARAMS ((char *name));
783
static unsigned int set_regstack PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int,
784
                                          unsigned int, unsigned int));
785
static void dot_align (int);
786
static void dot_radix PARAMS ((int));
787
static void dot_special_section PARAMS ((int));
788
static void dot_proc PARAMS ((int));
789
static void dot_fframe PARAMS ((int));
790
static void dot_vframe PARAMS ((int));
791
static void dot_vframesp PARAMS ((int));
792
static void dot_save PARAMS ((int));
793
static void dot_restore PARAMS ((int));
794
static void dot_restorereg PARAMS ((int));
795
static void dot_handlerdata  PARAMS ((int));
796
static void dot_unwentry PARAMS ((int));
797
static void dot_altrp PARAMS ((int));
798
static void dot_savemem PARAMS ((int));
799
static void dot_saveg PARAMS ((int));
800
static void dot_savef PARAMS ((int));
801
static void dot_saveb PARAMS ((int));
802
static void dot_savegf PARAMS ((int));
803
static void dot_spill PARAMS ((int));
804
static void dot_spillreg PARAMS ((int));
805
static void dot_spillmem PARAMS ((int));
806
static void dot_label_state PARAMS ((int));
807
static void dot_copy_state PARAMS ((int));
808
static void dot_unwabi PARAMS ((int));
809
static void dot_personality PARAMS ((int));
810
static void dot_body PARAMS ((int));
811
static void dot_prologue PARAMS ((int));
812
static void dot_endp PARAMS ((int));
813
static void dot_template PARAMS ((int));
814
static void dot_regstk PARAMS ((int));
815
static void dot_rot PARAMS ((int));
816
static void dot_byteorder PARAMS ((int));
817
static void dot_psr PARAMS ((int));
818
static void dot_alias PARAMS ((int));
819
static void dot_ln PARAMS ((int));
820
static void cross_section PARAMS ((int ref, void (*cons) PARAMS((int)), int ua));
821
static void dot_xdata PARAMS ((int));
822
static void stmt_float_cons PARAMS ((int));
823
static void stmt_cons_ua PARAMS ((int));
824
static void dot_xfloat_cons PARAMS ((int));
825
static void dot_xstringer PARAMS ((int));
826
static void dot_xdata_ua PARAMS ((int));
827
static void dot_xfloat_cons_ua PARAMS ((int));
828
static void print_prmask PARAMS ((valueT mask));
829
static void dot_pred_rel PARAMS ((int));
830
static void dot_reg_val PARAMS ((int));
831
static void dot_serialize PARAMS ((int));
832
static void dot_dv_mode PARAMS ((int));
833
static void dot_entry PARAMS ((int));
834
static void dot_mem_offset PARAMS ((int));
835
static void add_unwind_entry PARAMS((unw_rec_list *, int));
836
static symbolS *declare_register PARAMS ((const char *name, unsigned int regnum));
837
static void declare_register_set PARAMS ((const char *, unsigned int, unsigned int));
838
static unsigned int operand_width PARAMS ((enum ia64_opnd));
839
static enum operand_match_result operand_match PARAMS ((const struct ia64_opcode *idesc,
840
                                                        int index,
841
                                                        expressionS *e));
842
static int parse_operand PARAMS ((expressionS *, int));
843
static struct ia64_opcode * parse_operands PARAMS ((struct ia64_opcode *));
844
static void build_insn PARAMS ((struct slot *, bfd_vma *));
845
static void emit_one_bundle PARAMS ((void));
846
static void fix_insn PARAMS ((fixS *, const struct ia64_operand *, valueT));
847
static bfd_reloc_code_real_type ia64_gen_real_reloc_type PARAMS ((struct symbol *sym,
848
                                                                  bfd_reloc_code_real_type r_type));
849
static void insn_group_break PARAMS ((int, int, int));
850
static void mark_resource PARAMS ((struct ia64_opcode *, const struct ia64_dependency *,
851
                                   struct rsrc *, int depind, int path));
852
static void add_qp_mutex PARAMS((valueT mask));
853
static void add_qp_imply PARAMS((int p1, int p2));
854
static void clear_qp_branch_flag PARAMS((valueT mask));
855
static void clear_qp_mutex PARAMS((valueT mask));
856
static void clear_qp_implies PARAMS((valueT p1_mask, valueT p2_mask));
857
static int has_suffix_p PARAMS((const char *, const char *));
858
static void clear_register_values PARAMS ((void));
859
static void print_dependency PARAMS ((const char *action, int depind));
860
static void instruction_serialization PARAMS ((void));
861
static void data_serialization PARAMS ((void));
862
static void remove_marked_resource PARAMS ((struct rsrc *));
863
static int is_conditional_branch PARAMS ((struct ia64_opcode *));
864
static int is_taken_branch PARAMS ((struct ia64_opcode *));
865
static int is_interruption_or_rfi PARAMS ((struct ia64_opcode *));
866
static int depends_on PARAMS ((int, struct ia64_opcode *));
867
static int specify_resource PARAMS ((const struct ia64_dependency *,
868
                                     struct ia64_opcode *, int, struct rsrc [], int, int));
869
static int check_dv PARAMS((struct ia64_opcode *idesc));
870
static void check_dependencies PARAMS((struct ia64_opcode *));
871
static void mark_resources PARAMS((struct ia64_opcode *));
872
static void update_dependencies PARAMS((struct ia64_opcode *));
873
static void note_register_values PARAMS((struct ia64_opcode *));
874
static int qp_mutex PARAMS ((int, int, int));
875
static int resources_match PARAMS ((struct rsrc *, struct ia64_opcode *, int, int, int));
876
static void output_vbyte_mem PARAMS ((int, char *, char *));
877
static void count_output PARAMS ((int, char *, char *));
878
static void output_R1_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, int));
879
static void output_R2_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, int, int, unsigned long));
880
static void output_R3_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long));
881
static void output_P1_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, int));
882
static void output_P2_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, int, int));
883
static void output_P3_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, int));
884
static void output_P4_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unsigned char *, unsigned long));
885
static void output_P5_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, int, unsigned long));
886
static void output_P6_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, int));
887
static void output_P7_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long, unsigned long));
888
static void output_P8_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long));
889
static void output_P9_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, int, int));
890
static void output_P10_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, int, int));
891
static void output_B1_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long));
892
static void output_B2_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unsigned long, unsigned long));
893
static void output_B3_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unsigned long, unsigned long));
894
static void output_B4_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long));
895
static char format_ab_reg PARAMS ((int, int));
896
static void output_X1_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, int, int, unsigned long,
897
                                      unsigned long));
898
static void output_X2_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, int, int, int, int, int, unsigned long));
899
static void output_X3_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, unw_record_type, int, int, int, unsigned long,
900
                                      unsigned long));
901
static void output_X4_format PARAMS ((vbyte_func, int, int, int, int, int, int, unsigned long));
902
static unw_rec_list *output_endp PARAMS ((void));
903
static unw_rec_list *output_prologue PARAMS ((void));
904
static unw_rec_list *output_prologue_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int));
905
static unw_rec_list *output_body PARAMS ((void));
906
static unw_rec_list *output_mem_stack_f PARAMS ((unsigned int));
907
static unw_rec_list *output_mem_stack_v PARAMS ((void));
908
static unw_rec_list *output_psp_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
909
static unw_rec_list *output_psp_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
910
static unw_rec_list *output_rp_when PARAMS ((void));
911
static unw_rec_list *output_rp_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
912
static unw_rec_list *output_rp_br PARAMS ((unsigned int));
913
static unw_rec_list *output_rp_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
914
static unw_rec_list *output_rp_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
915
static unw_rec_list *output_pfs_when PARAMS ((void));
916
static unw_rec_list *output_pfs_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
917
static unw_rec_list *output_pfs_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
918
static unw_rec_list *output_pfs_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
919
static unw_rec_list *output_preds_when PARAMS ((void));
920
static unw_rec_list *output_preds_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
921
static unw_rec_list *output_preds_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
922
static unw_rec_list *output_preds_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
923
static unw_rec_list *output_fr_mem PARAMS ((unsigned int));
924
static unw_rec_list *output_frgr_mem PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int));
925
static unw_rec_list *output_gr_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int));
926
static unw_rec_list *output_gr_mem PARAMS ((unsigned int));
927
static unw_rec_list *output_br_mem PARAMS ((unsigned int));
928
static unw_rec_list *output_br_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int));
929
static unw_rec_list *output_spill_base PARAMS ((unsigned int));
930
static unw_rec_list *output_unat_when PARAMS ((void));
931
static unw_rec_list *output_unat_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
932
static unw_rec_list *output_unat_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
933
static unw_rec_list *output_unat_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
934
static unw_rec_list *output_lc_when PARAMS ((void));
935
static unw_rec_list *output_lc_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
936
static unw_rec_list *output_lc_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
937
static unw_rec_list *output_lc_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
938
static unw_rec_list *output_fpsr_when PARAMS ((void));
939
static unw_rec_list *output_fpsr_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
940
static unw_rec_list *output_fpsr_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
941
static unw_rec_list *output_fpsr_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
942
static unw_rec_list *output_priunat_when_gr PARAMS ((void));
943
static unw_rec_list *output_priunat_when_mem PARAMS ((void));
944
static unw_rec_list *output_priunat_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
945
static unw_rec_list *output_priunat_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
946
static unw_rec_list *output_priunat_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
947
static unw_rec_list *output_bsp_when PARAMS ((void));
948
static unw_rec_list *output_bsp_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
949
static unw_rec_list *output_bsp_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
950
static unw_rec_list *output_bsp_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
951
static unw_rec_list *output_bspstore_when PARAMS ((void));
952
static unw_rec_list *output_bspstore_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
953
static unw_rec_list *output_bspstore_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
954
static unw_rec_list *output_bspstore_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
955
static unw_rec_list *output_rnat_when PARAMS ((void));
956
static unw_rec_list *output_rnat_gr PARAMS ((unsigned int));
957
static unw_rec_list *output_rnat_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
958
static unw_rec_list *output_rnat_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int));
959
static unw_rec_list *output_unwabi PARAMS ((unsigned long, unsigned long));
960
static unw_rec_list *output_epilogue PARAMS ((unsigned long));
961
static unw_rec_list *output_label_state PARAMS ((unsigned long));
962
static unw_rec_list *output_copy_state PARAMS ((unsigned long));
963
static unw_rec_list *output_spill_psprel PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int, unsigned int,
964
                                                    unsigned int));
965
static unw_rec_list *output_spill_sprel PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int, unsigned int,
966
                                                   unsigned int));
967
static unw_rec_list *output_spill_reg PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int, unsigned int,
968
                                                 unsigned int, unsigned int));
969
static void process_one_record PARAMS ((unw_rec_list *, vbyte_func));
970
static void process_unw_records PARAMS ((unw_rec_list *, vbyte_func));
971
static int calc_record_size PARAMS ((unw_rec_list *));
972
static void set_imask PARAMS ((unw_rec_list *, unsigned long, unsigned long, unsigned int));
973
static unsigned long slot_index PARAMS ((unsigned long, fragS *,
974
                                         unsigned long, fragS *,
975
                                         int));
976
static unw_rec_list *optimize_unw_records PARAMS ((unw_rec_list *));
977
static void fixup_unw_records PARAMS ((unw_rec_list *, int));
978
static int parse_predicate_and_operand PARAMS ((expressionS *, unsigned *, const char *));
979
static void convert_expr_to_ab_reg PARAMS ((const expressionS *, unsigned int *, unsigned int *, const char *, int));
980
static void convert_expr_to_xy_reg PARAMS ((const expressionS *, unsigned int *, unsigned int *, const char *, int));
981
static unsigned int get_saved_prologue_count PARAMS ((unsigned long));
982
static void save_prologue_count PARAMS ((unsigned long, unsigned int));
983
static void free_saved_prologue_counts PARAMS ((void));
984
 
985
/* Determine if application register REGNUM resides only in the integer
986
   unit (as opposed to the memory unit).  */
987
static int
988
ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (int reg)
989
{
990
  reg -= REG_AR;
991
  return reg >= 64 && reg <= 111;
992
}
993
 
994
/* Determine if application register REGNUM resides only in the memory
995
   unit (as opposed to the integer unit).  */
996
static int
997
ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (int reg)
998
{
999
  reg -= REG_AR;
1000
  return reg >= 0 && reg <= 47;
1001
}
1002
 
1003
/* Switch to section NAME and create section if necessary.  It's
1004
   rather ugly that we have to manipulate input_line_pointer but I
1005
   don't see any other way to accomplish the same thing without
1006
   changing obj-elf.c (which may be the Right Thing, in the end).  */
1007
static void
1008
set_section (name)
1009
     char *name;
1010
{
1011
  char *saved_input_line_pointer;
1012
 
1013
  saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
1014
  input_line_pointer = name;
1015
  obj_elf_section (0);
1016
  input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
1017
}
1018
 
1019
/* Map 's' to SHF_IA_64_SHORT.  */
1020
 
1021
int
1022
ia64_elf_section_letter (letter, ptr_msg)
1023
     int letter;
1024
     char **ptr_msg;
1025
{
1026
  if (letter == 's')
1027
    return SHF_IA_64_SHORT;
1028
  else if (letter == 'o')
1029
    return SHF_LINK_ORDER;
1030
 
1031
  *ptr_msg = _("Bad .section directive: want a,o,s,w,x,M,S,G,T in string");
1032
  return -1;
1033
}
1034
 
1035
/* Map SHF_IA_64_SHORT to SEC_SMALL_DATA.  */
1036
 
1037
flagword
1038
ia64_elf_section_flags (flags, attr, type)
1039
     flagword flags;
1040
     int attr, type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
1041
{
1042
  if (attr & SHF_IA_64_SHORT)
1043
    flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
1044
  return flags;
1045
}
1046
 
1047
int
1048
ia64_elf_section_type (str, len)
1049
     const char *str;
1050
     size_t len;
1051
{
1052
#define STREQ(s) ((len == sizeof (s) - 1) && (strncmp (str, s, sizeof (s) - 1) == 0))
1053
 
1054
  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_info))
1055
    return SHT_PROGBITS;
1056
 
1057
  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_info_once))
1058
    return SHT_PROGBITS;
1059
 
1060
  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind))
1061
    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
1062
 
1063
  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_once))
1064
    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
1065
 
1066
  if (STREQ ("unwind"))
1067
    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
1068
 
1069
  return -1;
1070
#undef STREQ
1071
}
1072
 
1073
static unsigned int
1074
set_regstack (ins, locs, outs, rots)
1075
     unsigned int ins, locs, outs, rots;
1076
{
1077
  /* Size of frame.  */
1078
  unsigned int sof;
1079
 
1080
  sof = ins + locs + outs;
1081
  if (sof > 96)
1082
    {
1083
      as_bad (_("Size of frame exceeds maximum of 96 registers"));
1084
      return 0;
1085
    }
1086
  if (rots > sof)
1087
    {
1088
      as_warn (_("Size of rotating registers exceeds frame size"));
1089
      return 0;
1090
    }
1091
  md.in.base = REG_GR + 32;
1092
  md.loc.base = md.in.base + ins;
1093
  md.out.base = md.loc.base + locs;
1094
 
1095
  md.in.num_regs  = ins;
1096
  md.loc.num_regs = locs;
1097
  md.out.num_regs = outs;
1098
  md.rot.num_regs = rots;
1099
  return sof;
1100
}
1101
 
1102
void
1103
ia64_flush_insns ()
1104
{
1105
  struct label_fix *lfix;
1106
  segT saved_seg;
1107
  subsegT saved_subseg;
1108
  unw_rec_list *ptr;
1109
  bfd_boolean mark;
1110
 
1111
  if (!md.last_text_seg)
1112
    return;
1113
 
1114
  saved_seg = now_seg;
1115
  saved_subseg = now_subseg;
1116
 
1117
  subseg_set (md.last_text_seg, 0);
1118
 
1119
  while (md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
1120
    emit_one_bundle ();         /* force out queued instructions */
1121
 
1122
  /* In case there are labels following the last instruction, resolve
1123
     those now.  */
1124
  mark = FALSE;
1125
  for (lfix = CURR_SLOT.label_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
1126
    {
1127
      symbol_set_value_now (lfix->sym);
1128
      mark |= lfix->dw2_mark_labels;
1129
    }
1130
  if (mark)
1131
    {
1132
      dwarf2_where (&CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
1133
      CURR_SLOT.debug_line.flags |= DWARF2_FLAG_BASIC_BLOCK;
1134
      dwarf2_gen_line_info (frag_now_fix (), &CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
1135
      dwarf2_consume_line_info ();
1136
    }
1137
  CURR_SLOT.label_fixups = 0;
1138
 
1139
  for (lfix = CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
1140
    symbol_set_value_now (lfix->sym);
1141
  CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups = 0;
1142
 
1143
  /* In case there are unwind directives following the last instruction,
1144
     resolve those now.  We only handle prologue, body, and endp directives
1145
     here.  Give an error for others.  */
1146
  for (ptr = unwind.current_entry; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
1147
    {
1148
      switch (ptr->r.type)
1149
        {
1150
        case prologue:
1151
        case prologue_gr:
1152
        case body:
1153
        case endp:
1154
          ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) frag_more (0);
1155
          ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
1156
          break;
1157
 
1158
          /* Allow any record which doesn't have a "t" field (i.e.,
1159
             doesn't relate to a particular instruction).  */
1160
        case unwabi:
1161
        case br_gr:
1162
        case copy_state:
1163
        case fr_mem:
1164
        case frgr_mem:
1165
        case gr_gr:
1166
        case gr_mem:
1167
        case label_state:
1168
        case rp_br:
1169
        case spill_base:
1170
        case spill_mask:
1171
          /* nothing */
1172
          break;
1173
 
1174
        default:
1175
          as_bad (_("Unwind directive not followed by an instruction."));
1176
          break;
1177
        }
1178
    }
1179
  unwind.current_entry = NULL;
1180
 
1181
  subseg_set (saved_seg, saved_subseg);
1182
 
1183
  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
1184
    as_bad (_("qualifying predicate not followed by instruction"));
1185
}
1186
 
1187
static void
1188
ia64_do_align (int nbytes)
1189
{
1190
  char *saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
1191
 
1192
  input_line_pointer = "";
1193
  s_align_bytes (nbytes);
1194
  input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
1195
}
1196
 
1197
void
1198
ia64_cons_align (nbytes)
1199
     int nbytes;
1200
{
1201
  if (md.auto_align)
1202
    {
1203
      char *saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
1204
      input_line_pointer = "";
1205
      s_align_bytes (nbytes);
1206
      input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
1207
    }
1208
}
1209
 
1210
/* Output COUNT bytes to a memory location.  */
1211
static char *vbyte_mem_ptr = NULL;
1212
 
1213
void
1214
output_vbyte_mem (count, ptr, comment)
1215
     int count;
1216
     char *ptr;
1217
     char *comment ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
1218
{
1219
  int x;
1220
  if (vbyte_mem_ptr == NULL)
1221
    abort ();
1222
 
1223
  if (count == 0)
1224
    return;
1225
  for (x = 0; x < count; x++)
1226
    *(vbyte_mem_ptr++) = ptr[x];
1227
}
1228
 
1229
/* Count the number of bytes required for records.  */
1230
static int vbyte_count = 0;
1231
void
1232
count_output (count, ptr, comment)
1233
     int count;
1234
     char *ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
1235
     char *comment ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
1236
{
1237
  vbyte_count += count;
1238
}
1239
 
1240
static void
1241
output_R1_format (f, rtype, rlen)
1242
     vbyte_func f;
1243
     unw_record_type rtype;
1244
     int rlen;
1245
{
1246
  int r = 0;
1247
  char byte;
1248
  if (rlen > 0x1f)
1249
    {
1250
      output_R3_format (f, rtype, rlen);
1251
      return;
1252
    }
1253
 
1254
  if (rtype == body)
1255
    r = 1;
1256
  else if (rtype != prologue)
1257
    as_bad (_("record type is not valid"));
1258
 
1259
  byte = UNW_R1 | (r << 5) | (rlen & 0x1f);
1260
  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1261
}
1262
 
1263
static void
1264
output_R2_format (f, mask, grsave, rlen)
1265
     vbyte_func f;
1266
     int mask, grsave;
1267
     unsigned long rlen;
1268
{
1269
  char bytes[20];
1270
  int count = 2;
1271
  mask = (mask & 0x0f);
1272
  grsave = (grsave & 0x7f);
1273
 
1274
  bytes[0] = (UNW_R2 | (mask >> 1));
1275
  bytes[1] = (((mask & 0x01) << 7) | grsave);
1276
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, rlen, 0);
1277
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1278
}
1279
 
1280
static void
1281
output_R3_format (f, rtype, rlen)
1282
     vbyte_func f;
1283
     unw_record_type rtype;
1284
     unsigned long rlen;
1285
{
1286
  int r = 0, count;
1287
  char bytes[20];
1288
  if (rlen <= 0x1f)
1289
    {
1290
      output_R1_format (f, rtype, rlen);
1291
      return;
1292
    }
1293
 
1294
  if (rtype == body)
1295
    r = 1;
1296
  else if (rtype != prologue)
1297
    as_bad (_("record type is not valid"));
1298
  bytes[0] = (UNW_R3 | r);
1299
  count = output_leb128 (bytes + 1, rlen, 0);
1300
  (*f) (count + 1, bytes, NULL);
1301
}
1302
 
1303
static void
1304
output_P1_format (f, brmask)
1305
     vbyte_func f;
1306
     int brmask;
1307
{
1308
  char byte;
1309
  byte = UNW_P1 | (brmask & 0x1f);
1310
  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1311
}
1312
 
1313
static void
1314
output_P2_format (f, brmask, gr)
1315
     vbyte_func f;
1316
     int brmask;
1317
     int gr;
1318
{
1319
  char bytes[2];
1320
  brmask = (brmask & 0x1f);
1321
  bytes[0] = UNW_P2 | (brmask >> 1);
1322
  bytes[1] = (((brmask & 1) << 7) | gr);
1323
  (*f) (2, bytes, NULL);
1324
}
1325
 
1326
static void
1327
output_P3_format (f, rtype, reg)
1328
     vbyte_func f;
1329
     unw_record_type rtype;
1330
     int reg;
1331
{
1332
  char bytes[2];
1333
  int r = 0;
1334
  reg = (reg & 0x7f);
1335
  switch (rtype)
1336
    {
1337
    case psp_gr:
1338
      r = 0;
1339
      break;
1340
    case rp_gr:
1341
      r = 1;
1342
      break;
1343
    case pfs_gr:
1344
      r = 2;
1345
      break;
1346
    case preds_gr:
1347
      r = 3;
1348
      break;
1349
    case unat_gr:
1350
      r = 4;
1351
      break;
1352
    case lc_gr:
1353
      r = 5;
1354
      break;
1355
    case rp_br:
1356
      r = 6;
1357
      break;
1358
    case rnat_gr:
1359
      r = 7;
1360
      break;
1361
    case bsp_gr:
1362
      r = 8;
1363
      break;
1364
    case bspstore_gr:
1365
      r = 9;
1366
      break;
1367
    case fpsr_gr:
1368
      r = 10;
1369
      break;
1370
    case priunat_gr:
1371
      r = 11;
1372
      break;
1373
    default:
1374
      as_bad (_("Invalid record type for P3 format."));
1375
    }
1376
  bytes[0] = (UNW_P3 | (r >> 1));
1377
  bytes[1] = (((r & 1) << 7) | reg);
1378
  (*f) (2, bytes, NULL);
1379
}
1380
 
1381
static void
1382
output_P4_format (f, imask, imask_size)
1383
     vbyte_func f;
1384
     unsigned char *imask;
1385
     unsigned long imask_size;
1386
{
1387
  imask[0] = UNW_P4;
1388
  (*f) (imask_size, (char *) imask, NULL);
1389
}
1390
 
1391
static void
1392
output_P5_format (f, grmask, frmask)
1393
     vbyte_func f;
1394
     int grmask;
1395
     unsigned long frmask;
1396
{
1397
  char bytes[4];
1398
  grmask = (grmask & 0x0f);
1399
 
1400
  bytes[0] = UNW_P5;
1401
  bytes[1] = ((grmask << 4) | ((frmask & 0x000f0000) >> 16));
1402
  bytes[2] = ((frmask & 0x0000ff00) >> 8);
1403
  bytes[3] = (frmask & 0x000000ff);
1404
  (*f) (4, bytes, NULL);
1405
}
1406
 
1407
static void
1408
output_P6_format (f, rtype, rmask)
1409
     vbyte_func f;
1410
     unw_record_type rtype;
1411
     int rmask;
1412
{
1413
  char byte;
1414
  int r = 0;
1415
 
1416
  if (rtype == gr_mem)
1417
    r = 1;
1418
  else if (rtype != fr_mem)
1419
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format P6"));
1420
  byte = (UNW_P6 | (r << 4) | (rmask & 0x0f));
1421
  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1422
}
1423
 
1424
static void
1425
output_P7_format (f, rtype, w1, w2)
1426
     vbyte_func f;
1427
     unw_record_type rtype;
1428
     unsigned long w1;
1429
     unsigned long w2;
1430
{
1431
  char bytes[20];
1432
  int count = 1;
1433
  int r = 0;
1434
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, w1, 0);
1435
  switch (rtype)
1436
    {
1437
    case mem_stack_f:
1438
      r = 0;
1439
      count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w2 >> 4, 0);
1440
      break;
1441
    case mem_stack_v:
1442
      r = 1;
1443
      break;
1444
    case spill_base:
1445
      r = 2;
1446
      break;
1447
    case psp_sprel:
1448
      r = 3;
1449
      break;
1450
    case rp_when:
1451
      r = 4;
1452
      break;
1453
    case rp_psprel:
1454
      r = 5;
1455
      break;
1456
    case pfs_when:
1457
      r = 6;
1458
      break;
1459
    case pfs_psprel:
1460
      r = 7;
1461
      break;
1462
    case preds_when:
1463
      r = 8;
1464
      break;
1465
    case preds_psprel:
1466
      r = 9;
1467
      break;
1468
    case lc_when:
1469
      r = 10;
1470
      break;
1471
    case lc_psprel:
1472
      r = 11;
1473
      break;
1474
    case unat_when:
1475
      r = 12;
1476
      break;
1477
    case unat_psprel:
1478
      r = 13;
1479
      break;
1480
    case fpsr_when:
1481
      r = 14;
1482
      break;
1483
    case fpsr_psprel:
1484
      r = 15;
1485
      break;
1486
    default:
1487
      break;
1488
    }
1489
  bytes[0] = (UNW_P7 | r);
1490
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1491
}
1492
 
1493
static void
1494
output_P8_format (f, rtype, t)
1495
     vbyte_func f;
1496
     unw_record_type rtype;
1497
     unsigned long t;
1498
{
1499
  char bytes[20];
1500
  int r = 0;
1501
  int count = 2;
1502
  bytes[0] = UNW_P8;
1503
  switch (rtype)
1504
    {
1505
    case rp_sprel:
1506
      r = 1;
1507
      break;
1508
    case pfs_sprel:
1509
      r = 2;
1510
      break;
1511
    case preds_sprel:
1512
      r = 3;
1513
      break;
1514
    case lc_sprel:
1515
      r = 4;
1516
      break;
1517
    case unat_sprel:
1518
      r = 5;
1519
      break;
1520
    case fpsr_sprel:
1521
      r = 6;
1522
      break;
1523
    case bsp_when:
1524
      r = 7;
1525
      break;
1526
    case bsp_psprel:
1527
      r = 8;
1528
      break;
1529
    case bsp_sprel:
1530
      r = 9;
1531
      break;
1532
    case bspstore_when:
1533
      r = 10;
1534
      break;
1535
    case bspstore_psprel:
1536
      r = 11;
1537
      break;
1538
    case bspstore_sprel:
1539
      r = 12;
1540
      break;
1541
    case rnat_when:
1542
      r = 13;
1543
      break;
1544
    case rnat_psprel:
1545
      r = 14;
1546
      break;
1547
    case rnat_sprel:
1548
      r = 15;
1549
      break;
1550
    case priunat_when_gr:
1551
      r = 16;
1552
      break;
1553
    case priunat_psprel:
1554
      r = 17;
1555
      break;
1556
    case priunat_sprel:
1557
      r = 18;
1558
      break;
1559
    case priunat_when_mem:
1560
      r = 19;
1561
      break;
1562
    default:
1563
      break;
1564
    }
1565
  bytes[1] = r;
1566
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, t, 0);
1567
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1568
}
1569
 
1570
static void
1571
output_P9_format (f, grmask, gr)
1572
     vbyte_func f;
1573
     int grmask;
1574
     int gr;
1575
{
1576
  char bytes[3];
1577
  bytes[0] = UNW_P9;
1578
  bytes[1] = (grmask & 0x0f);
1579
  bytes[2] = (gr & 0x7f);
1580
  (*f) (3, bytes, NULL);
1581
}
1582
 
1583
static void
1584
output_P10_format (f, abi, context)
1585
     vbyte_func f;
1586
     int abi;
1587
     int context;
1588
{
1589
  char bytes[3];
1590
  bytes[0] = UNW_P10;
1591
  bytes[1] = (abi & 0xff);
1592
  bytes[2] = (context & 0xff);
1593
  (*f) (3, bytes, NULL);
1594
}
1595
 
1596
static void
1597
output_B1_format (f, rtype, label)
1598
     vbyte_func f;
1599
     unw_record_type rtype;
1600
     unsigned long label;
1601
{
1602
  char byte;
1603
  int r = 0;
1604
  if (label > 0x1f)
1605
    {
1606
      output_B4_format (f, rtype, label);
1607
      return;
1608
    }
1609
  if (rtype == copy_state)
1610
    r = 1;
1611
  else if (rtype != label_state)
1612
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format B1"));
1613
 
1614
  byte = (UNW_B1 | (r << 5) | (label & 0x1f));
1615
  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1616
}
1617
 
1618
static void
1619
output_B2_format (f, ecount, t)
1620
     vbyte_func f;
1621
     unsigned long ecount;
1622
     unsigned long t;
1623
{
1624
  char bytes[20];
1625
  int count = 1;
1626
  if (ecount > 0x1f)
1627
    {
1628
      output_B3_format (f, ecount, t);
1629
      return;
1630
    }
1631
  bytes[0] = (UNW_B2 | (ecount & 0x1f));
1632
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, t, 0);
1633
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1634
}
1635
 
1636
static void
1637
output_B3_format (f, ecount, t)
1638
     vbyte_func f;
1639
     unsigned long ecount;
1640
     unsigned long t;
1641
{
1642
  char bytes[20];
1643
  int count = 1;
1644
  if (ecount <= 0x1f)
1645
    {
1646
      output_B2_format (f, ecount, t);
1647
      return;
1648
    }
1649
  bytes[0] = UNW_B3;
1650
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, t, 0);
1651
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, ecount, 0);
1652
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1653
}
1654
 
1655
static void
1656
output_B4_format (f, rtype, label)
1657
     vbyte_func f;
1658
     unw_record_type rtype;
1659
     unsigned long label;
1660
{
1661
  char bytes[20];
1662
  int r = 0;
1663
  int count = 1;
1664
  if (label <= 0x1f)
1665
    {
1666
      output_B1_format (f, rtype, label);
1667
      return;
1668
    }
1669
 
1670
  if (rtype == copy_state)
1671
    r = 1;
1672
  else if (rtype != label_state)
1673
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format B1"));
1674
 
1675
  bytes[0] = (UNW_B4 | (r << 3));
1676
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, label, 0);
1677
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1678
}
1679
 
1680
static char
1681
format_ab_reg (ab, reg)
1682
     int ab;
1683
     int reg;
1684
{
1685
  int ret;
1686
  ab = (ab & 3);
1687
  reg = (reg & 0x1f);
1688
  ret = (ab << 5) | reg;
1689
  return ret;
1690
}
1691
 
1692
static void
1693
output_X1_format (f, rtype, ab, reg, t, w1)
1694
     vbyte_func f;
1695
     unw_record_type rtype;
1696
     int ab, reg;
1697
     unsigned long t;
1698
     unsigned long w1;
1699
{
1700
  char bytes[20];
1701
  int r = 0;
1702
  int count = 2;
1703
  bytes[0] = UNW_X1;
1704
 
1705
  if (rtype == spill_sprel)
1706
    r = 1;
1707
  else if (rtype != spill_psprel)
1708
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format X1"));
1709
  bytes[1] = ((r << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1710
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, t, 0);
1711
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w1, 0);
1712
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1713
}
1714
 
1715
static void
1716
output_X2_format (f, ab, reg, x, y, treg, t)
1717
     vbyte_func f;
1718
     int ab, reg;
1719
     int x, y, treg;
1720
     unsigned long t;
1721
{
1722
  char bytes[20];
1723
  int count = 3;
1724
  bytes[0] = UNW_X2;
1725
  bytes[1] = (((x & 1) << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1726
  bytes[2] = (((y & 1) << 7) | (treg & 0x7f));
1727
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 3, t, 0);
1728
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1729
}
1730
 
1731
static void
1732
output_X3_format (f, rtype, qp, ab, reg, t, w1)
1733
     vbyte_func f;
1734
     unw_record_type rtype;
1735
     int qp;
1736
     int ab, reg;
1737
     unsigned long t;
1738
     unsigned long w1;
1739
{
1740
  char bytes[20];
1741
  int r = 0;
1742
  int count = 3;
1743
  bytes[0] = UNW_X3;
1744
 
1745
  if (rtype == spill_sprel_p)
1746
    r = 1;
1747
  else if (rtype != spill_psprel_p)
1748
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format X3"));
1749
  bytes[1] = ((r << 7) | (qp & 0x3f));
1750
  bytes[2] = format_ab_reg (ab, reg);
1751
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 3, t, 0);
1752
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w1, 0);
1753
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1754
}
1755
 
1756
static void
1757
output_X4_format (f, qp, ab, reg, x, y, treg, t)
1758
     vbyte_func f;
1759
     int qp;
1760
     int ab, reg;
1761
     int x, y, treg;
1762
     unsigned long t;
1763
{
1764
  char bytes[20];
1765
  int count = 4;
1766
  bytes[0] = UNW_X4;
1767
  bytes[1] = (qp & 0x3f);
1768
  bytes[2] = (((x & 1) << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1769
  bytes[3] = (((y & 1) << 7) | (treg & 0x7f));
1770
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 4, t, 0);
1771
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1772
}
1773
 
1774
/* This function checks whether there are any outstanding .save-s and
1775
   discards them if so.  */
1776
 
1777
static void
1778
check_pending_save (void)
1779
{
1780
  if (unwind.pending_saves)
1781
    {
1782
      unw_rec_list *cur, *prev;
1783
 
1784
      as_warn (_("Previous .save incomplete"));
1785
      for (cur = unwind.list, prev = NULL; cur; )
1786
        if (&cur->r.record.p == unwind.pending_saves)
1787
          {
1788
            if (prev)
1789
              prev->next = cur->next;
1790
            else
1791
              unwind.list = cur->next;
1792
            if (cur == unwind.tail)
1793
              unwind.tail = prev;
1794
            if (cur == unwind.current_entry)
1795
              unwind.current_entry = cur->next;
1796
            /* Don't free the first discarded record, it's being used as
1797
               terminator for (currently) br_gr and gr_gr processing, and
1798
               also prevents leaving a dangling pointer to it in its
1799
               predecessor.  */
1800
            cur->r.record.p.grmask = 0;
1801
            cur->r.record.p.brmask = 0;
1802
            cur->r.record.p.frmask = 0;
1803
            prev = cur->r.record.p.next;
1804
            cur->r.record.p.next = NULL;
1805
            cur = prev;
1806
            break;
1807
          }
1808
        else
1809
          {
1810
            prev = cur;
1811
            cur = cur->next;
1812
          }
1813
      while (cur)
1814
        {
1815
          prev = cur;
1816
          cur = cur->r.record.p.next;
1817
          free (prev);
1818
        }
1819
      unwind.pending_saves = NULL;
1820
    }
1821
}
1822
 
1823
/* This function allocates a record list structure, and initializes fields.  */
1824
 
1825
static unw_rec_list *
1826
alloc_record (unw_record_type t)
1827
{
1828
  unw_rec_list *ptr;
1829
  ptr = xmalloc (sizeof (*ptr));
1830
  memset (ptr, 0, sizeof (*ptr));
1831
  ptr->slot_number = SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET;
1832
  ptr->r.type = t;
1833
  return ptr;
1834
}
1835
 
1836
/* Dummy unwind record used for calculating the length of the last prologue or
1837
   body region.  */
1838
 
1839
static unw_rec_list *
1840
output_endp ()
1841
{
1842
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (endp);
1843
  return ptr;
1844
}
1845
 
1846
static unw_rec_list *
1847
output_prologue ()
1848
{
1849
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (prologue);
1850
  memset (&ptr->r.record.r.mask, 0, sizeof (ptr->r.record.r.mask));
1851
  return ptr;
1852
}
1853
 
1854
static unw_rec_list *
1855
output_prologue_gr (saved_mask, reg)
1856
     unsigned int saved_mask;
1857
     unsigned int reg;
1858
{
1859
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (prologue_gr);
1860
  memset (&ptr->r.record.r.mask, 0, sizeof (ptr->r.record.r.mask));
1861
  ptr->r.record.r.grmask = saved_mask;
1862
  ptr->r.record.r.grsave = reg;
1863
  return ptr;
1864
}
1865
 
1866
static unw_rec_list *
1867
output_body ()
1868
{
1869
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (body);
1870
  return ptr;
1871
}
1872
 
1873
static unw_rec_list *
1874
output_mem_stack_f (size)
1875
     unsigned int size;
1876
{
1877
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (mem_stack_f);
1878
  ptr->r.record.p.size = size;
1879
  return ptr;
1880
}
1881
 
1882
static unw_rec_list *
1883
output_mem_stack_v ()
1884
{
1885
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (mem_stack_v);
1886
  return ptr;
1887
}
1888
 
1889
static unw_rec_list *
1890
output_psp_gr (gr)
1891
     unsigned int gr;
1892
{
1893
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (psp_gr);
1894
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1895
  return ptr;
1896
}
1897
 
1898
static unw_rec_list *
1899
output_psp_sprel (offset)
1900
     unsigned int offset;
1901
{
1902
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (psp_sprel);
1903
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1904
  return ptr;
1905
}
1906
 
1907
static unw_rec_list *
1908
output_rp_when ()
1909
{
1910
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_when);
1911
  return ptr;
1912
}
1913
 
1914
static unw_rec_list *
1915
output_rp_gr (gr)
1916
     unsigned int gr;
1917
{
1918
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_gr);
1919
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1920
  return ptr;
1921
}
1922
 
1923
static unw_rec_list *
1924
output_rp_br (br)
1925
     unsigned int br;
1926
{
1927
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_br);
1928
  ptr->r.record.p.r.br = br;
1929
  return ptr;
1930
}
1931
 
1932
static unw_rec_list *
1933
output_rp_psprel (offset)
1934
     unsigned int offset;
1935
{
1936
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_psprel);
1937
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1938
  return ptr;
1939
}
1940
 
1941
static unw_rec_list *
1942
output_rp_sprel (offset)
1943
     unsigned int offset;
1944
{
1945
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_sprel);
1946
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1947
  return ptr;
1948
}
1949
 
1950
static unw_rec_list *
1951
output_pfs_when ()
1952
{
1953
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_when);
1954
  return ptr;
1955
}
1956
 
1957
static unw_rec_list *
1958
output_pfs_gr (gr)
1959
     unsigned int gr;
1960
{
1961
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_gr);
1962
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1963
  return ptr;
1964
}
1965
 
1966
static unw_rec_list *
1967
output_pfs_psprel (offset)
1968
     unsigned int offset;
1969
{
1970
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_psprel);
1971
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1972
  return ptr;
1973
}
1974
 
1975
static unw_rec_list *
1976
output_pfs_sprel (offset)
1977
     unsigned int offset;
1978
{
1979
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_sprel);
1980
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1981
  return ptr;
1982
}
1983
 
1984
static unw_rec_list *
1985
output_preds_when ()
1986
{
1987
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_when);
1988
  return ptr;
1989
}
1990
 
1991
static unw_rec_list *
1992
output_preds_gr (gr)
1993
     unsigned int gr;
1994
{
1995
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_gr);
1996
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1997
  return ptr;
1998
}
1999
 
2000
static unw_rec_list *
2001
output_preds_psprel (offset)
2002
     unsigned int offset;
2003
{
2004
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_psprel);
2005
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2006
  return ptr;
2007
}
2008
 
2009
static unw_rec_list *
2010
output_preds_sprel (offset)
2011
     unsigned int offset;
2012
{
2013
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_sprel);
2014
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2015
  return ptr;
2016
}
2017
 
2018
static unw_rec_list *
2019
output_fr_mem (mask)
2020
     unsigned int mask;
2021
{
2022
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fr_mem);
2023
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2024
 
2025
  ptr->r.record.p.frmask = mask;
2026
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
2027
  for (;;)
2028
    {
2029
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2030
 
2031
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2032
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
2033
      if (!mask)
2034
        return ptr;
2035
      cur = alloc_record (fr_mem);
2036
      cur->r.record.p.frmask = mask;
2037
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2038
      prev->r.record.p.frmask ^= mask;
2039
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2040
    }
2041
}
2042
 
2043
static unw_rec_list *
2044
output_frgr_mem (gr_mask, fr_mask)
2045
     unsigned int gr_mask;
2046
     unsigned int fr_mask;
2047
{
2048
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
2049
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2050
 
2051
  unwind.pending_saves = &cur->r.record.p;
2052
  cur->r.record.p.frmask = fr_mask;
2053
  while (fr_mask)
2054
    {
2055
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2056
 
2057
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2058
      fr_mask &= ~(fr_mask & (~fr_mask + 1));
2059
      if (!gr_mask && !fr_mask)
2060
        return ptr;
2061
      cur = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
2062
      cur->r.record.p.frmask = fr_mask;
2063
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2064
      prev->r.record.p.frmask ^= fr_mask;
2065
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2066
    }
2067
  cur->r.record.p.grmask = gr_mask;
2068
  for (;;)
2069
    {
2070
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2071
 
2072
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2073
      gr_mask &= ~(gr_mask & (~gr_mask + 1));
2074
      if (!gr_mask)
2075
        return ptr;
2076
      cur = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
2077
      cur->r.record.p.grmask = gr_mask;
2078
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2079
      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= gr_mask;
2080
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2081
    }
2082
}
2083
 
2084
static unw_rec_list *
2085
output_gr_gr (mask, reg)
2086
     unsigned int mask;
2087
     unsigned int reg;
2088
{
2089
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (gr_gr);
2090
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2091
 
2092
  ptr->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
2093
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = reg;
2094
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
2095
  for (;;)
2096
    {
2097
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2098
 
2099
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2100
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
2101
      if (!mask)
2102
        return ptr;
2103
      cur = alloc_record (gr_gr);
2104
      cur->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
2105
      /* Indicate this record shouldn't be output.  */
2106
      cur->r.record.p.r.gr = REG_NUM;
2107
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2108
      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= mask;
2109
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2110
    }
2111
}
2112
 
2113
static unw_rec_list *
2114
output_gr_mem (mask)
2115
     unsigned int mask;
2116
{
2117
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (gr_mem);
2118
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2119
 
2120
  ptr->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
2121
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
2122
  for (;;)
2123
    {
2124
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2125
 
2126
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2127
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
2128
      if (!mask)
2129
        return ptr;
2130
      cur = alloc_record (gr_mem);
2131
      cur->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
2132
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2133
      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= mask;
2134
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2135
    }
2136
}
2137
 
2138
static unw_rec_list *
2139
output_br_mem (unsigned int mask)
2140
{
2141
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (br_mem);
2142
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2143
 
2144
  ptr->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
2145
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
2146
  for (;;)
2147
    {
2148
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2149
 
2150
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2151
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
2152
      if (!mask)
2153
        return ptr;
2154
      cur = alloc_record (br_mem);
2155
      cur->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
2156
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2157
      prev->r.record.p.brmask ^= mask;
2158
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2159
    }
2160
}
2161
 
2162
static unw_rec_list *
2163
output_br_gr (mask, reg)
2164
     unsigned int mask;
2165
     unsigned int reg;
2166
{
2167
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (br_gr);
2168
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2169
 
2170
  ptr->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
2171
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = reg;
2172
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
2173
  for (;;)
2174
    {
2175
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2176
 
2177
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2178
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
2179
      if (!mask)
2180
        return ptr;
2181
      cur = alloc_record (br_gr);
2182
      cur->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
2183
      /* Indicate this record shouldn't be output.  */
2184
      cur->r.record.p.r.gr = REG_NUM;
2185
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2186
      prev->r.record.p.brmask ^= mask;
2187
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2188
    }
2189
}
2190
 
2191
static unw_rec_list *
2192
output_spill_base (offset)
2193
     unsigned int offset;
2194
{
2195
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (spill_base);
2196
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2197
  return ptr;
2198
}
2199
 
2200
static unw_rec_list *
2201
output_unat_when ()
2202
{
2203
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_when);
2204
  return ptr;
2205
}
2206
 
2207
static unw_rec_list *
2208
output_unat_gr (gr)
2209
     unsigned int gr;
2210
{
2211
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_gr);
2212
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2213
  return ptr;
2214
}
2215
 
2216
static unw_rec_list *
2217
output_unat_psprel (offset)
2218
     unsigned int offset;
2219
{
2220
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_psprel);
2221
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2222
  return ptr;
2223
}
2224
 
2225
static unw_rec_list *
2226
output_unat_sprel (offset)
2227
     unsigned int offset;
2228
{
2229
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_sprel);
2230
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2231
  return ptr;
2232
}
2233
 
2234
static unw_rec_list *
2235
output_lc_when ()
2236
{
2237
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_when);
2238
  return ptr;
2239
}
2240
 
2241
static unw_rec_list *
2242
output_lc_gr (gr)
2243
     unsigned int gr;
2244
{
2245
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_gr);
2246
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2247
  return ptr;
2248
}
2249
 
2250
static unw_rec_list *
2251
output_lc_psprel (offset)
2252
     unsigned int offset;
2253
{
2254
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_psprel);
2255
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2256
  return ptr;
2257
}
2258
 
2259
static unw_rec_list *
2260
output_lc_sprel (offset)
2261
     unsigned int offset;
2262
{
2263
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_sprel);
2264
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2265
  return ptr;
2266
}
2267
 
2268
static unw_rec_list *
2269
output_fpsr_when ()
2270
{
2271
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_when);
2272
  return ptr;
2273
}
2274
 
2275
static unw_rec_list *
2276
output_fpsr_gr (gr)
2277
     unsigned int gr;
2278
{
2279
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_gr);
2280
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2281
  return ptr;
2282
}
2283
 
2284
static unw_rec_list *
2285
output_fpsr_psprel (offset)
2286
     unsigned int offset;
2287
{
2288
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_psprel);
2289
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2290
  return ptr;
2291
}
2292
 
2293
static unw_rec_list *
2294
output_fpsr_sprel (offset)
2295
     unsigned int offset;
2296
{
2297
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_sprel);
2298
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2299
  return ptr;
2300
}
2301
 
2302
static unw_rec_list *
2303
output_priunat_when_gr ()
2304
{
2305
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_when_gr);
2306
  return ptr;
2307
}
2308
 
2309
static unw_rec_list *
2310
output_priunat_when_mem ()
2311
{
2312
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_when_mem);
2313
  return ptr;
2314
}
2315
 
2316
static unw_rec_list *
2317
output_priunat_gr (gr)
2318
     unsigned int gr;
2319
{
2320
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_gr);
2321
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2322
  return ptr;
2323
}
2324
 
2325
static unw_rec_list *
2326
output_priunat_psprel (offset)
2327
     unsigned int offset;
2328
{
2329
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_psprel);
2330
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2331
  return ptr;
2332
}
2333
 
2334
static unw_rec_list *
2335
output_priunat_sprel (offset)
2336
     unsigned int offset;
2337
{
2338
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_sprel);
2339
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2340
  return ptr;
2341
}
2342
 
2343
static unw_rec_list *
2344
output_bsp_when ()
2345
{
2346
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_when);
2347
  return ptr;
2348
}
2349
 
2350
static unw_rec_list *
2351
output_bsp_gr (gr)
2352
     unsigned int gr;
2353
{
2354
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_gr);
2355
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2356
  return ptr;
2357
}
2358
 
2359
static unw_rec_list *
2360
output_bsp_psprel (offset)
2361
     unsigned int offset;
2362
{
2363
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_psprel);
2364
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2365
  return ptr;
2366
}
2367
 
2368
static unw_rec_list *
2369
output_bsp_sprel (offset)
2370
     unsigned int offset;
2371
{
2372
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_sprel);
2373
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2374
  return ptr;
2375
}
2376
 
2377
static unw_rec_list *
2378
output_bspstore_when ()
2379
{
2380
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_when);
2381
  return ptr;
2382
}
2383
 
2384
static unw_rec_list *
2385
output_bspstore_gr (gr)
2386
     unsigned int gr;
2387
{
2388
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_gr);
2389
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2390
  return ptr;
2391
}
2392
 
2393
static unw_rec_list *
2394
output_bspstore_psprel (offset)
2395
     unsigned int offset;
2396
{
2397
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_psprel);
2398
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2399
  return ptr;
2400
}
2401
 
2402
static unw_rec_list *
2403
output_bspstore_sprel (offset)
2404
     unsigned int offset;
2405
{
2406
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_sprel);
2407
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2408
  return ptr;
2409
}
2410
 
2411
static unw_rec_list *
2412
output_rnat_when ()
2413
{
2414
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_when);
2415
  return ptr;
2416
}
2417
 
2418
static unw_rec_list *
2419
output_rnat_gr (gr)
2420
     unsigned int gr;
2421
{
2422
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_gr);
2423
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2424
  return ptr;
2425
}
2426
 
2427
static unw_rec_list *
2428
output_rnat_psprel (offset)
2429
     unsigned int offset;
2430
{
2431
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_psprel);
2432
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2433
  return ptr;
2434
}
2435
 
2436
static unw_rec_list *
2437
output_rnat_sprel (offset)
2438
     unsigned int offset;
2439
{
2440
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_sprel);
2441
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2442
  return ptr;
2443
}
2444
 
2445
static unw_rec_list *
2446
output_unwabi (abi, context)
2447
     unsigned long abi;
2448
     unsigned long context;
2449
{
2450
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unwabi);
2451
  ptr->r.record.p.abi = abi;
2452
  ptr->r.record.p.context = context;
2453
  return ptr;
2454
}
2455
 
2456
static unw_rec_list *
2457
output_epilogue (unsigned long ecount)
2458
{
2459
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (epilogue);
2460
  ptr->r.record.b.ecount = ecount;
2461
  return ptr;
2462
}
2463
 
2464
static unw_rec_list *
2465
output_label_state (unsigned long label)
2466
{
2467
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (label_state);
2468
  ptr->r.record.b.label = label;
2469
  return ptr;
2470
}
2471
 
2472
static unw_rec_list *
2473
output_copy_state (unsigned long label)
2474
{
2475
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (copy_state);
2476
  ptr->r.record.b.label = label;
2477
  return ptr;
2478
}
2479
 
2480
static unw_rec_list *
2481
output_spill_psprel (ab, reg, offset, predicate)
2482
     unsigned int ab;
2483
     unsigned int reg;
2484
     unsigned int offset;
2485
     unsigned int predicate;
2486
{
2487
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_psprel_p : spill_psprel);
2488
  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2489
  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2490
  ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2491
  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2492
  return ptr;
2493
}
2494
 
2495
static unw_rec_list *
2496
output_spill_sprel (ab, reg, offset, predicate)
2497
     unsigned int ab;
2498
     unsigned int reg;
2499
     unsigned int offset;
2500
     unsigned int predicate;
2501
{
2502
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_sprel_p : spill_sprel);
2503
  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2504
  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2505
  ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff = offset / 4;
2506
  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2507
  return ptr;
2508
}
2509
 
2510
static unw_rec_list *
2511
output_spill_reg (ab, reg, targ_reg, xy, predicate)
2512
     unsigned int ab;
2513
     unsigned int reg;
2514
     unsigned int targ_reg;
2515
     unsigned int xy;
2516
     unsigned int predicate;
2517
{
2518
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_reg_p : spill_reg);
2519
  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2520
  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2521
  ptr->r.record.x.where.reg = targ_reg;
2522
  ptr->r.record.x.xy = xy;
2523
  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2524
  return ptr;
2525
}
2526
 
2527
/* Given a unw_rec_list process the correct format with the
2528
   specified function.  */
2529
 
2530
static void
2531
process_one_record (ptr, f)
2532
     unw_rec_list *ptr;
2533
     vbyte_func f;
2534
{
2535
  unsigned int fr_mask, gr_mask;
2536
 
2537
  switch (ptr->r.type)
2538
    {
2539
      /* This is a dummy record that takes up no space in the output.  */
2540
    case endp:
2541
      break;
2542
 
2543
    case gr_mem:
2544
    case fr_mem:
2545
    case br_mem:
2546
    case frgr_mem:
2547
      /* These are taken care of by prologue/prologue_gr.  */
2548
      break;
2549
 
2550
    case prologue_gr:
2551
    case prologue:
2552
      if (ptr->r.type == prologue_gr)
2553
        output_R2_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.grmask,
2554
                          ptr->r.record.r.grsave, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2555
      else
2556
        output_R1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2557
 
2558
      /* Output descriptor(s) for union of register spills (if any).  */
2559
      gr_mask = ptr->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem;
2560
      fr_mask = ptr->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem;
2561
      if (fr_mask)
2562
        {
2563
          if ((fr_mask & ~0xfUL) == 0)
2564
            output_P6_format (f, fr_mem, fr_mask);
2565
          else
2566
            {
2567
              output_P5_format (f, gr_mask, fr_mask);
2568
              gr_mask = 0;
2569
            }
2570
        }
2571
      if (gr_mask)
2572
        output_P6_format (f, gr_mem, gr_mask);
2573
      if (ptr->r.record.r.mask.br_mem)
2574
        output_P1_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.mask.br_mem);
2575
 
2576
      /* output imask descriptor if necessary:  */
2577
      if (ptr->r.record.r.mask.i)
2578
        output_P4_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.mask.i,
2579
                          ptr->r.record.r.imask_size);
2580
      break;
2581
 
2582
    case body:
2583
      output_R1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2584
      break;
2585
    case mem_stack_f:
2586
    case mem_stack_v:
2587
      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t,
2588
                        ptr->r.record.p.size);
2589
      break;
2590
    case psp_gr:
2591
    case rp_gr:
2592
    case pfs_gr:
2593
    case preds_gr:
2594
    case unat_gr:
2595
    case lc_gr:
2596
    case fpsr_gr:
2597
    case priunat_gr:
2598
    case bsp_gr:
2599
    case bspstore_gr:
2600
    case rnat_gr:
2601
      output_P3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2602
      break;
2603
    case rp_br:
2604
      output_P3_format (f, rp_br, ptr->r.record.p.r.br);
2605
      break;
2606
    case psp_sprel:
2607
      output_P7_format (f, psp_sprel, ptr->r.record.p.off.sp, 0);
2608
      break;
2609
    case rp_when:
2610
    case pfs_when:
2611
    case preds_when:
2612
    case unat_when:
2613
    case lc_when:
2614
    case fpsr_when:
2615
      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t, 0);
2616
      break;
2617
    case rp_psprel:
2618
    case pfs_psprel:
2619
    case preds_psprel:
2620
    case unat_psprel:
2621
    case lc_psprel:
2622
    case fpsr_psprel:
2623
    case spill_base:
2624
      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.psp, 0);
2625
      break;
2626
    case rp_sprel:
2627
    case pfs_sprel:
2628
    case preds_sprel:
2629
    case unat_sprel:
2630
    case lc_sprel:
2631
    case fpsr_sprel:
2632
    case priunat_sprel:
2633
    case bsp_sprel:
2634
    case bspstore_sprel:
2635
    case rnat_sprel:
2636
      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.sp);
2637
      break;
2638
    case gr_gr:
2639
      if (ptr->r.record.p.r.gr < REG_NUM)
2640
        {
2641
          const unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2642
 
2643
          gr_mask = cur->r.record.p.grmask;
2644
          while ((cur = cur->r.record.p.next) != NULL)
2645
            gr_mask |= cur->r.record.p.grmask;
2646
          output_P9_format (f, gr_mask, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2647
        }
2648
      break;
2649
    case br_gr:
2650
      if (ptr->r.record.p.r.gr < REG_NUM)
2651
        {
2652
          const unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2653
 
2654
          gr_mask = cur->r.record.p.brmask;
2655
          while ((cur = cur->r.record.p.next) != NULL)
2656
            gr_mask |= cur->r.record.p.brmask;
2657
          output_P2_format (f, gr_mask, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2658
        }
2659
      break;
2660
    case spill_mask:
2661
      as_bad (_("spill_mask record unimplemented."));
2662
      break;
2663
    case priunat_when_gr:
2664
    case priunat_when_mem:
2665
    case bsp_when:
2666
    case bspstore_when:
2667
    case rnat_when:
2668
      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t);
2669
      break;
2670
    case priunat_psprel:
2671
    case bsp_psprel:
2672
    case bspstore_psprel:
2673
    case rnat_psprel:
2674
      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.psp);
2675
      break;
2676
    case unwabi:
2677
      output_P10_format (f, ptr->r.record.p.abi, ptr->r.record.p.context);
2678
      break;
2679
    case epilogue:
2680
      output_B3_format (f, ptr->r.record.b.ecount, ptr->r.record.b.t);
2681
      break;
2682
    case label_state:
2683
    case copy_state:
2684
      output_B4_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.b.label);
2685
      break;
2686
    case spill_psprel:
2687
      output_X1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2688
                        ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t,
2689
                        ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff);
2690
      break;
2691
    case spill_sprel:
2692
      output_X1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2693
                        ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t,
2694
                        ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff);
2695
      break;
2696
    case spill_reg:
2697
      output_X2_format (f, ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2698
                        ptr->r.record.x.xy >> 1, ptr->r.record.x.xy,
2699
                        ptr->r.record.x.where.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t);
2700
      break;
2701
    case spill_psprel_p:
2702
      output_X3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.qp,
2703
                        ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2704
                        ptr->r.record.x.t, ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff);
2705
      break;
2706
    case spill_sprel_p:
2707
      output_X3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.qp,
2708
                        ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2709
                        ptr->r.record.x.t, ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff);
2710
      break;
2711
    case spill_reg_p:
2712
      output_X4_format (f, ptr->r.record.x.qp, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2713
                        ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.xy >> 1,
2714
                        ptr->r.record.x.xy, ptr->r.record.x.where.reg,
2715
                        ptr->r.record.x.t);
2716
      break;
2717
    default:
2718
      as_bad (_("record_type_not_valid"));
2719
      break;
2720
    }
2721
}
2722
 
2723
/* Given a unw_rec_list list, process all the records with
2724
   the specified function.  */
2725
static void
2726
process_unw_records (list, f)
2727
     unw_rec_list *list;
2728
     vbyte_func f;
2729
{
2730
  unw_rec_list *ptr;
2731
  for (ptr = list; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
2732
    process_one_record (ptr, f);
2733
}
2734
 
2735
/* Determine the size of a record list in bytes.  */
2736
static int
2737
calc_record_size (list)
2738
     unw_rec_list *list;
2739
{
2740
  vbyte_count = 0;
2741
  process_unw_records (list, count_output);
2742
  return vbyte_count;
2743
}
2744
 
2745
/* Return the number of bits set in the input value.
2746
   Perhaps this has a better place...  */
2747
#if __GNUC__ > 3 || (__GNUC__ == 3 && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= 4)
2748
# define popcount __builtin_popcount
2749
#else
2750
static int
2751
popcount (unsigned x)
2752
{
2753
  static const unsigned char popcnt[16] =
2754
    {
2755
      0, 1, 1, 2,
2756
      1, 2, 2, 3,
2757
      1, 2, 2, 3,
2758
      2, 3, 3, 4
2759
    };
2760
 
2761
  if (x < NELEMS (popcnt))
2762
    return popcnt[x];
2763
  return popcnt[x % NELEMS (popcnt)] + popcount (x / NELEMS (popcnt));
2764
}
2765
#endif
2766
 
2767
/* Update IMASK bitmask to reflect the fact that one or more registers
2768
   of type TYPE are saved starting at instruction with index T.  If N
2769
   bits are set in REGMASK, it is assumed that instructions T through
2770
   T+N-1 save these registers.
2771
 
2772
   TYPE values:
2773
        0: no save
2774
        1: instruction saves next fp reg
2775
        2: instruction saves next general reg
2776
        3: instruction saves next branch reg */
2777
static void
2778
set_imask (region, regmask, t, type)
2779
     unw_rec_list *region;
2780
     unsigned long regmask;
2781
     unsigned long t;
2782
     unsigned int type;
2783
{
2784
  unsigned char *imask;
2785
  unsigned long imask_size;
2786
  unsigned int i;
2787
  int pos;
2788
 
2789
  imask = region->r.record.r.mask.i;
2790
  imask_size = region->r.record.r.imask_size;
2791
  if (!imask)
2792
    {
2793
      imask_size = (region->r.record.r.rlen * 2 + 7) / 8 + 1;
2794
      imask = xmalloc (imask_size);
2795
      memset (imask, 0, imask_size);
2796
 
2797
      region->r.record.r.imask_size = imask_size;
2798
      region->r.record.r.mask.i = imask;
2799
    }
2800
 
2801
  i = (t / 4) + 1;
2802
  pos = 2 * (3 - t % 4);
2803
  while (regmask)
2804
    {
2805
      if (i >= imask_size)
2806
        {
2807
          as_bad (_("Ignoring attempt to spill beyond end of region"));
2808
          return;
2809
        }
2810
 
2811
      imask[i] |= (type & 0x3) << pos;
2812
 
2813
      regmask &= (regmask - 1);
2814
      pos -= 2;
2815
      if (pos < 0)
2816
        {
2817
          pos = 0;
2818
          ++i;
2819
        }
2820
    }
2821
}
2822
 
2823
/* Return the number of instruction slots from FIRST_ADDR to SLOT_ADDR.
2824
   SLOT_FRAG is the frag containing SLOT_ADDR, and FIRST_FRAG is the frag
2825
   containing FIRST_ADDR.  If BEFORE_RELAX, then we use worst-case estimates
2826
   for frag sizes.  */
2827
 
2828
unsigned long
2829
slot_index (slot_addr, slot_frag, first_addr, first_frag, before_relax)
2830
     unsigned long slot_addr;
2831
     fragS *slot_frag;
2832
     unsigned long first_addr;
2833
     fragS *first_frag;
2834
     int before_relax;
2835
{
2836
  unsigned long index = 0;
2837
 
2838
  /* First time we are called, the initial address and frag are invalid.  */
2839
  if (first_addr == 0)
2840
    return 0;
2841
 
2842
  /* If the two addresses are in different frags, then we need to add in
2843
     the remaining size of this frag, and then the entire size of intermediate
2844
     frags.  */
2845
  while (slot_frag != first_frag)
2846
    {
2847
      unsigned long start_addr = (unsigned long) &first_frag->fr_literal;
2848
 
2849
      if (! before_relax)
2850
        {
2851
          /* We can get the final addresses only during and after
2852
             relaxation.  */
2853
          if (first_frag->fr_next && first_frag->fr_next->fr_address)
2854
            index += 3 * ((first_frag->fr_next->fr_address
2855
                           - first_frag->fr_address
2856
                             - first_frag->fr_fix) >> 4);
2857
        }
2858
      else
2859
        /* We don't know what the final addresses will be. We try our
2860
           best to estimate.  */
2861
        switch (first_frag->fr_type)
2862
          {
2863
          default:
2864
            break;
2865
 
2866
          case rs_space:
2867
            as_fatal (_("Only constant space allocation is supported"));
2868
            break;
2869
 
2870
          case rs_align:
2871
          case rs_align_code:
2872
          case rs_align_test:
2873
            /* Take alignment into account.  Assume the worst case
2874
               before relaxation.  */
2875
            index += 3 * ((1 << first_frag->fr_offset) >> 4);
2876
            break;
2877
 
2878
          case rs_org:
2879
            if (first_frag->fr_symbol)
2880
              {
2881
                as_fatal (_("Only constant offsets are supported"));
2882
                break;
2883
              }
2884
          case rs_fill:
2885
            index += 3 * (first_frag->fr_offset >> 4);
2886
            break;
2887
          }
2888
 
2889
      /* Add in the full size of the frag converted to instruction slots.  */
2890
      index += 3 * (first_frag->fr_fix >> 4);
2891
      /* Subtract away the initial part before first_addr.  */
2892
      index -= (3 * ((first_addr >> 4) - (start_addr >> 4))
2893
                + ((first_addr & 0x3) - (start_addr & 0x3)));
2894
 
2895
      /* Move to the beginning of the next frag.  */
2896
      first_frag = first_frag->fr_next;
2897
      first_addr = (unsigned long) &first_frag->fr_literal;
2898
 
2899
      /* This can happen if there is section switching in the middle of a
2900
         function, causing the frag chain for the function to be broken.
2901
         It is too difficult to recover safely from this problem, so we just
2902
         exit with an error.  */
2903
      if (first_frag == NULL)
2904
        as_fatal (_("Section switching in code is not supported."));
2905
    }
2906
 
2907
  /* Add in the used part of the last frag.  */
2908
  index += (3 * ((slot_addr >> 4) - (first_addr >> 4))
2909
            + ((slot_addr & 0x3) - (first_addr & 0x3)));
2910
  return index;
2911
}
2912
 
2913
/* Optimize unwind record directives.  */
2914
 
2915
static unw_rec_list *
2916
optimize_unw_records (list)
2917
     unw_rec_list *list;
2918
{
2919
  if (!list)
2920
    return NULL;
2921
 
2922
  /* If the only unwind record is ".prologue" or ".prologue" followed
2923
     by ".body", then we can optimize the unwind directives away.  */
2924
  if (list->r.type == prologue
2925
      && (list->next->r.type == endp
2926
          || (list->next->r.type == body && list->next->next->r.type == endp)))
2927
    return NULL;
2928
 
2929
  return list;
2930
}
2931
 
2932
/* Given a complete record list, process any records which have
2933
   unresolved fields, (ie length counts for a prologue).  After
2934
   this has been run, all necessary information should be available
2935
   within each record to generate an image.  */
2936
 
2937
static void
2938
fixup_unw_records (list, before_relax)
2939
     unw_rec_list *list;
2940
     int before_relax;
2941
{
2942
  unw_rec_list *ptr, *region = 0;
2943
  unsigned long first_addr = 0, rlen = 0, t;
2944
  fragS *first_frag = 0;
2945
 
2946
  for (ptr = list; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
2947
    {
2948
      if (ptr->slot_number == SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET)
2949
        as_bad (_(" Insn slot not set in unwind record."));
2950
      t = slot_index (ptr->slot_number, ptr->slot_frag,
2951
                      first_addr, first_frag, before_relax);
2952
      switch (ptr->r.type)
2953
        {
2954
        case prologue:
2955
        case prologue_gr:
2956
        case body:
2957
          {
2958
            unw_rec_list *last;
2959
            int size;
2960
            unsigned long last_addr = 0;
2961
            fragS *last_frag = NULL;
2962
 
2963
            first_addr = ptr->slot_number;
2964
            first_frag = ptr->slot_frag;
2965
            /* Find either the next body/prologue start, or the end of
2966
               the function, and determine the size of the region.  */
2967
            for (last = ptr->next; last != NULL; last = last->next)
2968
              if (last->r.type == prologue || last->r.type == prologue_gr
2969
                  || last->r.type == body || last->r.type == endp)
2970
                {
2971
                  last_addr = last->slot_number;
2972
                  last_frag = last->slot_frag;
2973
                  break;
2974
                }
2975
            size = slot_index (last_addr, last_frag, first_addr, first_frag,
2976
                               before_relax);
2977
            rlen = ptr->r.record.r.rlen = size;
2978
            if (ptr->r.type == body)
2979
              /* End of region.  */
2980
              region = 0;
2981
            else
2982
              region = ptr;
2983
            break;
2984
          }
2985
        case epilogue:
2986
          if (t < rlen)
2987
            ptr->r.record.b.t = rlen - 1 - t;
2988
          else
2989
            /* This happens when a memory-stack-less procedure uses a
2990
               ".restore sp" directive at the end of a region to pop
2991
               the frame state.  */
2992
            ptr->r.record.b.t = 0;
2993
          break;
2994
 
2995
        case mem_stack_f:
2996
        case mem_stack_v:
2997
        case rp_when:
2998
        case pfs_when:
2999
        case preds_when:
3000
        case unat_when:
3001
        case lc_when:
3002
        case fpsr_when:
3003
        case priunat_when_gr:
3004
        case priunat_when_mem:
3005
        case bsp_when:
3006
        case bspstore_when:
3007
        case rnat_when:
3008
          ptr->r.record.p.t = t;
3009
          break;
3010
 
3011
        case spill_reg:
3012
        case spill_sprel:
3013
        case spill_psprel:
3014
        case spill_reg_p:
3015
        case spill_sprel_p:
3016
        case spill_psprel_p:
3017
          ptr->r.record.x.t = t;
3018
          break;
3019
 
3020
        case frgr_mem:
3021
          if (!region)
3022
            {
3023
              as_bad (_("frgr_mem record before region record!"));
3024
              return;
3025
            }
3026
          region->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.frmask;
3027
          region->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.grmask;
3028
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.frmask, t, 1);
3029
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
3030
          break;
3031
        case fr_mem:
3032
          if (!region)
3033
            {
3034
              as_bad (_("fr_mem record before region record!"));
3035
              return;
3036
            }
3037
          region->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.frmask;
3038
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.frmask, t, 1);
3039
          break;
3040
        case gr_mem:
3041
          if (!region)
3042
            {
3043
              as_bad (_("gr_mem record before region record!"));
3044
              return;
3045
            }
3046
          region->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.grmask;
3047
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
3048
          break;
3049
        case br_mem:
3050
          if (!region)
3051
            {
3052
              as_bad (_("br_mem record before region record!"));
3053
              return;
3054
            }
3055
          region->r.record.r.mask.br_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.brmask;
3056
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.brmask, t, 3);
3057
          break;
3058
 
3059
        case gr_gr:
3060
          if (!region)
3061
            {
3062
              as_bad (_("gr_gr record before region record!"));
3063
              return;
3064
            }
3065
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
3066
          break;
3067
        case br_gr:
3068
          if (!region)
3069
            {
3070
              as_bad (_("br_gr record before region record!"));
3071
              return;
3072
            }
3073
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.brmask, t, 3);
3074
          break;
3075
 
3076
        default:
3077
          break;
3078
        }
3079
    }
3080
}
3081
 
3082
/* Estimate the size of a frag before relaxing.  We only have one type of frag
3083
   to handle here, which is the unwind info frag.  */
3084
 
3085
int
3086
ia64_estimate_size_before_relax (fragS *frag,
3087
                                 asection *segtype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3088
{
3089
  unw_rec_list *list;
3090
  int len, size, pad;
3091
 
3092
  /* ??? This code is identical to the first part of ia64_convert_frag.  */
3093
  list = (unw_rec_list *) frag->fr_opcode;
3094
  fixup_unw_records (list, 0);
3095
 
3096
  len = calc_record_size (list);
3097
  /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
3098
  pad = len % md.pointer_size;
3099
  if (pad != 0)
3100
    len += md.pointer_size - pad;
3101
  /* Add 8 for the header.  */
3102
  size = len + 8;
3103
  /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
3104
  if (frag->fr_offset)
3105
    size += md.pointer_size;
3106
 
3107
  /* fr_var carries the max_chars that we created the fragment with.
3108
     We must, of course, have allocated enough memory earlier.  */
3109
  assert (frag->fr_var >= size);
3110
 
3111
  return frag->fr_fix + size;
3112
}
3113
 
3114
/* This function converts a rs_machine_dependent variant frag into a
3115
  normal fill frag with the unwind image from the the record list.  */
3116
void
3117
ia64_convert_frag (fragS *frag)
3118
{
3119
  unw_rec_list *list;
3120
  int len, size, pad;
3121
  valueT flag_value;
3122
 
3123
  /* ??? This code is identical to ia64_estimate_size_before_relax.  */
3124
  list = (unw_rec_list *) frag->fr_opcode;
3125
  fixup_unw_records (list, 0);
3126
 
3127
  len = calc_record_size (list);
3128
  /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
3129
  pad = len % md.pointer_size;
3130
  if (pad != 0)
3131
    len += md.pointer_size - pad;
3132
  /* Add 8 for the header.  */
3133
  size = len + 8;
3134
  /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
3135
  if (frag->fr_offset)
3136
    size += md.pointer_size;
3137
 
3138
  /* fr_var carries the max_chars that we created the fragment with.
3139
     We must, of course, have allocated enough memory earlier.  */
3140
  assert (frag->fr_var >= size);
3141
 
3142
  /* Initialize the header area. fr_offset is initialized with
3143
     unwind.personality_routine.  */
3144
  if (frag->fr_offset)
3145
    {
3146
      if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
3147
        flag_value = (bfd_vma) 3 << 32;
3148
      else
3149
        /* 32-bit unwind info block.  */
3150
        flag_value = (bfd_vma) 0x1003 << 32;
3151
    }
3152
  else
3153
    flag_value = 0;
3154
 
3155
 md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal,
3156
                     (((bfd_vma) 1 << 48) /* Version.  */
3157
                      | flag_value        /* U & E handler flags.  */
3158
                      | (len / md.pointer_size)), /* Length.  */
3159
                     8);
3160
 
3161
  /* Skip the header.  */
3162
  vbyte_mem_ptr = frag->fr_literal + 8;
3163
  process_unw_records (list, output_vbyte_mem);
3164
 
3165
  /* Fill the padding bytes with zeros.  */
3166
  if (pad != 0)
3167
    md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal + len + 8 - md.pointer_size + pad, 0,
3168
                        md.pointer_size - pad);
3169
  /* Fill the unwind personality with zeros.  */
3170
  if (frag->fr_offset)
3171
    md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal + size - md.pointer_size, 0,
3172
                        md.pointer_size);
3173
 
3174
  frag->fr_fix += size;
3175
  frag->fr_type = rs_fill;
3176
  frag->fr_var = 0;
3177
  frag->fr_offset = 0;
3178
}
3179
 
3180
static int
3181
parse_predicate_and_operand (e, qp, po)
3182
     expressionS * e;
3183
     unsigned * qp;
3184
     const char * po;
3185
{
3186
  int sep = parse_operand (e, ',');
3187
 
3188
  *qp = e->X_add_number - REG_P;
3189
  if (e->X_op != O_register || *qp > 63)
3190
    {
3191
      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s must be a predicate"), po);
3192
      *qp = 0;
3193
    }
3194
  else if (*qp == 0)
3195
    as_warn (_("Pointless use of p0 as first operand to .%s"), po);
3196
  if (sep == ',')
3197
    sep = parse_operand (e, ',');
3198
  else
3199
    e->X_op = O_absent;
3200
  return sep;
3201
}
3202
 
3203
static void
3204
convert_expr_to_ab_reg (e, ab, regp, po, n)
3205
     const expressionS *e;
3206
     unsigned int *ab;
3207
     unsigned int *regp;
3208
     const char * po;
3209
     int n;
3210
{
3211
  unsigned int reg = e->X_add_number;
3212
 
3213
  *ab = *regp = 0; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3214
 
3215
  if (e->X_op != O_register)
3216
    reg = REG_GR; /* Anything invalid is good here.  */
3217
 
3218
  if (reg >= (REG_GR + 4) && reg <= (REG_GR + 7))
3219
    {
3220
      *ab = 0;
3221
      *regp = reg - REG_GR;
3222
    }
3223
  else if ((reg >= (REG_FR + 2) && reg <= (REG_FR + 5))
3224
           || (reg >= (REG_FR + 16) && reg <= (REG_FR + 31)))
3225
    {
3226
      *ab = 1;
3227
      *regp = reg - REG_FR;
3228
    }
3229
  else if (reg >= (REG_BR + 1) && reg <= (REG_BR + 5))
3230
    {
3231
      *ab = 2;
3232
      *regp = reg - REG_BR;
3233
    }
3234
  else
3235
    {
3236
      *ab = 3;
3237
      switch (reg)
3238
        {
3239
        case REG_PR:            *regp =  0; break;
3240
        case REG_PSP:           *regp =  1; break;
3241
        case REG_PRIUNAT:       *regp =  2; break;
3242
        case REG_BR + 0: *regp =  3; break;
3243
        case REG_AR + AR_BSP:   *regp =  4; break;
3244
        case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE: *regp = 5; break;
3245
        case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:  *regp =  6; break;
3246
        case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:  *regp =  7; break;
3247
        case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:  *regp =  8; break;
3248
        case REG_AR + AR_PFS:   *regp =  9; break;
3249
        case REG_AR + AR_LC:    *regp = 10; break;
3250
 
3251
        default:
3252
          as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a preserved register"), n, po);
3253
          break;
3254
        }
3255
    }
3256
}
3257
 
3258
static void
3259
convert_expr_to_xy_reg (e, xy, regp, po, n)
3260
     const expressionS *e;
3261
     unsigned int *xy;
3262
     unsigned int *regp;
3263
     const char * po;
3264
     int n;
3265
{
3266
  unsigned int reg = e->X_add_number;
3267
 
3268
  *xy = *regp = 0; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3269
 
3270
  if (e->X_op != O_register)
3271
    reg = REG_GR; /* Anything invalid is good here.  */
3272
 
3273
  if (reg >= (REG_GR + 1) && reg <= (REG_GR + 127))
3274
    {
3275
      *xy = 0;
3276
      *regp = reg - REG_GR;
3277
    }
3278
  else if (reg >= (REG_FR + 2) && reg <= (REG_FR + 127))
3279
    {
3280
      *xy = 1;
3281
      *regp = reg - REG_FR;
3282
    }
3283
  else if (reg >= REG_BR && reg <= (REG_BR + 7))
3284
    {
3285
      *xy = 2;
3286
      *regp = reg - REG_BR;
3287
    }
3288
  else
3289
    as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a writable register"), n, po);
3290
}
3291
 
3292
static void
3293
dot_align (int arg)
3294
{
3295
  /* The current frag is an alignment frag.  */
3296
  align_frag = frag_now;
3297
  s_align_bytes (arg);
3298
}
3299
 
3300
static void
3301
dot_radix (dummy)
3302
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3303
{
3304
  char *radix;
3305
  int ch;
3306
 
3307
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
3308
 
3309
  if (is_it_end_of_statement ())
3310
    return;
3311
  radix = input_line_pointer;
3312
  ch = get_symbol_end ();
3313
  ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (radix);
3314
  if (strcasecmp (radix, "C"))
3315
    as_bad (_("Radix `%s' unsupported or invalid"), radix);
3316
  *input_line_pointer = ch;
3317
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3318
}
3319
 
3320
/* Helper function for .loc directives.  If the assembler is not generating
3321
   line number info, then we need to remember which instructions have a .loc
3322
   directive, and only call dwarf2_gen_line_info for those instructions.  */
3323
 
3324
static void
3325
dot_loc (int x)
3326
{
3327
  CURR_SLOT.loc_directive_seen = 1;
3328
  dwarf2_directive_loc (x);
3329
}
3330
 
3331
/* .sbss, .bss etc. are macros that expand into ".section SECNAME".  */
3332
static void
3333
dot_special_section (which)
3334
     int which;
3335
{
3336
  set_section ((char *) special_section_name[which]);
3337
}
3338
 
3339
/* Return -1 for warning and 0 for error.  */
3340
 
3341
static int
3342
unwind_diagnostic (const char * region, const char *directive)
3343
{
3344
  if (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning)
3345
    {
3346
      as_warn (_(".%s outside of %s"), directive, region);
3347
      return -1;
3348
    }
3349
  else
3350
    {
3351
      as_bad (_(".%s outside of %s"), directive, region);
3352
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
3353
      return 0;
3354
    }
3355
}
3356
 
3357
/* Return 1 if a directive is in a procedure, -1 if a directive isn't in
3358
   a procedure but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3359
   a directive isn't in a procedure and the unwind directive check is set
3360
   to error.  */
3361
 
3362
static int
3363
in_procedure (const char *directive)
3364
{
3365
  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym
3366
      && (!unwind.saved_text_seg || strcmp (directive, "endp") == 0))
3367
    return 1;
3368
  return unwind_diagnostic ("procedure", directive);
3369
}
3370
 
3371
/* Return 1 if a directive is in a prologue, -1 if a directive isn't in
3372
   a prologue but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3373
   a directive isn't in a prologue and the unwind directive check is set
3374
   to error.  */
3375
 
3376
static int
3377
in_prologue (const char *directive)
3378
{
3379
  int in = in_procedure (directive);
3380
 
3381
  if (in > 0 && !unwind.prologue)
3382
    in = unwind_diagnostic ("prologue", directive);
3383
  check_pending_save ();
3384
  return in;
3385
}
3386
 
3387
/* Return 1 if a directive is in a body, -1 if a directive isn't in
3388
   a body but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3389
   a directive isn't in a body and the unwind directive check is set
3390
   to error.  */
3391
 
3392
static int
3393
in_body (const char *directive)
3394
{
3395
  int in = in_procedure (directive);
3396
 
3397
  if (in > 0 && !unwind.body)
3398
    in = unwind_diagnostic ("body region", directive);
3399
  return in;
3400
}
3401
 
3402
static void
3403
add_unwind_entry (ptr, sep)
3404
     unw_rec_list *ptr;
3405
     int sep;
3406
{
3407
  if (ptr)
3408
    {
3409
      if (unwind.tail)
3410
        unwind.tail->next = ptr;
3411
      else
3412
        unwind.list = ptr;
3413
      unwind.tail = ptr;
3414
 
3415
      /* The current entry can in fact be a chain of unwind entries.  */
3416
      if (unwind.current_entry == NULL)
3417
        unwind.current_entry = ptr;
3418
    }
3419
 
3420
  /* The current entry can in fact be a chain of unwind entries.  */
3421
  if (unwind.current_entry == NULL)
3422
    unwind.current_entry = ptr;
3423
 
3424
  if (sep == ',')
3425
    {
3426
      /* Parse a tag permitted for the current directive.  */
3427
      int ch;
3428
 
3429
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
3430
      ch = get_symbol_end ();
3431
      /* FIXME: For now, just issue a warning that this isn't implemented.  */
3432
      {
3433
        static int warned;
3434
 
3435
        if (!warned)
3436
          {
3437
            warned = 1;
3438
            as_warn (_("Tags on unwind pseudo-ops aren't supported, yet"));
3439
          }
3440
      }
3441
      *input_line_pointer = ch;
3442
    }
3443
  if (sep != NOT_A_CHAR)
3444
    demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3445
}
3446
 
3447
static void
3448
dot_fframe (dummy)
3449
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3450
{
3451
  expressionS e;
3452
  int sep;
3453
 
3454
  if (!in_prologue ("fframe"))
3455
    return;
3456
 
3457
  sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
3458
 
3459
  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
3460
    {
3461
      as_bad (_("First operand to .fframe must be a constant"));
3462
      e.X_add_number = 0;
3463
    }
3464
  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_f (e.X_add_number), sep);
3465
}
3466
 
3467
static void
3468
dot_vframe (dummy)
3469
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3470
{
3471
  expressionS e;
3472
  unsigned reg;
3473
  int sep;
3474
 
3475
  if (!in_prologue ("vframe"))
3476
    return;
3477
 
3478
  sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
3479
  reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3480
  if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
3481
    {
3482
      as_bad (_("First operand to .vframe must be a general register"));
3483
      reg = 0;
3484
    }
3485
  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_v (), sep);
3486
  if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 2))
3487
    add_unwind_entry (output_psp_gr (reg), NOT_A_CHAR);
3488
  else if (reg != unwind.prologue_gr
3489
                  + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & (-2 << 1)))
3490
    as_warn (_("Operand of .vframe contradicts .prologue"));
3491
}
3492
 
3493
static void
3494
dot_vframesp (psp)
3495
     int psp;
3496
{
3497
  expressionS e;
3498
  int sep;
3499
 
3500
  if (psp)
3501
    as_warn (_(".vframepsp is meaningless, assuming .vframesp was meant"));
3502
 
3503
  if (!in_prologue ("vframesp"))
3504
    return;
3505
 
3506
  sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
3507
  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
3508
    {
3509
      as_bad (_("Operand to .vframesp must be a constant (sp-relative offset)"));
3510
      e.X_add_number = 0;
3511
    }
3512
  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_v (), sep);
3513
  add_unwind_entry (output_psp_sprel (e.X_add_number), NOT_A_CHAR);
3514
}
3515
 
3516
static void
3517
dot_save (dummy)
3518
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3519
{
3520
  expressionS e1, e2;
3521
  unsigned reg1, reg2;
3522
  int sep;
3523
 
3524
  if (!in_prologue ("save"))
3525
    return;
3526
 
3527
  sep = parse_operand (&e1, ',');
3528
  if (sep == ',')
3529
    sep = parse_operand (&e2, ',');
3530
  else
3531
    e2.X_op = O_absent;
3532
 
3533
  reg1 = e1.X_add_number;
3534
  /* Make sure its a valid ar.xxx reg, OR its br0, aka 'rp'.  */
3535
  if (e1.X_op != O_register)
3536
    {
3537
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save not a register"));
3538
      reg1 = REG_PR; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3539
    }
3540
  reg2 = e2.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3541
  if (e2.X_op != O_register || reg2 > 127)
3542
    {
3543
      as_bad (_("Second operand to .save not a valid register"));
3544
      reg2 = 0;
3545
    }
3546
  switch (reg1)
3547
    {
3548
    case REG_AR + AR_BSP:
3549
      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_when (), sep);
3550
      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3551
      break;
3552
    case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE:
3553
      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_when (), sep);
3554
      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3555
      break;
3556
    case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:
3557
      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_when (), sep);
3558
      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3559
      break;
3560
    case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:
3561
      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_when (), sep);
3562
      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3563
      break;
3564
    case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:
3565
      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_when (), sep);
3566
      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3567
      break;
3568
    case REG_AR + AR_PFS:
3569
      add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_when (), sep);
3570
      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 4))
3571
        add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3572
      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr
3573
                       + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & (-4 << 1)))
3574
        as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3575
      break;
3576
    case REG_AR + AR_LC:
3577
      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_when (), sep);
3578
      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3579
      break;
3580
    case REG_BR:
3581
      add_unwind_entry (output_rp_when (), sep);
3582
      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 8))
3583
        add_unwind_entry (output_rp_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3584
      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr)
3585
        as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3586
      break;
3587
    case REG_PR:
3588
      add_unwind_entry (output_preds_when (), sep);
3589
      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 1))
3590
        add_unwind_entry (output_preds_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3591
      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr
3592
                       + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & (-1 << 1)))
3593
        as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3594
      break;
3595
    case REG_PRIUNAT:
3596
      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_when_gr (), sep);
3597
      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3598
      break;
3599
    default:
3600
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save not a valid register"));
3601
      add_unwind_entry (NULL, sep);
3602
      break;
3603
    }
3604
}
3605
 
3606
static void
3607
dot_restore (dummy)
3608
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3609
{
3610
  expressionS e1;
3611
  unsigned long ecount; /* # of _additional_ regions to pop */
3612
  int sep;
3613
 
3614
  if (!in_body ("restore"))
3615
    return;
3616
 
3617
  sep = parse_operand (&e1, ',');
3618
  if (e1.X_op != O_register || e1.X_add_number != REG_GR + 12)
3619
    as_bad (_("First operand to .restore must be stack pointer (sp)"));
3620
 
3621
  if (sep == ',')
3622
    {
3623
      expressionS e2;
3624
 
3625
      sep = parse_operand (&e2, ',');
3626
      if (e2.X_op != O_constant || e2.X_add_number < 0)
3627
        {
3628
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .restore must be a constant >= 0"));
3629
          e2.X_add_number = 0;
3630
        }
3631
      ecount = e2.X_add_number;
3632
    }
3633
  else
3634
    ecount = unwind.prologue_count - 1;
3635
 
3636
  if (ecount >= unwind.prologue_count)
3637
    {
3638
      as_bad (_("Epilogue count of %lu exceeds number of nested prologues (%u)"),
3639
              ecount + 1, unwind.prologue_count);
3640
      ecount = 0;
3641
    }
3642
 
3643
  add_unwind_entry (output_epilogue (ecount), sep);
3644
 
3645
  if (ecount < unwind.prologue_count)
3646
    unwind.prologue_count -= ecount + 1;
3647
  else
3648
    unwind.prologue_count = 0;
3649
}
3650
 
3651
static void
3652
dot_restorereg (pred)
3653
     int pred;
3654
{
3655
  unsigned int qp, ab, reg;
3656
  expressionS e;
3657
  int sep;
3658
  const char * const po = pred ? "restorereg.p" : "restorereg";
3659
 
3660
  if (!in_procedure (po))
3661
    return;
3662
 
3663
  if (pred)
3664
    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
3665
  else
3666
    {
3667
      sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
3668
      qp = 0;
3669
    }
3670
  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
3671
 
3672
  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_reg (ab, reg, 0, 0, qp), sep);
3673
}
3674
 
3675
static char *special_linkonce_name[] =
3676
  {
3677
    ".gnu.linkonce.ia64unw.", ".gnu.linkonce.ia64unwi."
3678
  };
3679
 
3680
static void
3681
start_unwind_section (const segT text_seg, int sec_index)
3682
{
3683
  /*
3684
    Use a slightly ugly scheme to derive the unwind section names from
3685
    the text section name:
3686
 
3687
    text sect.  unwind table sect.
3688
    name:       name:                      comments:
3689
    ----------  -----------------          --------------------------------
3690
    .text       .IA_64.unwind
3691
    .text.foo   .IA_64.unwind.text.foo
3692
    .foo        .IA_64.unwind.foo
3693
    .gnu.linkonce.t.foo
3694
                .gnu.linkonce.ia64unw.foo
3695
    _info       .IA_64.unwind_info         gas issues error message (ditto)
3696
    _infoFOO    .IA_64.unwind_infoFOO      gas issues error message (ditto)
3697
 
3698
    This mapping is done so that:
3699
 
3700
        (a) An object file with unwind info only in .text will use
3701
            unwind section names .IA_64.unwind and .IA_64.unwind_info.
3702
            This follows the letter of the ABI and also ensures backwards
3703
            compatibility with older toolchains.
3704
 
3705
        (b) An object file with unwind info in multiple text sections
3706
            will use separate unwind sections for each text section.
3707
            This allows us to properly set the "sh_info" and "sh_link"
3708
            fields in SHT_IA_64_UNWIND as required by the ABI and also
3709
            lets GNU ld support programs with multiple segments
3710
            containing unwind info (as might be the case for certain
3711
            embedded applications).
3712
 
3713
        (c) An error is issued if there would be a name clash.
3714
  */
3715
 
3716
  const char *text_name, *sec_text_name;
3717
  char *sec_name;
3718
  const char *prefix = special_section_name [sec_index];
3719
  const char *suffix;
3720
  size_t prefix_len, suffix_len, sec_name_len;
3721
 
3722
  sec_text_name = segment_name (text_seg);
3723
  text_name = sec_text_name;
3724
  if (strncmp (text_name, "_info", 5) == 0)
3725
    {
3726
      as_bad (_("Illegal section name `%s' (causes unwind section name clash)"),
3727
              text_name);
3728
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
3729
      return;
3730
    }
3731
  if (strcmp (text_name, ".text") == 0)
3732
    text_name = "";
3733
 
3734
  /* Build the unwind section name by appending the (possibly stripped)
3735
     text section name to the unwind prefix.  */
3736
  suffix = text_name;
3737
  if (strncmp (text_name, ".gnu.linkonce.t.",
3738
               sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.t.") - 1) == 0)
3739
    {
3740
      prefix = special_linkonce_name [sec_index - SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND];
3741
      suffix += sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.t.") - 1;
3742
    }
3743
 
3744
  prefix_len = strlen (prefix);
3745
  suffix_len = strlen (suffix);
3746
  sec_name_len = prefix_len + suffix_len;
3747
  sec_name = alloca (sec_name_len + 1);
3748
  memcpy (sec_name, prefix, prefix_len);
3749
  memcpy (sec_name + prefix_len, suffix, suffix_len);
3750
  sec_name [sec_name_len] = '\0';
3751
 
3752
  /* Handle COMDAT group.  */
3753
  if ((text_seg->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE) != 0
3754
      && (elf_section_flags (text_seg) & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
3755
    {
3756
      char *section;
3757
      size_t len, group_name_len;
3758
      const char *group_name = elf_group_name (text_seg);
3759
 
3760
      if (group_name == NULL)
3761
        {
3762
          as_bad (_("Group section `%s' has no group signature"),
3763
                  sec_text_name);
3764
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
3765
          return;
3766
        }
3767
      /* We have to construct a fake section directive. */
3768
      group_name_len = strlen (group_name);
3769
      len = (sec_name_len
3770
             + 16                       /* ,"aG",@progbits,  */
3771
             + group_name_len           /* ,group_name  */
3772
             + 7);                      /* ,comdat  */
3773
 
3774
      section = alloca (len + 1);
3775
      memcpy (section, sec_name, sec_name_len);
3776
      memcpy (section + sec_name_len, ",\"aG\",@progbits,", 16);
3777
      memcpy (section + sec_name_len + 16, group_name, group_name_len);
3778
      memcpy (section + len - 7, ",comdat", 7);
3779
      section [len] = '\0';
3780
      set_section (section);
3781
    }
3782
  else
3783
    {
3784
      set_section (sec_name);
3785
      bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, now_seg,
3786
                             SEC_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY);
3787
    }
3788
 
3789
  elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) = text_seg;
3790
}
3791
 
3792
static void
3793
generate_unwind_image (const segT text_seg)
3794
{
3795
  int size, pad;
3796
  unw_rec_list *list;
3797
 
3798
  /* Mark the end of the unwind info, so that we can compute the size of the
3799
     last unwind region.  */
3800
  add_unwind_entry (output_endp (), NOT_A_CHAR);
3801
 
3802
  /* Force out pending instructions, to make sure all unwind records have
3803
     a valid slot_number field.  */
3804
  ia64_flush_insns ();
3805
 
3806
  /* Generate the unwind record.  */
3807
  list = optimize_unw_records (unwind.list);
3808
  fixup_unw_records (list, 1);
3809
  size = calc_record_size (list);
3810
 
3811
  if (size > 0 || unwind.force_unwind_entry)
3812
    {
3813
      unwind.force_unwind_entry = 0;
3814
      /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
3815
      pad = size % md.pointer_size;
3816
      if (pad != 0)
3817
        size += md.pointer_size - pad;
3818
      /* Add 8 for the header.  */
3819
      size += 8;
3820
      /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
3821
      if (unwind.personality_routine)
3822
        size += md.pointer_size;
3823
    }
3824
 
3825
  /* If there are unwind records, switch sections, and output the info.  */
3826
  if (size != 0)
3827
    {
3828
      expressionS exp;
3829
      bfd_reloc_code_real_type reloc;
3830
 
3831
      start_unwind_section (text_seg, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO);
3832
 
3833
      /* Make sure the section has 4 byte alignment for ILP32 and
3834
         8 byte alignment for LP64.  */
3835
      frag_align (md.pointer_size_shift, 0, 0);
3836
      record_alignment (now_seg, md.pointer_size_shift);
3837
 
3838
      /* Set expression which points to start of unwind descriptor area.  */
3839
      unwind.info = expr_build_dot ();
3840
 
3841
      frag_var (rs_machine_dependent, size, size, 0, 0,
3842
                (offsetT) (long) unwind.personality_routine,
3843
                (char *) list);
3844
 
3845
      /* Add the personality address to the image.  */
3846
      if (unwind.personality_routine != 0)
3847
        {
3848
          exp.X_op = O_symbol;
3849
          exp.X_add_symbol = unwind.personality_routine;
3850
          exp.X_add_number = 0;
3851
 
3852
          if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_BE)
3853
            {
3854
              if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
3855
                reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64MSB;
3856
              else
3857
                reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32MSB;
3858
            }
3859
          else
3860
            {
3861
              if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
3862
                reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64LSB;
3863
              else
3864
                reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32LSB;
3865
            }
3866
 
3867
          fix_new_exp (frag_now, frag_now_fix () - md.pointer_size,
3868
                       md.pointer_size, &exp, 0, reloc);
3869
          unwind.personality_routine = 0;
3870
        }
3871
    }
3872
 
3873
  free_saved_prologue_counts ();
3874
  unwind.list = unwind.tail = unwind.current_entry = NULL;
3875
}
3876
 
3877
static void
3878
dot_handlerdata (dummy)
3879
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3880
{
3881
  if (!in_procedure ("handlerdata"))
3882
    return;
3883
  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
3884
 
3885
  /* Remember which segment we're in so we can switch back after .endp */
3886
  unwind.saved_text_seg = now_seg;
3887
  unwind.saved_text_subseg = now_subseg;
3888
 
3889
  /* Generate unwind info into unwind-info section and then leave that
3890
     section as the currently active one so dataXX directives go into
3891
     the language specific data area of the unwind info block.  */
3892
  generate_unwind_image (now_seg);
3893
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3894
}
3895
 
3896
static void
3897
dot_unwentry (dummy)
3898
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3899
{
3900
  if (!in_procedure ("unwentry"))
3901
    return;
3902
  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
3903
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3904
}
3905
 
3906
static void
3907
dot_altrp (dummy)
3908
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3909
{
3910
  expressionS e;
3911
  unsigned reg;
3912
 
3913
  if (!in_prologue ("altrp"))
3914
    return;
3915
 
3916
  parse_operand (&e, 0);
3917
  reg = e.X_add_number - REG_BR;
3918
  if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 7)
3919
    {
3920
      as_bad (_("First operand to .altrp not a valid branch register"));
3921
      reg = 0;
3922
    }
3923
  add_unwind_entry (output_rp_br (reg), 0);
3924
}
3925
 
3926
static void
3927
dot_savemem (psprel)
3928
     int psprel;
3929
{
3930
  expressionS e1, e2;
3931
  int sep;
3932
  int reg1, val;
3933
  const char * const po = psprel ? "savepsp" : "savesp";
3934
 
3935
  if (!in_prologue (po))
3936
    return;
3937
 
3938
  sep = parse_operand (&e1, ',');
3939
  if (sep == ',')
3940
    sep = parse_operand (&e2, ',');
3941
  else
3942
    e2.X_op = O_absent;
3943
 
3944
  reg1 = e1.X_add_number;
3945
  val = e2.X_add_number;
3946
 
3947
  /* Make sure its a valid ar.xxx reg, OR its br0, aka 'rp'.  */
3948
  if (e1.X_op != O_register)
3949
    {
3950
      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s not a register"), po);
3951
      reg1 = REG_PR; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3952
    }
3953
  if (e2.X_op != O_constant)
3954
    {
3955
      as_bad (_("Second operand to .%s not a constant"), po);
3956
      val = 0;
3957
    }
3958
 
3959
  switch (reg1)
3960
    {
3961
    case REG_AR + AR_BSP:
3962
      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_when (), sep);
3963
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3964
                         ? output_bsp_psprel
3965
                         : output_bsp_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3966
      break;
3967
    case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE:
3968
      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_when (), sep);
3969
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3970
                         ? output_bspstore_psprel
3971
                         : output_bspstore_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3972
      break;
3973
    case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:
3974
      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_when (), sep);
3975
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3976
                         ? output_rnat_psprel
3977
                         : output_rnat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3978
      break;
3979
    case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:
3980
      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_when (), sep);
3981
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3982
                         ? output_unat_psprel
3983
                         : output_unat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3984
      break;
3985
    case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:
3986
      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_when (), sep);
3987
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3988
                         ? output_fpsr_psprel
3989
                         : output_fpsr_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3990
      break;
3991
    case REG_AR + AR_PFS:
3992
      add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_when (), sep);
3993
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3994
                         ? output_pfs_psprel
3995
                         : output_pfs_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3996
      break;
3997
    case REG_AR + AR_LC:
3998
      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_when (), sep);
3999
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
4000
                         ? output_lc_psprel
4001
                         : output_lc_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
4002
      break;
4003
    case REG_BR:
4004
      add_unwind_entry (output_rp_when (), sep);
4005
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
4006
                         ? output_rp_psprel
4007
                         : output_rp_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
4008
      break;
4009
    case REG_PR:
4010
      add_unwind_entry (output_preds_when (), sep);
4011
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
4012
                         ? output_preds_psprel
4013
                         : output_preds_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
4014
      break;
4015
    case REG_PRIUNAT:
4016
      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_when_mem (), sep);
4017
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
4018
                         ? output_priunat_psprel
4019
                         : output_priunat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
4020
      break;
4021
    default:
4022
      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s not a valid register"), po);
4023
      add_unwind_entry (NULL, sep);
4024
      break;
4025
    }
4026
}
4027
 
4028
static void
4029
dot_saveg (dummy)
4030
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4031
{
4032
  expressionS e;
4033
  unsigned grmask;
4034
  int sep;
4035
 
4036
  if (!in_prologue ("save.g"))
4037
    return;
4038
 
4039
  sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
4040
 
4041
  grmask = e.X_add_number;
4042
  if (e.X_op != O_constant
4043
      || e.X_add_number <= 0
4044
      || e.X_add_number > 0xf)
4045
    {
4046
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.g must be a positive 4-bit constant"));
4047
      grmask = 0;
4048
    }
4049
 
4050
  if (sep == ',')
4051
    {
4052
      unsigned reg;
4053
      int n = popcount (grmask);
4054
 
4055
      parse_operand (&e, 0);
4056
      reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
4057
      if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
4058
        {
4059
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.g must be a general register"));
4060
          reg = 0;
4061
        }
4062
      else if (reg > 128U - n)
4063
        {
4064
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.g must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
4065
          reg = 0;
4066
        }
4067
      add_unwind_entry (output_gr_gr (grmask, reg), 0);
4068
    }
4069
  else
4070
    add_unwind_entry (output_gr_mem (grmask), 0);
4071
}
4072
 
4073
static void
4074
dot_savef (dummy)
4075
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4076
{
4077
  expressionS e;
4078
 
4079
  if (!in_prologue ("save.f"))
4080
    return;
4081
 
4082
  parse_operand (&e, 0);
4083
 
4084
  if (e.X_op != O_constant
4085
      || e.X_add_number <= 0
4086
      || e.X_add_number > 0xfffff)
4087
    {
4088
      as_bad (_("Operand to .save.f must be a positive 20-bit constant"));
4089
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4090
    }
4091
  add_unwind_entry (output_fr_mem (e.X_add_number), 0);
4092
}
4093
 
4094
static void
4095
dot_saveb (dummy)
4096
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4097
{
4098
  expressionS e;
4099
  unsigned brmask;
4100
  int sep;
4101
 
4102
  if (!in_prologue ("save.b"))
4103
    return;
4104
 
4105
  sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
4106
 
4107
  brmask = e.X_add_number;
4108
  if (e.X_op != O_constant
4109
      || e.X_add_number <= 0
4110
      || e.X_add_number > 0x1f)
4111
    {
4112
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.b must be a positive 5-bit constant"));
4113
      brmask = 0;
4114
    }
4115
 
4116
  if (sep == ',')
4117
    {
4118
      unsigned reg;
4119
      int n = popcount (brmask);
4120
 
4121
      parse_operand (&e, 0);
4122
      reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
4123
      if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
4124
        {
4125
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.b must be a general register"));
4126
          reg = 0;
4127
        }
4128
      else if (reg > 128U - n)
4129
        {
4130
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.b must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
4131
          reg = 0;
4132
        }
4133
      add_unwind_entry (output_br_gr (brmask, reg), 0);
4134
    }
4135
  else
4136
    add_unwind_entry (output_br_mem (brmask), 0);
4137
}
4138
 
4139
static void
4140
dot_savegf (dummy)
4141
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4142
{
4143
  expressionS e1, e2;
4144
 
4145
  if (!in_prologue ("save.gf"))
4146
    return;
4147
 
4148
  if (parse_operand (&e1, ',') == ',')
4149
    parse_operand (&e2, 0);
4150
  else
4151
    e2.X_op = O_absent;
4152
 
4153
  if (e1.X_op != O_constant
4154
      || e1.X_add_number < 0
4155
      || e1.X_add_number > 0xf)
4156
    {
4157
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.gf must be a non-negative 4-bit constant"));
4158
      e1.X_op = O_absent;
4159
      e1.X_add_number = 0;
4160
    }
4161
  if (e2.X_op != O_constant
4162
      || e2.X_add_number < 0
4163
      || e2.X_add_number > 0xfffff)
4164
    {
4165
      as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.gf must be a non-negative 20-bit constant"));
4166
      e2.X_op = O_absent;
4167
      e2.X_add_number = 0;
4168
    }
4169
  if (e1.X_op == O_constant
4170
      && e2.X_op == O_constant
4171
      && e1.X_add_number == 0
4172
      && e2.X_add_number == 0)
4173
    as_bad (_("Operands to .save.gf may not be both zero"));
4174
 
4175
  add_unwind_entry (output_frgr_mem (e1.X_add_number, e2.X_add_number), 0);
4176
}
4177
 
4178
static void
4179
dot_spill (dummy)
4180
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4181
{
4182
  expressionS e;
4183
 
4184
  if (!in_prologue ("spill"))
4185
    return;
4186
 
4187
  parse_operand (&e, 0);
4188
 
4189
  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
4190
    {
4191
      as_bad (_("Operand to .spill must be a constant"));
4192
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4193
    }
4194
  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_base (e.X_add_number), 0);
4195
}
4196
 
4197
static void
4198
dot_spillreg (pred)
4199
     int pred;
4200
{
4201
  int sep;
4202
  unsigned int qp, ab, xy, reg, treg;
4203
  expressionS e;
4204
  const char * const po = pred ? "spillreg.p" : "spillreg";
4205
 
4206
  if (!in_procedure (po))
4207
    return;
4208
 
4209
  if (pred)
4210
    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
4211
  else
4212
    {
4213
      sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
4214
      qp = 0;
4215
    }
4216
  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
4217
 
4218
  if (sep == ',')
4219
    sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
4220
  else
4221
    e.X_op = O_absent;
4222
  convert_expr_to_xy_reg (&e, &xy, &treg, po, 2 + pred);
4223
 
4224
  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_reg (ab, reg, treg, xy, qp), sep);
4225
}
4226
 
4227
static void
4228
dot_spillmem (psprel)
4229
     int psprel;
4230
{
4231
  expressionS e;
4232
  int pred = (psprel < 0), sep;
4233
  unsigned int qp, ab, reg;
4234
  const char * po;
4235
 
4236
  if (pred)
4237
    {
4238
      psprel = ~psprel;
4239
      po = psprel ? "spillpsp.p" : "spillsp.p";
4240
    }
4241
  else
4242
    po = psprel ? "spillpsp" : "spillsp";
4243
 
4244
  if (!in_procedure (po))
4245
    return;
4246
 
4247
  if (pred)
4248
    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
4249
  else
4250
    {
4251
      sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
4252
      qp = 0;
4253
    }
4254
  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
4255
 
4256
  if (sep == ',')
4257
    sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
4258
  else
4259
    e.X_op = O_absent;
4260
  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
4261
    {
4262
      as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a constant"), 2 + pred, po);
4263
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4264
    }
4265
 
4266
  if (psprel)
4267
    add_unwind_entry (output_spill_psprel (ab, reg, e.X_add_number, qp), sep);
4268
  else
4269
    add_unwind_entry (output_spill_sprel (ab, reg, e.X_add_number, qp), sep);
4270
}
4271
 
4272
static unsigned int
4273
get_saved_prologue_count (lbl)
4274
     unsigned long lbl;
4275
{
4276
  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4277
 
4278
  while (lpc != NULL && lpc->label_number != lbl)
4279
    lpc = lpc->next;
4280
 
4281
  if (lpc != NULL)
4282
    return lpc->prologue_count;
4283
 
4284
  as_bad (_("Missing .label_state %ld"), lbl);
4285
  return 1;
4286
}
4287
 
4288
static void
4289
save_prologue_count (lbl, count)
4290
     unsigned long lbl;
4291
     unsigned int count;
4292
{
4293
  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4294
 
4295
  while (lpc != NULL && lpc->label_number != lbl)
4296
    lpc = lpc->next;
4297
 
4298
  if (lpc != NULL)
4299
    lpc->prologue_count = count;
4300
  else
4301
    {
4302
      label_prologue_count *new_lpc = xmalloc (sizeof (* new_lpc));
4303
 
4304
      new_lpc->next = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4305
      new_lpc->label_number = lbl;
4306
      new_lpc->prologue_count = count;
4307
      unwind.saved_prologue_counts = new_lpc;
4308
    }
4309
}
4310
 
4311
static void
4312
free_saved_prologue_counts ()
4313
{
4314
  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4315
  label_prologue_count *next;
4316
 
4317
  while (lpc != NULL)
4318
    {
4319
      next = lpc->next;
4320
      free (lpc);
4321
      lpc = next;
4322
    }
4323
 
4324
  unwind.saved_prologue_counts = NULL;
4325
}
4326
 
4327
static void
4328
dot_label_state (dummy)
4329
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4330
{
4331
  expressionS e;
4332
 
4333
  if (!in_body ("label_state"))
4334
    return;
4335
 
4336
  parse_operand (&e, 0);
4337
  if (e.X_op == O_constant)
4338
    save_prologue_count (e.X_add_number, unwind.prologue_count);
4339
  else
4340
    {
4341
      as_bad (_("Operand to .label_state must be a constant"));
4342
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4343
    }
4344
  add_unwind_entry (output_label_state (e.X_add_number), 0);
4345
}
4346
 
4347
static void
4348
dot_copy_state (dummy)
4349
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4350
{
4351
  expressionS e;
4352
 
4353
  if (!in_body ("copy_state"))
4354
    return;
4355
 
4356
  parse_operand (&e, 0);
4357
  if (e.X_op == O_constant)
4358
    unwind.prologue_count = get_saved_prologue_count (e.X_add_number);
4359
  else
4360
    {
4361
      as_bad (_("Operand to .copy_state must be a constant"));
4362
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4363
    }
4364
  add_unwind_entry (output_copy_state (e.X_add_number), 0);
4365
}
4366
 
4367
static void
4368
dot_unwabi (dummy)
4369
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4370
{
4371
  expressionS e1, e2;
4372
  unsigned char sep;
4373
 
4374
  if (!in_prologue ("unwabi"))
4375
    return;
4376
 
4377
  sep = parse_operand (&e1, ',');
4378
  if (sep == ',')
4379
    parse_operand (&e2, 0);
4380
  else
4381
    e2.X_op = O_absent;
4382
 
4383
  if (e1.X_op != O_constant)
4384
    {
4385
      as_bad (_("First operand to .unwabi must be a constant"));
4386
      e1.X_add_number = 0;
4387
    }
4388
 
4389
  if (e2.X_op != O_constant)
4390
    {
4391
      as_bad (_("Second operand to .unwabi must be a constant"));
4392
      e2.X_add_number = 0;
4393
    }
4394
 
4395
  add_unwind_entry (output_unwabi (e1.X_add_number, e2.X_add_number), 0);
4396
}
4397
 
4398
static void
4399
dot_personality (dummy)
4400
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4401
{
4402
  char *name, *p, c;
4403
  if (!in_procedure ("personality"))
4404
    return;
4405
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4406
  name = input_line_pointer;
4407
  c = get_symbol_end ();
4408
  p = input_line_pointer;
4409
  unwind.personality_routine = symbol_find_or_make (name);
4410
  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
4411
  *p = c;
4412
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4413
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4414
}
4415
 
4416
static void
4417
dot_proc (dummy)
4418
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4419
{
4420
  char *name, *p, c;
4421
  symbolS *sym;
4422
  proc_pending *pending, *last_pending;
4423
 
4424
  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4425
    {
4426
      (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning
4427
       ? as_warn
4428
       : as_bad) (_("Missing .endp after previous .proc"));
4429
      while (unwind.proc_pending.next)
4430
        {
4431
          pending = unwind.proc_pending.next;
4432
          unwind.proc_pending.next = pending->next;
4433
          free (pending);
4434
        }
4435
    }
4436
  last_pending = NULL;
4437
 
4438
  /* Parse names of main and alternate entry points and mark them as
4439
     function symbols:  */
4440
  while (1)
4441
    {
4442
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4443
      name = input_line_pointer;
4444
      c = get_symbol_end ();
4445
      p = input_line_pointer;
4446
      if (!*name)
4447
        as_bad (_("Empty argument of .proc"));
4448
      else
4449
        {
4450
          sym = symbol_find_or_make (name);
4451
          if (S_IS_DEFINED (sym))
4452
            as_bad (_("`%s' was already defined"), name);
4453
          else if (!last_pending)
4454
            {
4455
              unwind.proc_pending.sym = sym;
4456
              last_pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4457
            }
4458
          else
4459
            {
4460
              pending = xmalloc (sizeof (*pending));
4461
              pending->sym = sym;
4462
              last_pending = last_pending->next = pending;
4463
            }
4464
          symbol_get_bfdsym (sym)->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
4465
        }
4466
      *p = c;
4467
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4468
      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4469
        break;
4470
      ++input_line_pointer;
4471
    }
4472
  if (!last_pending)
4473
    {
4474
      unwind.proc_pending.sym = expr_build_dot ();
4475
      last_pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4476
    }
4477
  last_pending->next = NULL;
4478
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4479
  ia64_do_align (16);
4480
 
4481
  unwind.prologue = 0;
4482
  unwind.prologue_count = 0;
4483
  unwind.body = 0;
4484
  unwind.insn = 0;
4485
  unwind.list = unwind.tail = unwind.current_entry = NULL;
4486
  unwind.personality_routine = 0;
4487
}
4488
 
4489
static void
4490
dot_body (dummy)
4491
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4492
{
4493
  if (!in_procedure ("body"))
4494
    return;
4495
  if (!unwind.prologue && !unwind.body && unwind.insn)
4496
    as_warn (_("Initial .body should precede any instructions"));
4497
  check_pending_save ();
4498
 
4499
  unwind.prologue = 0;
4500
  unwind.prologue_mask = 0;
4501
  unwind.body = 1;
4502
 
4503
  add_unwind_entry (output_body (), 0);
4504
}
4505
 
4506
static void
4507
dot_prologue (dummy)
4508
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4509
{
4510
  unsigned mask = 0, grsave = 0;
4511
 
4512
  if (!in_procedure ("prologue"))
4513
    return;
4514
  if (unwind.prologue)
4515
    {
4516
      as_bad (_(".prologue within prologue"));
4517
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4518
      return;
4519
    }
4520
  if (!unwind.body && unwind.insn)
4521
    as_warn (_("Initial .prologue should precede any instructions"));
4522
 
4523
  if (!is_it_end_of_statement ())
4524
    {
4525
      expressionS e;
4526
      int n, sep = parse_operand (&e, ',');
4527
 
4528
      if (e.X_op != O_constant
4529
          || e.X_add_number < 0
4530
          || e.X_add_number > 0xf)
4531
        as_bad (_("First operand to .prologue must be a positive 4-bit constant"));
4532
      else if (e.X_add_number == 0)
4533
        as_warn (_("Pointless use of zero first operand to .prologue"));
4534
      else
4535
        mask = e.X_add_number;
4536
        n = popcount (mask);
4537
 
4538
      if (sep == ',')
4539
        parse_operand (&e, 0);
4540
      else
4541
        e.X_op = O_absent;
4542
      if (e.X_op == O_constant
4543
          && e.X_add_number >= 0
4544
          && e.X_add_number < 128)
4545
        {
4546
          if (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_error)
4547
            as_warn (_("Using a constant as second operand to .prologue is deprecated"));
4548
          grsave = e.X_add_number;
4549
        }
4550
      else if (e.X_op != O_register
4551
               || (grsave = e.X_add_number - REG_GR) > 127)
4552
        {
4553
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .prologue must be a general register"));
4554
          grsave = 0;
4555
        }
4556
      else if (grsave > 128U - n)
4557
        {
4558
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .prologue must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
4559
          grsave = 0;
4560
        }
4561
 
4562
    }
4563
 
4564
  if (mask)
4565
    add_unwind_entry (output_prologue_gr (mask, grsave), 0);
4566
  else
4567
    add_unwind_entry (output_prologue (), 0);
4568
 
4569
  unwind.prologue = 1;
4570
  unwind.prologue_mask = mask;
4571
  unwind.prologue_gr = grsave;
4572
  unwind.body = 0;
4573
  ++unwind.prologue_count;
4574
}
4575
 
4576
static void
4577
dot_endp (dummy)
4578
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4579
{
4580
  expressionS e;
4581
  int bytes_per_address;
4582
  long where;
4583
  segT saved_seg;
4584
  subsegT saved_subseg;
4585
  proc_pending *pending;
4586
  int unwind_check = md.unwind_check;
4587
 
4588
  md.unwind_check = unwind_check_error;
4589
  if (!in_procedure ("endp"))
4590
    return;
4591
  md.unwind_check = unwind_check;
4592
 
4593
  if (unwind.saved_text_seg)
4594
    {
4595
      saved_seg = unwind.saved_text_seg;
4596
      saved_subseg = unwind.saved_text_subseg;
4597
      unwind.saved_text_seg = NULL;
4598
    }
4599
  else
4600
    {
4601
      saved_seg = now_seg;
4602
      saved_subseg = now_subseg;
4603
    }
4604
 
4605
  insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4606
 
4607
  /* If there wasn't a .handlerdata, we haven't generated an image yet.  */
4608
  if (!unwind.info)
4609
    generate_unwind_image (saved_seg);
4610
 
4611
  if (unwind.info || unwind.force_unwind_entry)
4612
    {
4613
      symbolS *proc_end;
4614
 
4615
      subseg_set (md.last_text_seg, 0);
4616
      proc_end = expr_build_dot ();
4617
 
4618
      start_unwind_section (saved_seg, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND);
4619
 
4620
      /* Make sure that section has 4 byte alignment for ILP32 and
4621
         8 byte alignment for LP64.  */
4622
      record_alignment (now_seg, md.pointer_size_shift);
4623
 
4624
      /* Need space for 3 pointers for procedure start, procedure end,
4625
         and unwind info.  */
4626
      memset (frag_more (3 * md.pointer_size), 0, 3 * md.pointer_size);
4627
      where = frag_now_fix () - (3 * md.pointer_size);
4628
      bytes_per_address = bfd_arch_bits_per_address (stdoutput) / 8;
4629
 
4630
      /* Issue the values of  a) Proc Begin, b) Proc End, c) Unwind Record.  */
4631
      e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4632
      e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4633
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4634
      if (!S_IS_LOCAL (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4635
          && S_IS_DEFINED (unwind.proc_pending.sym))
4636
        e.X_add_symbol = symbol_temp_new (S_GET_SEGMENT (unwind.proc_pending.sym),
4637
                                          S_GET_VALUE (unwind.proc_pending.sym),
4638
                                          symbol_get_frag (unwind.proc_pending.sym));
4639
      else
4640
        e.X_add_symbol = unwind.proc_pending.sym;
4641
      ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where, bytes_per_address, &e);
4642
 
4643
      e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4644
      e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4645
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4646
      e.X_add_symbol = proc_end;
4647
      ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where + bytes_per_address,
4648
                         bytes_per_address, &e);
4649
 
4650
      if (unwind.info)
4651
        {
4652
          e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4653
          e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4654
          e.X_add_number = 0;
4655
          e.X_add_symbol = unwind.info;
4656
          ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where + (bytes_per_address * 2),
4657
                             bytes_per_address, &e);
4658
        }
4659
    }
4660
  subseg_set (saved_seg, saved_subseg);
4661
 
4662
  /* Set symbol sizes.  */
4663
  pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4664
  if (S_GET_NAME (pending->sym))
4665
    {
4666
      do
4667
        {
4668
          symbolS *sym = pending->sym;
4669
 
4670
          if (!S_IS_DEFINED (sym))
4671
            as_bad (_("`%s' was not defined within procedure"), S_GET_NAME (sym));
4672
          else if (S_GET_SIZE (sym) == 0
4673
                   && symbol_get_obj (sym)->size == NULL)
4674
            {
4675
              fragS *frag = symbol_get_frag (sym);
4676
 
4677
              if (frag)
4678
                {
4679
                  if (frag == frag_now && SEG_NORMAL (now_seg))
4680
                    S_SET_SIZE (sym, frag_now_fix () - S_GET_VALUE (sym));
4681
                  else
4682
                    {
4683
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size =
4684
                        (expressionS *) xmalloc (sizeof (expressionS));
4685
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_op = O_subtract;
4686
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_add_symbol
4687
                        = symbol_new (FAKE_LABEL_NAME, now_seg,
4688
                                      frag_now_fix (), frag_now);
4689
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_op_symbol = sym;
4690
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_add_number = 0;
4691
                    }
4692
                }
4693
            }
4694
        } while ((pending = pending->next) != NULL);
4695
    }
4696
 
4697
  /* Parse names of main and alternate entry points.  */
4698
  while (1)
4699
    {
4700
      char *name, *p, c;
4701
 
4702
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4703
      name = input_line_pointer;
4704
      c = get_symbol_end ();
4705
      p = input_line_pointer;
4706
      if (!*name)
4707
        (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning
4708
         ? as_warn
4709
         : as_bad) (_("Empty argument of .endp"));
4710
      else
4711
        {
4712
          symbolS *sym = symbol_find (name);
4713
 
4714
          for (pending = &unwind.proc_pending; pending; pending = pending->next)
4715
            {
4716
              if (sym == pending->sym)
4717
                {
4718
                  pending->sym = NULL;
4719
                  break;
4720
                }
4721
            }
4722
          if (!sym || !pending)
4723
            as_warn (_("`%s' was not specified with previous .proc"), name);
4724
        }
4725
      *p = c;
4726
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4727
      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4728
        break;
4729
      ++input_line_pointer;
4730
    }
4731
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4732
 
4733
  /* Deliberately only checking for the main entry point here; the
4734
     language spec even says all arguments to .endp are ignored.  */
4735
  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym
4736
      && S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4737
      && strcmp (S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym), FAKE_LABEL_NAME))
4738
    as_warn (_("`%s' should be an operand to this .endp"),
4739
             S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym));
4740
  while (unwind.proc_pending.next)
4741
    {
4742
      pending = unwind.proc_pending.next;
4743
      unwind.proc_pending.next = pending->next;
4744
      free (pending);
4745
    }
4746
  unwind.proc_pending.sym = unwind.info = NULL;
4747
}
4748
 
4749
static void
4750
dot_template (template)
4751
     int template;
4752
{
4753
  CURR_SLOT.user_template = template;
4754
}
4755
 
4756
static void
4757
dot_regstk (dummy)
4758
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4759
{
4760
  int ins, locs, outs, rots;
4761
 
4762
  if (is_it_end_of_statement ())
4763
    ins = locs = outs = rots = 0;
4764
  else
4765
    {
4766
      ins = get_absolute_expression ();
4767
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4768
        goto err;
4769
      locs = get_absolute_expression ();
4770
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4771
        goto err;
4772
      outs = get_absolute_expression ();
4773
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4774
        goto err;
4775
      rots = get_absolute_expression ();
4776
    }
4777
  set_regstack (ins, locs, outs, rots);
4778
  return;
4779
 
4780
 err:
4781
  as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
4782
  ignore_rest_of_line ();
4783
}
4784
 
4785
static void
4786
dot_rot (type)
4787
     int type;
4788
{
4789
  offsetT num_regs;
4790
  valueT num_alloced = 0;
4791
  struct dynreg **drpp, *dr;
4792
  int ch, base_reg = 0;
4793
  char *name, *start;
4794
  size_t len;
4795
 
4796
  switch (type)
4797
    {
4798
    case DYNREG_GR: base_reg = REG_GR + 32; break;
4799
    case DYNREG_FR: base_reg = REG_FR + 32; break;
4800
    case DYNREG_PR: base_reg = REG_P + 16; break;
4801
    default: break;
4802
    }
4803
 
4804
  /* First, remove existing names from hash table.  */
4805
  for (dr = md.dynreg[type]; dr && dr->num_regs; dr = dr->next)
4806
    {
4807
      hash_delete (md.dynreg_hash, dr->name);
4808
      /* FIXME: Free dr->name.  */
4809
      dr->num_regs = 0;
4810
    }
4811
 
4812
  drpp = &md.dynreg[type];
4813
  while (1)
4814
    {
4815
      start = input_line_pointer;
4816
      ch = get_symbol_end ();
4817
      len = strlen (ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (start));
4818
      *input_line_pointer = ch;
4819
 
4820
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4821
      if (*input_line_pointer != '[')
4822
        {
4823
          as_bad (_("Expected '['"));
4824
          goto err;
4825
        }
4826
      ++input_line_pointer;     /* skip '[' */
4827
 
4828
      num_regs = get_absolute_expression ();
4829
 
4830
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ']')
4831
        {
4832
          as_bad (_("Expected ']'"));
4833
          goto err;
4834
        }
4835
      if (num_regs <= 0)
4836
        {
4837
          as_bad (_("Number of elements must be positive"));
4838
          goto err;
4839
        }
4840
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4841
 
4842
      num_alloced += num_regs;
4843
      switch (type)
4844
        {
4845
        case DYNREG_GR:
4846
          if (num_alloced > md.rot.num_regs)
4847
            {
4848
              as_bad (_("Used more than the declared %d rotating registers"),
4849
                      md.rot.num_regs);
4850
              goto err;
4851
            }
4852
          break;
4853
        case DYNREG_FR:
4854
          if (num_alloced > 96)
4855
            {
4856
              as_bad (_("Used more than the available 96 rotating registers"));
4857
              goto err;
4858
            }
4859
          break;
4860
        case DYNREG_PR:
4861
          if (num_alloced > 48)
4862
            {
4863
              as_bad (_("Used more than the available 48 rotating registers"));
4864
              goto err;
4865
            }
4866
          break;
4867
 
4868
        default:
4869
          break;
4870
        }
4871
 
4872
      if (!*drpp)
4873
        {
4874
          *drpp = obstack_alloc (&notes, sizeof (*dr));
4875
          memset (*drpp, 0, sizeof (*dr));
4876
        }
4877
 
4878
      name = obstack_alloc (&notes, len + 1);
4879
      memcpy (name, start, len);
4880
      name[len] = '\0';
4881
 
4882
      dr = *drpp;
4883
      dr->name = name;
4884
      dr->num_regs = num_regs;
4885
      dr->base = base_reg;
4886
      drpp = &dr->next;
4887
      base_reg += num_regs;
4888
 
4889
      if (hash_insert (md.dynreg_hash, name, dr))
4890
        {
4891
          as_bad (_("Attempt to redefine register set `%s'"), name);
4892
          obstack_free (&notes, name);
4893
          goto err;
4894
        }
4895
 
4896
      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4897
        break;
4898
      ++input_line_pointer;     /* skip comma */
4899
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4900
    }
4901
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4902
  return;
4903
 
4904
 err:
4905
  ignore_rest_of_line ();
4906
}
4907
 
4908
static void
4909
dot_byteorder (byteorder)
4910
     int byteorder;
4911
{
4912
  segment_info_type *seginfo = seg_info (now_seg);
4913
 
4914
  if (byteorder == -1)
4915
    {
4916
      if (seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian == 0)
4917
        seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian = default_big_endian ? 1 : 2;
4918
      byteorder = seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian == 1;
4919
    }
4920
  else
4921
    seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian = byteorder ? 1 : 2;
4922
 
4923
  if (target_big_endian != byteorder)
4924
    {
4925
      target_big_endian = byteorder;
4926
      if (target_big_endian)
4927
        {
4928
          ia64_number_to_chars = number_to_chars_bigendian;
4929
          ia64_float_to_chars = ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian;
4930
        }
4931
      else
4932
        {
4933
          ia64_number_to_chars = number_to_chars_littleendian;
4934
          ia64_float_to_chars = ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian;
4935
        }
4936
    }
4937
}
4938
 
4939
static void
4940
dot_psr (dummy)
4941
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4942
{
4943
  char *option;
4944
  int ch;
4945
 
4946
  while (1)
4947
    {
4948
      option = input_line_pointer;
4949
      ch = get_symbol_end ();
4950
      if (strcmp (option, "lsb") == 0)
4951
        md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_BE;
4952
      else if (strcmp (option, "msb") == 0)
4953
        md.flags |= EF_IA_64_BE;
4954
      else if (strcmp (option, "abi32") == 0)
4955
        md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_ABI64;
4956
      else if (strcmp (option, "abi64") == 0)
4957
        md.flags |= EF_IA_64_ABI64;
4958
      else
4959
        as_bad (_("Unknown psr option `%s'"), option);
4960
      *input_line_pointer = ch;
4961
 
4962
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4963
      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4964
        break;
4965
 
4966
      ++input_line_pointer;
4967
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4968
    }
4969
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4970
}
4971
 
4972
static void
4973
dot_ln (dummy)
4974
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
4975
{
4976
  new_logical_line (0, get_absolute_expression ());
4977
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4978
}
4979
 
4980
static void
4981
cross_section (ref, cons, ua)
4982
     int ref;
4983
     void (*cons) PARAMS((int));
4984
     int ua;
4985
{
4986
  char *start, *end;
4987
  int saved_auto_align;
4988
  unsigned int section_count;
4989
 
4990
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4991
  start = input_line_pointer;
4992
  if (*start == '"')
4993
    {
4994
      int len;
4995
      char *name;
4996
 
4997
      name = demand_copy_C_string (&len);
4998
      obstack_free(&notes, name);
4999
      if (!name)
5000
        {
5001
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
5002
          return;
5003
        }
5004
    }
5005
  else
5006
    {
5007
      char c = get_symbol_end ();
5008
 
5009
      if (input_line_pointer == start)
5010
        {
5011
          as_bad (_("Missing section name"));
5012
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
5013
          return;
5014
        }
5015
      *input_line_pointer = c;
5016
    }
5017
  end = input_line_pointer;
5018
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5019
  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
5020
    {
5021
      as_bad (_("Comma expected after section name"));
5022
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
5023
      return;
5024
    }
5025
  *end = '\0';
5026
  end = input_line_pointer + 1;         /* skip comma */
5027
  input_line_pointer = start;
5028
  md.keep_pending_output = 1;
5029
  section_count = bfd_count_sections(stdoutput);
5030
  obj_elf_section (0);
5031
  if (section_count != bfd_count_sections(stdoutput))
5032
    as_warn (_("Creating sections with .xdataN/.xrealN/.xstringZ is deprecated."));
5033
  input_line_pointer = end;
5034
  saved_auto_align = md.auto_align;
5035
  if (ua)
5036
    md.auto_align = 0;
5037
  (*cons) (ref);
5038
  if (ua)
5039
    md.auto_align = saved_auto_align;
5040
  obj_elf_previous (0);
5041
  md.keep_pending_output = 0;
5042
}
5043
 
5044
static void
5045
dot_xdata (size)
5046
     int size;
5047
{
5048
  cross_section (size, cons, 0);
5049
}
5050
 
5051
/* Why doesn't float_cons() call md_cons_align() the way cons() does?  */
5052
 
5053
static void
5054
stmt_float_cons (kind)
5055
     int kind;
5056
{
5057
  size_t alignment;
5058
 
5059
  switch (kind)
5060
    {
5061
    case 'd':
5062
      alignment = 8;
5063
      break;
5064
 
5065
    case 'x':
5066
    case 'X':
5067
      alignment = 16;
5068
      break;
5069
 
5070
    case 'f':
5071
    default:
5072
      alignment = 4;
5073
      break;
5074
    }
5075
  ia64_do_align (alignment);
5076
  float_cons (kind);
5077
}
5078
 
5079
static void
5080
stmt_cons_ua (size)
5081
     int size;
5082
{
5083
  int saved_auto_align = md.auto_align;
5084
 
5085
  md.auto_align = 0;
5086
  cons (size);
5087
  md.auto_align = saved_auto_align;
5088
}
5089
 
5090
static void
5091
dot_xfloat_cons (kind)
5092
     int kind;
5093
{
5094
  cross_section (kind, stmt_float_cons, 0);
5095
}
5096
 
5097
static void
5098
dot_xstringer (int zero)
5099
{
5100
  cross_section (zero, stringer, 0);
5101
}
5102
 
5103
static void
5104
dot_xdata_ua (size)
5105
     int size;
5106
{
5107
  cross_section (size, cons, 1);
5108
}
5109
 
5110
static void
5111
dot_xfloat_cons_ua (kind)
5112
     int kind;
5113
{
5114
  cross_section (kind, float_cons, 1);
5115
}
5116
 
5117
/* .reg.val <regname>,value */
5118
 
5119
static void
5120
dot_reg_val (dummy)
5121
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
5122
{
5123
  expressionS reg;
5124
 
5125
  expression_and_evaluate (&reg);
5126
  if (reg.X_op != O_register)
5127
    {
5128
      as_bad (_("Register name expected"));
5129
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
5130
    }
5131
  else if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
5132
    {
5133
      as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
5134
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
5135
    }
5136
  else
5137
    {
5138
      valueT value = get_absolute_expression ();
5139
      int regno = reg.X_add_number;
5140
      if (regno <= REG_GR || regno > REG_GR + 127)
5141
        as_warn (_("Register value annotation ignored"));
5142
      else
5143
        {
5144
          gr_values[regno - REG_GR].known = 1;
5145
          gr_values[regno - REG_GR].value = value;
5146
          gr_values[regno - REG_GR].path = md.path;
5147
        }
5148
    }
5149
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5150
}
5151
 
5152
/*
5153
  .serialize.data
5154
  .serialize.instruction
5155
 */
5156
static void
5157
dot_serialize (type)
5158
     int type;
5159
{
5160
  insn_group_break (0, 0, 0);
5161
  if (type)
5162
    instruction_serialization ();
5163
  else
5164
    data_serialization ();
5165
  insn_group_break (0, 0, 0);
5166
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5167
}
5168
 
5169
/* select dv checking mode
5170
   .auto
5171
   .explicit
5172
   .default
5173
 
5174
   A stop is inserted when changing modes
5175
 */
5176
 
5177
static void
5178
dot_dv_mode (type)
5179
     int type;
5180
{
5181
  if (md.manual_bundling)
5182
    as_warn (_("Directive invalid within a bundle"));
5183
 
5184
  if (type == 'E' || type == 'A')
5185
    md.mode_explicitly_set = 0;
5186
  else
5187
    md.mode_explicitly_set = 1;
5188
 
5189
  md.detect_dv = 1;
5190
  switch (type)
5191
    {
5192
    case 'A':
5193
    case 'a':
5194
      if (md.explicit_mode)
5195
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
5196
      md.explicit_mode = 0;
5197
      break;
5198
    case 'E':
5199
    case 'e':
5200
      if (!md.explicit_mode)
5201
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
5202
      md.explicit_mode = 1;
5203
      break;
5204
    default:
5205
    case 'd':
5206
      if (md.explicit_mode != md.default_explicit_mode)
5207
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
5208
      md.explicit_mode = md.default_explicit_mode;
5209
      md.mode_explicitly_set = 0;
5210
      break;
5211
    }
5212
}
5213
 
5214
static void
5215
print_prmask (mask)
5216
     valueT mask;
5217
{
5218
  int regno;
5219
  char *comma = "";
5220
  for (regno = 0; regno < 64; regno++)
5221
    {
5222
      if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << regno))
5223
        {
5224
          fprintf (stderr, "%s p%d", comma, regno);
5225
          comma = ",";
5226
        }
5227
    }
5228
}
5229
 
5230
/*
5231
  .pred.rel.clear [p1 [,p2 [,...]]]     (also .pred.rel "clear" or @clear)
5232
  .pred.rel.imply p1, p2                (also .pred.rel "imply" or @imply)
5233
  .pred.rel.mutex p1, p2 [,...]         (also .pred.rel "mutex" or @mutex)
5234
  .pred.safe_across_calls p1 [, p2 [,...]]
5235
 */
5236
 
5237
static void
5238
dot_pred_rel (type)
5239
     int type;
5240
{
5241
  valueT mask = 0;
5242
  int count = 0;
5243
  int p1 = -1, p2 = -1;
5244
 
5245
  if (type == 0)
5246
    {
5247
      if (*input_line_pointer == '"')
5248
        {
5249
          int len;
5250
          char *form = demand_copy_C_string (&len);
5251
 
5252
          if (strcmp (form, "mutex") == 0)
5253
            type = 'm';
5254
          else if (strcmp (form, "clear") == 0)
5255
            type = 'c';
5256
          else if (strcmp (form, "imply") == 0)
5257
            type = 'i';
5258
          obstack_free (&notes, form);
5259
        }
5260
      else if (*input_line_pointer == '@')
5261
        {
5262
          char *form = ++input_line_pointer;
5263
          char c = get_symbol_end();
5264
 
5265
          if (strcmp (form, "mutex") == 0)
5266
            type = 'm';
5267
          else if (strcmp (form, "clear") == 0)
5268
            type = 'c';
5269
          else if (strcmp (form, "imply") == 0)
5270
            type = 'i';
5271
          *input_line_pointer = c;
5272
        }
5273
      else
5274
        {
5275
          as_bad (_("Missing predicate relation type"));
5276
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
5277
          return;
5278
        }
5279
      if (type == 0)
5280
        {
5281
          as_bad (_("Unrecognized predicate relation type"));
5282
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
5283
          return;
5284
        }
5285
      if (*input_line_pointer == ',')
5286
        ++input_line_pointer;
5287
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5288
    }
5289
 
5290
  while (1)
5291
    {
5292
      valueT bits = 1;
5293
      int sep, regno;
5294
      expressionS pr, *pr1, *pr2;
5295
 
5296
      sep = parse_operand (&pr, ',');
5297
      if (pr.X_op == O_register
5298
          && pr.X_add_number >= REG_P
5299
          && pr.X_add_number <= REG_P + 63)
5300
        {
5301
          regno = pr.X_add_number - REG_P;
5302
          bits <<= regno;
5303
          count++;
5304
          if (p1 == -1)
5305
            p1 = regno;
5306
          else if (p2 == -1)
5307
            p2 = regno;
5308
        }
5309
      else if (type != 'i'
5310
          && pr.X_op == O_subtract
5311
          && (pr1 = symbol_get_value_expression (pr.X_add_symbol))
5312
          && pr1->X_op == O_register
5313
          && pr1->X_add_number >= REG_P
5314
          && pr1->X_add_number <= REG_P + 63
5315
          && (pr2 = symbol_get_value_expression (pr.X_op_symbol))
5316
          && pr2->X_op == O_register
5317
          && pr2->X_add_number >= REG_P
5318
          && pr2->X_add_number <= REG_P + 63)
5319
        {
5320
          /* It's a range.  */
5321
          int stop;
5322
 
5323
          regno = pr1->X_add_number - REG_P;
5324
          stop = pr2->X_add_number - REG_P;
5325
          if (regno >= stop)
5326
            {
5327
              as_bad (_("Bad register range"));
5328
              ignore_rest_of_line ();
5329
              return;
5330
            }
5331
          bits = ((bits << stop) << 1) - (bits << regno);
5332
          count += stop - regno + 1;
5333
        }
5334
      else
5335
        {
5336
          as_bad (_("Predicate register expected"));
5337
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
5338
          return;
5339
        }
5340
      if (mask & bits)
5341
        as_warn (_("Duplicate predicate register ignored"));
5342
      mask |= bits;
5343
      if (sep != ',')
5344
        break;
5345
    }
5346
 
5347
  switch (type)
5348
    {
5349
    case 'c':
5350
      if (count == 0)
5351
        mask = ~(valueT) 0;
5352
      clear_qp_mutex (mask);
5353
      clear_qp_implies (mask, (valueT) 0);
5354
      break;
5355
    case 'i':
5356
      if (count != 2 || p1 == -1 || p2 == -1)
5357
        as_bad (_("Predicate source and target required"));
5358
      else if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
5359
        as_bad (_("Use of p0 is not valid in this context"));
5360
      else
5361
        add_qp_imply (p1, p2);
5362
      break;
5363
    case 'm':
5364
      if (count < 2)
5365
        {
5366
          as_bad (_("At least two PR arguments expected"));
5367
          break;
5368
        }
5369
      else if (mask & 1)
5370
        {
5371
          as_bad (_("Use of p0 is not valid in this context"));
5372
          break;
5373
        }
5374
      add_qp_mutex (mask);
5375
      break;
5376
    case 's':
5377
      /* note that we don't override any existing relations */
5378
      if (count == 0)
5379
        {
5380
          as_bad (_("At least one PR argument expected"));
5381
          break;
5382
        }
5383
      if (md.debug_dv)
5384
        {
5385
          fprintf (stderr, "Safe across calls: ");
5386
          print_prmask (mask);
5387
          fprintf (stderr, "\n");
5388
        }
5389
      qp_safe_across_calls = mask;
5390
      break;
5391
    }
5392
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5393
}
5394
 
5395
/* .entry label [, label [, ...]]
5396
   Hint to DV code that the given labels are to be considered entry points.
5397
   Otherwise, only global labels are considered entry points.  */
5398
 
5399
static void
5400
dot_entry (dummy)
5401
     int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
5402
{
5403
  const char *err;
5404
  char *name;
5405
  int c;
5406
  symbolS *symbolP;
5407
 
5408
  do
5409
    {
5410
      name = input_line_pointer;
5411
      c = get_symbol_end ();
5412
      symbolP = symbol_find_or_make (name);
5413
 
5414
      err = hash_insert (md.entry_hash, S_GET_NAME (symbolP), (PTR) symbolP);
5415
      if (err)
5416
        as_fatal (_("Inserting \"%s\" into entry hint table failed: %s"),
5417
                  name, err);
5418
 
5419
      *input_line_pointer = c;
5420
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5421
      c = *input_line_pointer;
5422
      if (c == ',')
5423
        {
5424
          input_line_pointer++;
5425
          SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5426
          if (*input_line_pointer == '\n')
5427
            c = '\n';
5428
        }
5429
    }
5430
  while (c == ',');
5431
 
5432
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5433
}
5434
 
5435
/* .mem.offset offset, base
5436
   "base" is used to distinguish between offsets from a different base.  */
5437
 
5438
static void
5439
dot_mem_offset (dummy)
5440
  int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
5441
{
5442
  md.mem_offset.hint = 1;
5443
  md.mem_offset.offset = get_absolute_expression ();
5444
  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
5445
    {
5446
      as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
5447
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
5448
      return;
5449
    }
5450
  ++input_line_pointer;
5451
  md.mem_offset.base = get_absolute_expression ();
5452
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5453
}
5454
 
5455
/* ia64-specific pseudo-ops:  */
5456
const pseudo_typeS md_pseudo_table[] =
5457
  {
5458
    { "radix", dot_radix, 0 },
5459
    { "lcomm", s_lcomm_bytes, 1 },
5460
    { "loc", dot_loc, 0 },
5461
    { "bss", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_BSS },
5462
    { "sbss", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_SBSS },
5463
    { "sdata", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_SDATA },
5464
    { "rodata", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_RODATA },
5465
    { "comment", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_COMMENT },
5466
    { "ia_64.unwind", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND },
5467
    { "ia_64.unwind_info", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO },
5468
    { "init_array", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_INIT_ARRAY },
5469
    { "fini_array", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_FINI_ARRAY },
5470
    { "proc", dot_proc, 0 },
5471
    { "body", dot_body, 0 },
5472
    { "prologue", dot_prologue, 0 },
5473
    { "endp", dot_endp, 0 },
5474
 
5475
    { "fframe", dot_fframe, 0 },
5476
    { "vframe", dot_vframe, 0 },
5477
    { "vframesp", dot_vframesp, 0 },
5478
    { "vframepsp", dot_vframesp, 1 },
5479
    { "save", dot_save, 0 },
5480
    { "restore", dot_restore, 0 },
5481
    { "restorereg", dot_restorereg, 0 },
5482
    { "restorereg.p", dot_restorereg, 1 },
5483
    { "handlerdata", dot_handlerdata, 0 },
5484
    { "unwentry", dot_unwentry, 0 },
5485
    { "altrp", dot_altrp, 0 },
5486
    { "savesp", dot_savemem, 0 },
5487
    { "savepsp", dot_savemem, 1 },
5488
    { "save.g", dot_saveg, 0 },
5489
    { "save.f", dot_savef, 0 },
5490
    { "save.b", dot_saveb, 0 },
5491
    { "save.gf", dot_savegf, 0 },
5492
    { "spill", dot_spill, 0 },
5493
    { "spillreg", dot_spillreg, 0 },
5494
    { "spillsp", dot_spillmem, 0 },
5495
    { "spillpsp", dot_spillmem, 1 },
5496
    { "spillreg.p", dot_spillreg, 1 },
5497
    { "spillsp.p", dot_spillmem, ~0 },
5498
    { "spillpsp.p", dot_spillmem, ~1 },
5499
    { "label_state", dot_label_state, 0 },
5500
    { "copy_state", dot_copy_state, 0 },
5501
    { "unwabi", dot_unwabi, 0 },
5502
    { "personality", dot_personality, 0 },
5503
    { "mii", dot_template, 0x0 },
5504
    { "mli", dot_template, 0x2 }, /* old format, for compatibility */
5505
    { "mlx", dot_template, 0x2 },
5506
    { "mmi", dot_template, 0x4 },
5507
    { "mfi", dot_template, 0x6 },
5508
    { "mmf", dot_template, 0x7 },
5509
    { "mib", dot_template, 0x8 },
5510
    { "mbb", dot_template, 0x9 },
5511
    { "bbb", dot_template, 0xb },
5512
    { "mmb", dot_template, 0xc },
5513
    { "mfb", dot_template, 0xe },
5514
    { "align", dot_align, 0 },
5515
    { "regstk", dot_regstk, 0 },
5516
    { "rotr", dot_rot, DYNREG_GR },
5517
    { "rotf", dot_rot, DYNREG_FR },
5518
    { "rotp", dot_rot, DYNREG_PR },
5519
    { "lsb", dot_byteorder, 0 },
5520
    { "msb", dot_byteorder, 1 },
5521
    { "psr", dot_psr, 0 },
5522
    { "alias", dot_alias, 0 },
5523
    { "secalias", dot_alias, 1 },
5524
    { "ln", dot_ln, 0 },         /* source line info (for debugging) */
5525
 
5526
    { "xdata1", dot_xdata, 1 },
5527
    { "xdata2", dot_xdata, 2 },
5528
    { "xdata4", dot_xdata, 4 },
5529
    { "xdata8", dot_xdata, 8 },
5530
    { "xdata16", dot_xdata, 16 },
5531
    { "xreal4", dot_xfloat_cons, 'f' },
5532
    { "xreal8", dot_xfloat_cons, 'd' },
5533
    { "xreal10", dot_xfloat_cons, 'x' },
5534
    { "xreal16", dot_xfloat_cons, 'X' },
5535
    { "xstring", dot_xstringer, 8 + 0 },
5536
    { "xstringz", dot_xstringer, 8 + 1 },
5537
 
5538
    /* unaligned versions:  */
5539
    { "xdata2.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 2 },
5540
    { "xdata4.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 4 },
5541
    { "xdata8.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 8 },
5542
    { "xdata16.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 16 },
5543
    { "xreal4.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'f' },
5544
    { "xreal8.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'd' },
5545
    { "xreal10.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'x' },
5546
    { "xreal16.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'X' },
5547
 
5548
    /* annotations/DV checking support */
5549
    { "entry", dot_entry, 0 },
5550
    { "mem.offset", dot_mem_offset, 0 },
5551
    { "pred.rel", dot_pred_rel, 0 },
5552
    { "pred.rel.clear", dot_pred_rel, 'c' },
5553
    { "pred.rel.imply", dot_pred_rel, 'i' },
5554
    { "pred.rel.mutex", dot_pred_rel, 'm' },
5555
    { "pred.safe_across_calls", dot_pred_rel, 's' },
5556
    { "reg.val", dot_reg_val, 0 },
5557
    { "serialize.data", dot_serialize, 0 },
5558
    { "serialize.instruction", dot_serialize, 1 },
5559
    { "auto", dot_dv_mode, 'a' },
5560
    { "explicit", dot_dv_mode, 'e' },
5561
    { "default", dot_dv_mode, 'd' },
5562
 
5563
    /* ??? These are needed to make gas/testsuite/gas/elf/ehopt.s work.
5564
       IA-64 aligns data allocation pseudo-ops by default, so we have to
5565
       tell it that these ones are supposed to be unaligned.  Long term,
5566
       should rewrite so that only IA-64 specific data allocation pseudo-ops
5567
       are aligned by default.  */
5568
    {"2byte", stmt_cons_ua, 2},
5569
    {"4byte", stmt_cons_ua, 4},
5570
    {"8byte", stmt_cons_ua, 8},
5571
 
5572
    { NULL, 0, 0 }
5573
  };
5574
 
5575
static const struct pseudo_opcode
5576
  {
5577
    const char *name;
5578
    void (*handler) (int);
5579
    int arg;
5580
  }
5581
pseudo_opcode[] =
5582
  {
5583
    /* these are more like pseudo-ops, but don't start with a dot */
5584
    { "data1", cons, 1 },
5585
    { "data2", cons, 2 },
5586
    { "data4", cons, 4 },
5587
    { "data8", cons, 8 },
5588
    { "data16", cons, 16 },
5589
    { "real4", stmt_float_cons, 'f' },
5590
    { "real8", stmt_float_cons, 'd' },
5591
    { "real10", stmt_float_cons, 'x' },
5592
    { "real16", stmt_float_cons, 'X' },
5593
    { "string", stringer, 8 + 0 },
5594
    { "stringz", stringer, 8 + 1 },
5595
 
5596
    /* unaligned versions:  */
5597
    { "data2.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 2 },
5598
    { "data4.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 4 },
5599
    { "data8.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 8 },
5600
    { "data16.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 16 },
5601
    { "real4.ua", float_cons, 'f' },
5602
    { "real8.ua", float_cons, 'd' },
5603
    { "real10.ua", float_cons, 'x' },
5604
    { "real16.ua", float_cons, 'X' },
5605
  };
5606
 
5607
/* Declare a register by creating a symbol for it and entering it in
5608
   the symbol table.  */
5609
 
5610
static symbolS *
5611
declare_register (name, regnum)
5612
     const char *name;
5613
     unsigned int regnum;
5614
{
5615
  const char *err;
5616
  symbolS *sym;
5617
 
5618
  sym = symbol_create (name, reg_section, regnum, &zero_address_frag);
5619
 
5620
  err = hash_insert (md.reg_hash, S_GET_NAME (sym), (PTR) sym);
5621
  if (err)
5622
    as_fatal ("Inserting \"%s\" into register table failed: %s",
5623
              name, err);
5624
 
5625
  return sym;
5626
}
5627
 
5628
static void
5629
declare_register_set (prefix, num_regs, base_regnum)
5630
     const char *prefix;
5631
     unsigned int num_regs;
5632
     unsigned int base_regnum;
5633
{
5634
  char name[8];
5635
  unsigned int i;
5636
 
5637
  for (i = 0; i < num_regs; ++i)
5638
    {
5639
      snprintf (name, sizeof (name), "%s%u", prefix, i);
5640
      declare_register (name, base_regnum + i);
5641
    }
5642
}
5643
 
5644
static unsigned int
5645
operand_width (opnd)
5646
     enum ia64_opnd opnd;
5647
{
5648
  const struct ia64_operand *odesc = &elf64_ia64_operands[opnd];
5649
  unsigned int bits = 0;
5650
  int i;
5651
 
5652
  bits = 0;
5653
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (odesc->field) && odesc->field[i].bits; ++i)
5654
    bits += odesc->field[i].bits;
5655
 
5656
  return bits;
5657
}
5658
 
5659
static enum operand_match_result
5660
operand_match (idesc, index, e)
5661
     const struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
5662
     int index;
5663
     expressionS *e;
5664
{
5665
  enum ia64_opnd opnd = idesc->operands[index];
5666
  int bits, relocatable = 0;
5667
  struct insn_fix *fix;
5668
  bfd_signed_vma val;
5669
 
5670
  switch (opnd)
5671
    {
5672
      /* constants:  */
5673
 
5674
    case IA64_OPND_AR_CCV:
5675
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 32)
5676
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5677
      break;
5678
 
5679
    case IA64_OPND_AR_CSD:
5680
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 25)
5681
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5682
      break;
5683
 
5684
    case IA64_OPND_AR_PFS:
5685
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 64)
5686
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5687
      break;
5688
 
5689
    case IA64_OPND_GR0:
5690
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_GR + 0)
5691
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5692
      break;
5693
 
5694
    case IA64_OPND_IP:
5695
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_IP)
5696
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5697
      break;
5698
 
5699
    case IA64_OPND_PR:
5700
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PR)
5701
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5702
      break;
5703
 
5704
    case IA64_OPND_PR_ROT:
5705
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PR_ROT)
5706
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5707
      break;
5708
 
5709
    case IA64_OPND_PSR:
5710
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR)
5711
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5712
      break;
5713
 
5714
    case IA64_OPND_PSR_L:
5715
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR_L)
5716
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5717
      break;
5718
 
5719
    case IA64_OPND_PSR_UM:
5720
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR_UM)
5721
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5722
      break;
5723
 
5724
    case IA64_OPND_C1:
5725
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5726
        {
5727
          if (e->X_add_number == 1)
5728
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5729
          else
5730
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5731
        }
5732
      break;
5733
 
5734
    case IA64_OPND_C8:
5735
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5736
        {
5737
          if (e->X_add_number == 8)
5738
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5739
          else
5740
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5741
        }
5742
      break;
5743
 
5744
    case IA64_OPND_C16:
5745
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5746
        {
5747
          if (e->X_add_number == 16)
5748
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5749
          else
5750
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5751
        }
5752
      break;
5753
 
5754
      /* register operands:  */
5755
 
5756
    case IA64_OPND_AR3:
5757
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_AR
5758
          && e->X_add_number < REG_AR + 128)
5759
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5760
      break;
5761
 
5762
    case IA64_OPND_B1:
5763
    case IA64_OPND_B2:
5764
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_BR
5765
          && e->X_add_number < REG_BR + 8)
5766
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5767
      break;
5768
 
5769
    case IA64_OPND_CR3:
5770
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_CR
5771
          && e->X_add_number < REG_CR + 128)
5772
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5773
      break;
5774
 
5775
    case IA64_OPND_F1:
5776
    case IA64_OPND_F2:
5777
    case IA64_OPND_F3:
5778
    case IA64_OPND_F4:
5779
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_FR
5780
          && e->X_add_number < REG_FR + 128)
5781
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5782
      break;
5783
 
5784
    case IA64_OPND_P1:
5785
    case IA64_OPND_P2:
5786
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_P
5787
          && e->X_add_number < REG_P + 64)
5788
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5789
      break;
5790
 
5791
    case IA64_OPND_R1:
5792
    case IA64_OPND_R2:
5793
    case IA64_OPND_R3:
5794
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_GR
5795
          && e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 128)
5796
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5797
      break;
5798
 
5799
    case IA64_OPND_R3_2:
5800
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_GR)
5801
        {
5802
          if (e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 4)
5803
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5804
          else if (e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 128)
5805
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5806
        }
5807
      break;
5808
 
5809
      /* indirect operands:  */
5810
    case IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3:
5811
    case IA64_OPND_DBR_R3:
5812
    case IA64_OPND_DTR_R3:
5813
    case IA64_OPND_ITR_R3:
5814
    case IA64_OPND_IBR_R3:
5815
    case IA64_OPND_MSR_R3:
5816
    case IA64_OPND_PKR_R3:
5817
    case IA64_OPND_PMC_R3:
5818
    case IA64_OPND_PMD_R3:
5819
    case IA64_OPND_RR_R3:
5820
      if (e->X_op == O_index && e->X_op_symbol
5821
          && (S_GET_VALUE (e->X_op_symbol) - IND_CPUID
5822
              == opnd - IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3))
5823
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5824
      break;
5825
 
5826
    case IA64_OPND_MR3:
5827
      if (e->X_op == O_index && !e->X_op_symbol)
5828
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5829
      break;
5830
 
5831
      /* immediate operands:  */
5832
    case IA64_OPND_CNT2a:
5833
    case IA64_OPND_LEN4:
5834
    case IA64_OPND_LEN6:
5835
      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[index]);
5836
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5837
        {
5838
          if ((bfd_vma) (e->X_add_number - 1) < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5839
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5840
          else
5841
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5842
        }
5843
      break;
5844
 
5845
    case IA64_OPND_CNT2b:
5846
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5847
        {
5848
          if ((bfd_vma) (e->X_add_number - 1) < 3)
5849
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5850
          else
5851
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5852
        }
5853
      break;
5854
 
5855
    case IA64_OPND_CNT2c:
5856
      val = e->X_add_number;
5857
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5858
        {
5859
          if ((val == 0 || val == 7 || val == 15 || val == 16))
5860
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5861
          else
5862
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5863
        }
5864
      break;
5865
 
5866
    case IA64_OPND_SOR:
5867
      /* SOR must be an integer multiple of 8 */
5868
      if (e->X_op == O_constant && e->X_add_number & 0x7)
5869
        return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5870
    case IA64_OPND_SOF:
5871
    case IA64_OPND_SOL:
5872
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5873
        {
5874
          if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number <= 96)
5875
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5876
          else
5877
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5878
        }
5879
      break;
5880
 
5881
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU62:
5882
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5883
        {
5884
          if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 62))
5885
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5886
          else
5887
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5888
        }
5889
      else
5890
        {
5891
          /* FIXME -- need 62-bit relocation type */
5892
          as_bad (_("62-bit relocation not yet implemented"));
5893
        }
5894
      break;
5895
 
5896
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU64:
5897
      if (e->X_op == O_symbol || e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
5898
          || e->X_op == O_subtract)
5899
        {
5900
          fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5901
          fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64;
5902
          if (e->X_op != O_subtract)
5903
            {
5904
              fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5905
              if (e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
5906
                e->X_op = O_symbol;
5907
            }
5908
 
5909
          fix->opnd = idesc->operands[index];
5910
          fix->expr = *e;
5911
          fix->is_pcrel = 0;
5912
          ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5913
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
5914
        }
5915
      else if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5916
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5917
      break;
5918
 
5919
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU5b:
5920
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5921
        {
5922
          val = e->X_add_number;
5923
          if (val >= 32 && val <= 63)
5924
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5925
          else
5926
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5927
        }
5928
      break;
5929
 
5930
    case IA64_OPND_CCNT5:
5931
    case IA64_OPND_CNT5:
5932
    case IA64_OPND_CNT6:
5933
    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6a:
5934
    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6b:
5935
    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6c:
5936
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU2:
5937
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU7a:
5938
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU7b:
5939
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU21:
5940
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU24:
5941
    case IA64_OPND_MBTYPE4:
5942
    case IA64_OPND_MHTYPE8:
5943
    case IA64_OPND_POS6:
5944
      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[index]);
5945
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5946
        {
5947
          if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5948
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5949
          else
5950
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5951
        }
5952
      break;
5953
 
5954
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU9:
5955
      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[index]);
5956
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5957
        {
5958
          if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5959
            {
5960
              int lobits = e->X_add_number & 0x3;
5961
              if (((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number & 0x3C) != 0 && lobits == 0)
5962
                e->X_add_number |= (bfd_vma) 0x3;
5963
              return OPERAND_MATCH;
5964
            }
5965
          else
5966
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5967
        }
5968
      break;
5969
 
5970
    case IA64_OPND_IMM44:
5971
      /* least 16 bits must be zero */
5972
      if ((e->X_add_number & 0xffff) != 0)
5973
        /* XXX technically, this is wrong: we should not be issuing warning
5974
           messages until we're sure this instruction pattern is going to
5975
           be used! */
5976
        as_warn (_("lower 16 bits of mask ignored"));
5977
 
5978
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5979
        {
5980
          if (((e->X_add_number >= 0
5981
                && (bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 44))
5982
               || (e->X_add_number < 0
5983
                   && (bfd_vma) -e->X_add_number <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << 44))))
5984
            {
5985
              /* sign-extend */
5986
              if (e->X_add_number >= 0
5987
                  && (e->X_add_number & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 43)) != 0)
5988
                {
5989
                  e->X_add_number |= ~(((bfd_vma) 1 << 44) - 1);
5990
                }
5991
              return OPERAND_MATCH;
5992
            }
5993
          else
5994
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5995
        }
5996
      break;
5997
 
5998
    case IA64_OPND_IMM17:
5999
      /* bit 0 is a don't care (pr0 is hardwired to 1) */
6000
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
6001
        {
6002
          if (((e->X_add_number >= 0
6003
                && (bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 17))
6004
               || (e->X_add_number < 0
6005
                   && (bfd_vma) -e->X_add_number <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << 17))))
6006
            {
6007
              /* sign-extend */
6008
              if (e->X_add_number >= 0
6009
                  && (e->X_add_number & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 16)) != 0)
6010
                {
6011
                  e->X_add_number |= ~(((bfd_vma) 1 << 17) - 1);
6012
                }
6013
              return OPERAND_MATCH;
6014
            }
6015
          else
6016
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
6017
        }
6018
      break;
6019
 
6020
    case IA64_OPND_IMM14:
6021
    case IA64_OPND_IMM22:
6022
      relocatable = 1;
6023
    case IA64_OPND_IMM1:
6024
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8:
6025
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8U4:
6026
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1:
6027
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U4:
6028
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8:
6029
    case IA64_OPND_IMM9a:
6030
    case IA64_OPND_IMM9b:
6031
      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[index]);
6032
      if (relocatable && (e->X_op == O_symbol
6033
                          || e->X_op == O_subtract
6034
                          || e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup))
6035
        {
6036
          fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
6037
 
6038
          if (idesc->operands[index] == IA64_OPND_IMM14)
6039
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14;
6040
          else
6041
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22;
6042
 
6043
          if (e->X_op != O_subtract)
6044
            {
6045
              fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
6046
              if (e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
6047
                e->X_op = O_symbol;
6048
            }
6049
 
6050
          fix->opnd = idesc->operands[index];
6051
          fix->expr = *e;
6052
          fix->is_pcrel = 0;
6053
          ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
6054
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
6055
        }
6056
      else if (e->X_op != O_constant
6057
               && ! (e->X_op == O_big && opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8))
6058
        return OPERAND_MISMATCH;
6059
 
6060
      if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U4)
6061
        {
6062
          /* Zero is not valid for unsigned compares that take an adjusted
6063
             constant immediate range.  */
6064
          if (e->X_add_number == 0)
6065
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
6066
 
6067
          /* Sign-extend 32-bit unsigned numbers, so that the following range
6068
             checks will work.  */
6069
          val = e->X_add_number;
6070
          if (((val & (~(bfd_vma) 0 << 32)) == 0)
6071
              && ((val & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)) != 0))
6072
            val = ((val << 32) >> 32);
6073
 
6074
          /* Check for 0x100000000.  This is valid because
6075
             0x100000000-1 is the same as ((uint32_t) -1).  */
6076
          if (val == ((bfd_signed_vma) 1 << 32))
6077
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
6078
 
6079
          val = val - 1;
6080
        }
6081
      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8)
6082
        {
6083
          /* Zero is not valid for unsigned compares that take an adjusted
6084
             constant immediate range.  */
6085
          if (e->X_add_number == 0)
6086
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
6087
 
6088
          /* Check for 0x10000000000000000.  */
6089
          if (e->X_op == O_big)
6090
            {
6091
              if (generic_bignum[0] == 0
6092
                  && generic_bignum[1] == 0
6093
                  && generic_bignum[2] == 0
6094
                  && generic_bignum[3] == 0
6095
                  && generic_bignum[4] == 1)
6096
                return OPERAND_MATCH;
6097
              else
6098
                return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
6099
            }
6100
          else
6101
            val = e->X_add_number - 1;
6102
        }
6103
      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1)
6104
        val = e->X_add_number - 1;
6105
      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8U4)
6106
        {
6107
          /* Sign-extend 32-bit unsigned numbers, so that the following range
6108
             checks will work.  */
6109
          val = e->X_add_number;
6110
          if (((val & (~(bfd_vma) 0 << 32)) == 0)
6111
              && ((val & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)) != 0))
6112
            val = ((val << 32) >> 32);
6113
        }
6114
      else
6115
        val = e->X_add_number;
6116
 
6117
      if ((val >= 0 && (bfd_vma) val < ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
6118
          || (val < 0 && (bfd_vma) -val <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1))))
6119
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
6120
      else
6121
        return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
6122
 
6123
    case IA64_OPND_INC3:
6124
      /* +/- 1, 4, 8, 16 */
6125
      val = e->X_add_number;
6126
      if (val < 0)
6127
        val = -val;
6128
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
6129
        {
6130
          if ((val == 1 || val == 4 || val == 8 || val == 16))
6131
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
6132
          else
6133
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
6134
        }
6135
      break;
6136
 
6137
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25:
6138
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25b:
6139
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25c:
6140
    case IA64_OPND_TGT64:
6141
      if (e->X_op == O_symbol)
6142
        {
6143
          fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
6144
          if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25)
6145
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21F;
6146
          else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25b)
6147
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21M;
6148
          else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25c)
6149
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21B;
6150
          else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT64)
6151
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL60B;
6152
          else
6153
            abort ();
6154
 
6155
          fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
6156
          fix->opnd = idesc->operands[index];
6157
          fix->expr = *e;
6158
          fix->is_pcrel = 1;
6159
          ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
6160
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
6161
        }
6162
    case IA64_OPND_TAG13:
6163
    case IA64_OPND_TAG13b:
6164
      switch (e->X_op)
6165
        {
6166
        case O_constant:
6167
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
6168
 
6169
        case O_symbol:
6170
          fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
6171
          /* There are no external relocs for TAG13/TAG13b fields, so we
6172
             create a dummy reloc.  This will not live past md_apply_fix.  */
6173
          fix->code = BFD_RELOC_UNUSED;
6174
          fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
6175
          fix->opnd = idesc->operands[index];
6176
          fix->expr = *e;
6177
          fix->is_pcrel = 1;
6178
          ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
6179
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
6180
 
6181
        default:
6182
          break;
6183
        }
6184
      break;
6185
 
6186
    case IA64_OPND_LDXMOV:
6187
      fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
6188
      fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LDXMOV;
6189
      fix->opnd = idesc->operands[index];
6190
      fix->expr = *e;
6191
      fix->is_pcrel = 0;
6192
      ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
6193
      return OPERAND_MATCH;
6194
 
6195
    default:
6196
      break;
6197
    }
6198
  return OPERAND_MISMATCH;
6199
}
6200
 
6201
static int
6202
parse_operand (e, more)
6203
     expressionS *e;
6204
     int more;
6205
{
6206
  int sep = '\0';
6207
 
6208
  memset (e, 0, sizeof (*e));
6209
  e->X_op = O_absent;
6210
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
6211
  expression_and_evaluate (e);
6212
  sep = *input_line_pointer;
6213
  if (more && (sep == ',' || sep == more))
6214
    ++input_line_pointer;
6215
  return sep;
6216
}
6217
 
6218
/* Returns the next entry in the opcode table that matches the one in
6219
   IDESC, and frees the entry in IDESC.  If no matching entry is
6220
   found, NULL is returned instead.  */
6221
 
6222
static struct ia64_opcode *
6223
get_next_opcode (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
6224
{
6225
  struct ia64_opcode *next = ia64_find_next_opcode (idesc);
6226
  ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
6227
  return next;
6228
}
6229
 
6230
/* Parse the operands for the opcode and find the opcode variant that
6231
   matches the specified operands, or NULL if no match is possible.  */
6232
 
6233
static struct ia64_opcode *
6234
parse_operands (idesc)
6235
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
6236
{
6237
  int i = 0, highest_unmatched_operand, num_operands = 0, num_outputs = 0;
6238
  int error_pos, out_of_range_pos, curr_out_of_range_pos, sep = 0;
6239
  int reg1, reg2;
6240
  char reg_class;
6241
  enum ia64_opnd expected_operand = IA64_OPND_NIL;
6242
  enum operand_match_result result;
6243
  char mnemonic[129];
6244
  char *first_arg = 0, *end, *saved_input_pointer;
6245
  unsigned int sof;
6246
 
6247
  assert (strlen (idesc->name) <= 128);
6248
 
6249
  strcpy (mnemonic, idesc->name);
6250
  if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_SOF
6251
      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_SOF)
6252
    {
6253
      /* To make the common idiom "alloc loc?=ar.pfs,0,1,0,0" work, we
6254
         can't parse the first operand until we have parsed the
6255
         remaining operands of the "alloc" instruction.  */
6256
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
6257
      first_arg = input_line_pointer;
6258
      end = strchr (input_line_pointer, '=');
6259
      if (!end)
6260
        {
6261
          as_bad (_("Expected separator `='"));
6262
          return 0;
6263
        }
6264
      input_line_pointer = end + 1;
6265
      ++i;
6266
      ++num_outputs;
6267
    }
6268
 
6269
  for (; ; ++i)
6270
    {
6271
      if (i < NELEMS (CURR_SLOT.opnd))
6272
        {
6273
          sep = parse_operand (CURR_SLOT.opnd + i, '=');
6274
          if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_op == O_absent)
6275
            break;
6276
        }
6277
      else
6278
        {
6279
          expressionS dummy;
6280
 
6281
          sep = parse_operand (&dummy, '=');
6282
          if (dummy.X_op == O_absent)
6283
            break;
6284
        }
6285
 
6286
      ++num_operands;
6287
 
6288
      if (sep != '=' && sep != ',')
6289
        break;
6290
 
6291
      if (sep == '=')
6292
        {
6293
          if (num_outputs > 0)
6294
            as_bad (_("Duplicate equal sign (=) in instruction"));
6295
          else
6296
            num_outputs = i + 1;
6297
        }
6298
    }
6299
  if (sep != '\0')
6300
    {
6301
      as_bad (_("Illegal operand separator `%c'"), sep);
6302
      return 0;
6303
    }
6304
 
6305
  if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_SOF
6306
      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_SOF)
6307
    {
6308
      /* Map alloc r1=ar.pfs,i,l,o,r to alloc r1=ar.pfs,(i+l+o),(i+l),r.
6309
         Note, however, that due to that mapping operand numbers in error
6310
         messages for any of the constant operands will not be correct.  */
6311
      know (strcmp (idesc->name, "alloc") == 0);
6312
      /* The first operand hasn't been parsed/initialized, yet (but
6313
         num_operands intentionally doesn't account for that).  */
6314
      i = num_operands > 4 ? 2 : 1;
6315
#define FORCE_CONST(n) (CURR_SLOT.opnd[n].X_op == O_constant \
6316
                        ? CURR_SLOT.opnd[n].X_add_number \
6317
                        : 0)
6318
      sof = set_regstack (FORCE_CONST(i),
6319
                          FORCE_CONST(i + 1),
6320
                          FORCE_CONST(i + 2),
6321
                          FORCE_CONST(i + 3));
6322
#undef FORCE_CONST
6323
 
6324
      /* now we can parse the first arg:  */
6325
      saved_input_pointer = input_line_pointer;
6326
      input_line_pointer = first_arg;
6327
      sep = parse_operand (CURR_SLOT.opnd + 0, '=');
6328
      if (sep != '=')
6329
        --num_outputs;  /* force error */
6330
      input_line_pointer = saved_input_pointer;
6331
 
6332
      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number = sof;
6333
      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_op == O_constant
6334
          && CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2].X_op == O_constant)
6335
        CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_add_number
6336
          = sof - CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2].X_add_number;
6337
      else
6338
        CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_op = O_illegal;
6339
      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2] = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 3];
6340
    }
6341
 
6342
  highest_unmatched_operand = -4;
6343
  curr_out_of_range_pos = -1;
6344
  error_pos = 0;
6345
  for (; idesc; idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc))
6346
    {
6347
      if (num_outputs != idesc->num_outputs)
6348
        continue;               /* mismatch in # of outputs */
6349
      if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0)
6350
        highest_unmatched_operand |= 1;
6351
      if (num_operands > NELEMS (idesc->operands)
6352
          || (num_operands < NELEMS (idesc->operands)
6353
           && idesc->operands[num_operands])
6354
          || (num_operands > 0 && !idesc->operands[num_operands - 1]))
6355
        continue;               /* mismatch in number of arguments */
6356
      if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0)
6357
        highest_unmatched_operand |= 2;
6358
 
6359
      CURR_SLOT.num_fixups = 0;
6360
 
6361
      /* Try to match all operands.  If we see an out-of-range operand,
6362
         then continue trying to match the rest of the operands, since if
6363
         the rest match, then this idesc will give the best error message.  */
6364
 
6365
      out_of_range_pos = -1;
6366
      for (i = 0; i < num_operands && idesc->operands[i]; ++i)
6367
        {
6368
          result = operand_match (idesc, i, CURR_SLOT.opnd + i);
6369
          if (result != OPERAND_MATCH)
6370
            {
6371
              if (result != OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE)
6372
                break;
6373
              if (out_of_range_pos < 0)
6374
                /* remember position of the first out-of-range operand: */
6375
                out_of_range_pos = i;
6376
            }
6377
        }
6378
 
6379
      /* If we did not match all operands, or if at least one operand was
6380
         out-of-range, then this idesc does not match.  Keep track of which
6381
         idesc matched the most operands before failing.  If we have two
6382
         idescs that failed at the same position, and one had an out-of-range
6383
         operand, then prefer the out-of-range operand.  Thus if we have
6384
         "add r0=0x1000000,r1" we get an error saying the constant is out
6385
         of range instead of an error saying that the constant should have been
6386
         a register.  */
6387
 
6388
      if (i != num_operands || out_of_range_pos >= 0)
6389
        {
6390
          if (i > highest_unmatched_operand
6391
              || (i == highest_unmatched_operand
6392
                  && out_of_range_pos > curr_out_of_range_pos))
6393
            {
6394
              highest_unmatched_operand = i;
6395
              if (out_of_range_pos >= 0)
6396
                {
6397
                  expected_operand = idesc->operands[out_of_range_pos];
6398
                  error_pos = out_of_range_pos;
6399
                }
6400
              else
6401
                {
6402
                  expected_operand = idesc->operands[i];
6403
                  error_pos = i;
6404
                }
6405
              curr_out_of_range_pos = out_of_range_pos;
6406
            }
6407
          continue;
6408
        }
6409
 
6410
      break;
6411
    }
6412
  if (!idesc)
6413
    {
6414
      if (expected_operand)
6415
        as_bad (_("Operand %u of `%s' should be %s"),
6416
                error_pos + 1, mnemonic,
6417
                elf64_ia64_operands[expected_operand].desc);
6418
      else if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0 && !(highest_unmatched_operand & 1))
6419
        as_bad (_("Wrong number of output operands"));
6420
      else if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0 && !(highest_unmatched_operand & 2))
6421
        as_bad (_("Wrong number of input operands"));
6422
      else
6423
        as_bad (_("Operand mismatch"));
6424
      return 0;
6425
    }
6426
 
6427
  /* Check that the instruction doesn't use
6428
     - r0, f0, or f1 as output operands
6429
     - the same predicate twice as output operands
6430
     - r0 as address of a base update load or store
6431
     - the same GR as output and address of a base update load
6432
     - two even- or two odd-numbered FRs as output operands of a floating
6433
       point parallel load.
6434
     At most two (conflicting) output (or output-like) operands can exist,
6435
     (floating point parallel loads have three outputs, but the base register,
6436
     if updated, cannot conflict with the actual outputs).  */
6437
  reg2 = reg1 = -1;
6438
  for (i = 0; i < num_operands; ++i)
6439
    {
6440
      int regno = 0;
6441
 
6442
      reg_class = 0;
6443
      switch (idesc->operands[i])
6444
        {
6445
        case IA64_OPND_R1:
6446
        case IA64_OPND_R2:
6447
        case IA64_OPND_R3:
6448
          if (i < num_outputs)
6449
            {
6450
              if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number == REG_GR)
6451
                reg_class = 'r';
6452
              else if (reg1 < 0)
6453
                reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6454
              else if (reg2 < 0)
6455
                reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6456
            }
6457
          break;
6458
        case IA64_OPND_P1:
6459
        case IA64_OPND_P2:
6460
          if (i < num_outputs)
6461
            {
6462
              if (reg1 < 0)
6463
                reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6464
              else if (reg2 < 0)
6465
                reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6466
            }
6467
          break;
6468
        case IA64_OPND_F1:
6469
        case IA64_OPND_F2:
6470
        case IA64_OPND_F3:
6471
        case IA64_OPND_F4:
6472
          if (i < num_outputs)
6473
            {
6474
              if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number >= REG_FR
6475
                  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number <= REG_FR + 1)
6476
                {
6477
                  reg_class = 'f';
6478
                  regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
6479
                }
6480
              else if (reg1 < 0)
6481
                reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6482
              else if (reg2 < 0)
6483
                reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6484
            }
6485
          break;
6486
        case IA64_OPND_MR3:
6487
          if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_POSTINC)
6488
            {
6489
              if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number == REG_GR)
6490
                reg_class = 'm';
6491
              else if (reg1 < 0)
6492
                reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6493
              else if (reg2 < 0)
6494
                reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6495
            }
6496
          break;
6497
        default:
6498
          break;
6499
        }
6500
      switch (reg_class)
6501
        {
6502
        case 0:
6503
          break;
6504
        default:
6505
          as_warn (_("Invalid use of `%c%d' as output operand"), reg_class, regno);
6506
          break;
6507
        case 'm':
6508
          as_warn (_("Invalid use of `r%d' as base update address operand"), regno);
6509
          break;
6510
        }
6511
    }
6512
  if (reg1 == reg2)
6513
    {
6514
      if (reg1 >= REG_GR && reg1 <= REG_GR + 127)
6515
        {
6516
          reg1 -= REG_GR;
6517
          reg_class = 'r';
6518
        }
6519
      else if (reg1 >= REG_P && reg1 <= REG_P + 63)
6520
        {
6521
          reg1 -= REG_P;
6522
          reg_class = 'p';
6523
        }
6524
      else if (reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127)
6525
        {
6526
          reg1 -= REG_FR;
6527
          reg_class = 'f';
6528
        }
6529
      else
6530
        reg_class = 0;
6531
      if (reg_class)
6532
        as_warn (_("Invalid duplicate use of `%c%d'"), reg_class, reg1);
6533
    }
6534
  else if (((reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 31
6535
             && reg2 >= REG_FR && reg2 <= REG_FR + 31)
6536
            || (reg1 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127
6537
             && reg2 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg2 <= REG_FR + 127))
6538
           && ! ((reg1 ^ reg2) & 1))
6539
    as_warn (_("Invalid simultaneous use of `f%d' and `f%d'"),
6540
             reg1 - REG_FR, reg2 - REG_FR);
6541
  else if ((reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 31
6542
            && reg2 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg2 <= REG_FR + 127)
6543
           || (reg1 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127
6544
            && reg2 >= REG_FR && reg2 <= REG_FR + 31))
6545
    as_warn (_("Dangerous simultaneous use of `f%d' and `f%d'"),
6546
             reg1 - REG_FR, reg2 - REG_FR);
6547
  return idesc;
6548
}
6549
 
6550
static void
6551
build_insn (slot, insnp)
6552
     struct slot *slot;
6553
     bfd_vma *insnp;
6554
{
6555
  const struct ia64_operand *odesc, *o2desc;
6556
  struct ia64_opcode *idesc = slot->idesc;
6557
  bfd_vma insn;
6558
  bfd_signed_vma val;
6559
  const char *err;
6560
  int i;
6561
 
6562
  insn = idesc->opcode | slot->qp_regno;
6563
 
6564
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands) && idesc->operands[i]; ++i)
6565
    {
6566
      if (slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_register
6567
          || slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_constant
6568
          || slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_index)
6569
        val = slot->opnd[i].X_add_number;
6570
      else if (slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_big)
6571
        {
6572
          /* This must be the value 0x10000000000000000.  */
6573
          assert (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8);
6574
          val = 0;
6575
        }
6576
      else
6577
        val = 0;
6578
 
6579
      switch (idesc->operands[i])
6580
        {
6581
        case IA64_OPND_IMMU64:
6582
          *insnp++ = (val >> 22) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
6583
          insn |= (((val & 0x7f) << 13) | (((val >> 7) & 0x1ff) << 27)
6584
                   | (((val >> 16) & 0x1f) << 22) | (((val >> 21) & 0x1) << 21)
6585
                   | (((val >> 63) & 0x1) << 36));
6586
          continue;
6587
 
6588
        case IA64_OPND_IMMU62:
6589
          val &= 0x3fffffffffffffffULL;
6590
          if (val != slot->opnd[i].X_add_number)
6591
            as_warn (_("Value truncated to 62 bits"));
6592
          *insnp++ = (val >> 21) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
6593
          insn |= (((val & 0xfffff) << 6) | (((val >> 20) & 0x1) << 36));
6594
          continue;
6595
 
6596
        case IA64_OPND_TGT64:
6597
          val >>= 4;
6598
          *insnp++ = ((val >> 20) & 0x7fffffffffLL) << 2;
6599
          insn |= ((((val >> 59) & 0x1) << 36)
6600
                   | (((val >> 0) & 0xfffff) << 13));
6601
          continue;
6602
 
6603
        case IA64_OPND_AR3:
6604
          val -= REG_AR;
6605
          break;
6606
 
6607
        case IA64_OPND_B1:
6608
        case IA64_OPND_B2:
6609
          val -= REG_BR;
6610
          break;
6611
 
6612
        case IA64_OPND_CR3:
6613
          val -= REG_CR;
6614
          break;
6615
 
6616
        case IA64_OPND_F1:
6617
        case IA64_OPND_F2:
6618
        case IA64_OPND_F3:
6619
        case IA64_OPND_F4:
6620
          val -= REG_FR;
6621
          break;
6622
 
6623
        case IA64_OPND_P1:
6624
        case IA64_OPND_P2:
6625
          val -= REG_P;
6626
          break;
6627
 
6628
        case IA64_OPND_R1:
6629
        case IA64_OPND_R2:
6630
        case IA64_OPND_R3:
6631
        case IA64_OPND_R3_2:
6632
        case IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3:
6633
        case IA64_OPND_DBR_R3:
6634
        case IA64_OPND_DTR_R3:
6635
        case IA64_OPND_ITR_R3:
6636
        case IA64_OPND_IBR_R3:
6637
        case IA64_OPND_MR3:
6638
        case IA64_OPND_MSR_R3:
6639
        case IA64_OPND_PKR_R3:
6640
        case IA64_OPND_PMC_R3:
6641
        case IA64_OPND_PMD_R3:
6642
        case IA64_OPND_RR_R3:
6643
          val -= REG_GR;
6644
          break;
6645
 
6646
        default:
6647
          break;
6648
        }
6649
 
6650
      odesc = elf64_ia64_operands + idesc->operands[i];
6651
      err = (*odesc->insert) (odesc, val, &insn);
6652
      if (err)
6653
        as_bad_where (slot->src_file, slot->src_line,
6654
                      _("Bad operand value: %s"), err);
6655
      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_PSEUDO)
6656
        {
6657
          if ((idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_F2_EQ_F3)
6658
              && odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_F3)
6659
            {
6660
              o2desc = elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_F2;
6661
              (*o2desc->insert) (o2desc, val, &insn);
6662
            }
6663
          if ((idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_LEN_EQ_64MCNT)
6664
              && (odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_CPOS6a
6665
                  || odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_POS6))
6666
            {
6667
              o2desc = elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_LEN6;
6668
              (*o2desc->insert) (o2desc, 64 - val, &insn);
6669
            }
6670
        }
6671
    }
6672
  *insnp = insn;
6673
}
6674
 
6675
static void
6676
emit_one_bundle ()
6677
{
6678
  int manual_bundling_off = 0, manual_bundling = 0;
6679
  enum ia64_unit required_unit, insn_unit = 0;
6680
  enum ia64_insn_type type[3], insn_type;
6681
  unsigned int template, orig_template;
6682
  bfd_vma insn[3] = { -1, -1, -1 };
6683
  struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
6684
  int end_of_insn_group = 0, user_template = -1;
6685
  int n, i, j, first, curr, last_slot;
6686
  bfd_vma t0 = 0, t1 = 0;
6687
  struct label_fix *lfix;
6688
  bfd_boolean mark_label;
6689
  struct insn_fix *ifix;
6690
  char mnemonic[16];
6691
  fixS *fix;
6692
  char *f;
6693
  int addr_mod;
6694
 
6695
  first = (md.curr_slot + NUM_SLOTS - md.num_slots_in_use) % NUM_SLOTS;
6696
  know (first >= 0 && first < NUM_SLOTS);
6697
  n = MIN (3, md.num_slots_in_use);
6698
 
6699
  /* Determine template: user user_template if specified, best match
6700
     otherwise:  */
6701
 
6702
  if (md.slot[first].user_template >= 0)
6703
    user_template = template = md.slot[first].user_template;
6704
  else
6705
    {
6706
      /* Auto select appropriate template.  */
6707
      memset (type, 0, sizeof (type));
6708
      curr = first;
6709
      for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
6710
        {
6711
          if (md.slot[curr].label_fixups && i != 0)
6712
            break;
6713
          type[i] = md.slot[curr].idesc->type;
6714
          curr = (curr + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
6715
        }
6716
      template = best_template[type[0]][type[1]][type[2]];
6717
    }
6718
 
6719
  /* initialize instructions with appropriate nops:  */
6720
  for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
6721
    insn[i] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[template].exec_unit[i]];
6722
 
6723
  f = frag_more (16);
6724
 
6725
  /* Check to see if this bundle is at an offset that is a multiple of 16-bytes
6726
     from the start of the frag.  */
6727
  addr_mod = frag_now_fix () & 15;
6728
  if (frag_now->has_code && frag_now->insn_addr != addr_mod)
6729
    as_bad (_("instruction address is not a multiple of 16"));
6730
  frag_now->insn_addr = addr_mod;
6731
  frag_now->has_code = 1;
6732
 
6733
  /* now fill in slots with as many insns as possible:  */
6734
  curr = first;
6735
  idesc = md.slot[curr].idesc;
6736
  end_of_insn_group = 0;
6737
  last_slot = -1;
6738
  for (i = 0; i < 3 && md.num_slots_in_use > 0; ++i)
6739
    {
6740
      /* If we have unwind records, we may need to update some now.  */
6741
      unw_rec_list *ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record;
6742
      unw_rec_list *end_ptr = NULL;
6743
 
6744
      if (ptr)
6745
        {
6746
          /* Find the last prologue/body record in the list for the current
6747
             insn, and set the slot number for all records up to that point.
6748
             This needs to be done now, because prologue/body records refer to
6749
             the current point, not the point after the instruction has been
6750
             issued.  This matters because there may have been nops emitted
6751
             meanwhile.  Any non-prologue non-body record followed by a
6752
             prologue/body record must also refer to the current point.  */
6753
          unw_rec_list *last_ptr;
6754
 
6755
          for (j = 1; end_ptr == NULL && j < md.num_slots_in_use; ++j)
6756
            end_ptr = md.slot[(curr + j) % NUM_SLOTS].unwind_record;
6757
          for (last_ptr = NULL; ptr != end_ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
6758
            if (ptr->r.type == prologue || ptr->r.type == prologue_gr
6759
                || ptr->r.type == body)
6760
              last_ptr = ptr;
6761
          if (last_ptr)
6762
            {
6763
              /* Make last_ptr point one after the last prologue/body
6764
                 record.  */
6765
              last_ptr = last_ptr->next;
6766
              for (ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record; ptr != last_ptr;
6767
                   ptr = ptr->next)
6768
                {
6769
                  ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) f + i;
6770
                  ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
6771
                }
6772
              /* Remove the initialized records, so that we won't accidentally
6773
                 update them again if we insert a nop and continue.  */
6774
              md.slot[curr].unwind_record = last_ptr;
6775
            }
6776
        }
6777
 
6778
      manual_bundling_off = md.slot[curr].manual_bundling_off;
6779
      if (md.slot[curr].manual_bundling_on)
6780
        {
6781
          if (curr == first)
6782
            manual_bundling = 1;
6783
          else
6784
          break; /* Need to start a new bundle.  */
6785
        }
6786
 
6787
      /* If this instruction specifies a template, then it must be the first
6788
         instruction of a bundle.  */
6789
      if (curr != first && md.slot[curr].user_template >= 0)
6790
        break;
6791
 
6792
      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_SLOT2)
6793
        {
6794
          if (manual_bundling && !manual_bundling_off)
6795
            {
6796
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6797
                            _("`%s' must be last in bundle"), idesc->name);
6798
              if (i < 2)
6799
                manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6800
            }
6801
          i = 2;
6802
        }
6803
      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_LAST)
6804
        {
6805
          int required_slot;
6806
          unsigned int required_template;
6807
 
6808
          /* If we need a stop bit after an M slot, our only choice is
6809
             template 5 (M;;MI).  If we need a stop bit after a B
6810
             slot, our only choice is to place it at the end of the
6811
             bundle, because the only available templates are MIB,
6812
             MBB, BBB, MMB, and MFB.  We don't handle anything other
6813
             than M and B slots because these are the only kind of
6814
             instructions that can have the IA64_OPCODE_LAST bit set.  */
6815
          required_template = template;
6816
          switch (idesc->type)
6817
            {
6818
            case IA64_TYPE_M:
6819
              required_slot = 0;
6820
              required_template = 5;
6821
              break;
6822
 
6823
            case IA64_TYPE_B:
6824
              required_slot = 2;
6825
              break;
6826
 
6827
            default:
6828
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6829
                            _("Internal error: don't know how to force %s to end of instruction group"),
6830
                            idesc->name);
6831
              required_slot = i;
6832
              break;
6833
            }
6834
          if (manual_bundling
6835
              && (i > required_slot
6836
                  || (required_slot == 2 && !manual_bundling_off)
6837
                  || (user_template >= 0
6838
                      /* Changing from MMI to M;MI is OK.  */
6839
                      && (template ^ required_template) > 1)))
6840
            {
6841
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6842
                            _("`%s' must be last in instruction group"),
6843
                            idesc->name);
6844
              if (i < 2 && required_slot == 2 && !manual_bundling_off)
6845
                manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6846
            }
6847
          if (required_slot < i)
6848
            /* Can't fit this instruction.  */
6849
            break;
6850
 
6851
          i = required_slot;
6852
          if (required_template != template)
6853
            {
6854
              /* If we switch the template, we need to reset the NOPs
6855
                 after slot i.  The slot-types of the instructions ahead
6856
                 of i never change, so we don't need to worry about
6857
                 changing NOPs in front of this slot.  */
6858
              for (j = i; j < 3; ++j)
6859
                insn[j] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[required_template].exec_unit[j]];
6860
 
6861
              /* We just picked a template that includes the stop bit in the
6862
                 middle, so we don't need another one emitted later.  */
6863
              md.slot[curr].end_of_insn_group = 0;
6864
            }
6865
          template = required_template;
6866
        }
6867
      if (curr != first && md.slot[curr].label_fixups)
6868
        {
6869
          if (manual_bundling)
6870
            {
6871
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6872
                            _("Label must be first in a bundle"));
6873
              manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6874
            }
6875
          /* This insn must go into the first slot of a bundle.  */
6876
          break;
6877
        }
6878
 
6879
      if (end_of_insn_group && md.num_slots_in_use >= 1)
6880
        {
6881
          /* We need an instruction group boundary in the middle of a
6882
             bundle.  See if we can switch to an other template with
6883
             an appropriate boundary.  */
6884
 
6885
          orig_template = template;
6886
          if (i == 1 && (user_template == 4
6887
                         || (user_template < 0
6888
                             && (ia64_templ_desc[template].exec_unit[0]
6889
                                 == IA64_UNIT_M))))
6890
            {
6891
              template = 5;
6892
              end_of_insn_group = 0;
6893
            }
6894
          else if (i == 2 && (user_template == 0
6895
                              || (user_template < 0
6896
                                  && (ia64_templ_desc[template].exec_unit[1]
6897
                                      == IA64_UNIT_I)))
6898
                   /* This test makes sure we don't switch the template if
6899
                      the next instruction is one that needs to be first in
6900
                      an instruction group.  Since all those instructions are
6901
                      in the M group, there is no way such an instruction can
6902
                      fit in this bundle even if we switch the template.  The
6903
                      reason we have to check for this is that otherwise we
6904
                      may end up generating "MI;;I M.." which has the deadly
6905
                      effect that the second M instruction is no longer the
6906
                      first in the group! --davidm 99/12/16  */
6907
                   && (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST) == 0)
6908
            {
6909
              template = 1;
6910
              end_of_insn_group = 0;
6911
            }
6912
          else if (i == 1
6913
                   && user_template == 0
6914
                   && !(idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST))
6915
            /* Use the next slot.  */
6916
            continue;
6917
          else if (curr != first)
6918
            /* can't fit this insn */
6919
            break;
6920
 
6921
          if (template != orig_template)
6922
            /* if we switch the template, we need to reset the NOPs
6923
               after slot i.  The slot-types of the instructions ahead
6924
               of i never change, so we don't need to worry about
6925
               changing NOPs in front of this slot.  */
6926
            for (j = i; j < 3; ++j)
6927
              insn[j] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[template].exec_unit[j]];
6928
        }
6929
      required_unit = ia64_templ_desc[template].exec_unit[i];
6930
 
6931
      /* resolve dynamic opcodes such as "break", "hint", and "nop":  */
6932
      if (idesc->type == IA64_TYPE_DYN)
6933
        {
6934
          enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
6935
 
6936
          if ((strcmp (idesc->name, "nop") == 0)
6937
              || (strcmp (idesc->name, "break") == 0))
6938
            insn_unit = required_unit;
6939
          else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "hint") == 0)
6940
            {
6941
              insn_unit = required_unit;
6942
              if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_B)
6943
                {
6944
                  switch (md.hint_b)
6945
                    {
6946
                    case hint_b_ok:
6947
                      break;
6948
                    case hint_b_warning:
6949
                      as_warn (_("hint in B unit may be treated as nop"));
6950
                      break;
6951
                    case hint_b_error:
6952
                      /* When manual bundling is off and there is no
6953
                         user template, we choose a different unit so
6954
                         that hint won't go into the current slot. We
6955
                         will fill the current bundle with nops and
6956
                         try to put hint into the next bundle.  */
6957
                      if (!manual_bundling && user_template < 0)
6958
                        insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I;
6959
                      else
6960
                        as_bad (_("hint in B unit can't be used"));
6961
                      break;
6962
                    }
6963
                }
6964
            }
6965
          else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "chk.s") == 0
6966
              || strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0)
6967
            {
6968
              insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_M;
6969
              if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_I
6970
                  || (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_F && template == 6))
6971
                insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I;
6972
            }
6973
          else
6974
            as_fatal (_("emit_one_bundle: unexpected dynamic op"));
6975
 
6976
          snprintf (mnemonic, sizeof (mnemonic), "%s.%c",
6977
                    idesc->name, "?imbfxx"[insn_unit]);
6978
          opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
6979
          opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
6980
          ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
6981
          idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
6982
          /* moves to/from ARs have collisions */
6983
          if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3 || opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
6984
            {
6985
              while (idesc != NULL
6986
                     && (idesc->operands[0] != opnd1
6987
                         || idesc->operands[1] != opnd2))
6988
                idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc);
6989
            }
6990
          md.slot[curr].idesc = idesc;
6991
        }
6992
      else
6993
        {
6994
          insn_type = idesc->type;
6995
          insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_NIL;
6996
          switch (insn_type)
6997
            {
6998
            case IA64_TYPE_A:
6999
              if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_I || required_unit == IA64_UNIT_M)
7000
                insn_unit = required_unit;
7001
              break;
7002
            case IA64_TYPE_X: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_L; break;
7003
            case IA64_TYPE_I: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I; break;
7004
            case IA64_TYPE_M: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_M; break;
7005
            case IA64_TYPE_B: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_B; break;
7006
            case IA64_TYPE_F: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_F; break;
7007
            default:                                   break;
7008
            }
7009
        }
7010
 
7011
      if (insn_unit != required_unit)
7012
        continue;               /* Try next slot.  */
7013
 
7014
      /* Now is a good time to fix up the labels for this insn.  */
7015
      mark_label = FALSE;
7016
      for (lfix = md.slot[curr].label_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
7017
        {
7018
          S_SET_VALUE (lfix->sym, frag_now_fix () - 16);
7019
          symbol_set_frag (lfix->sym, frag_now);
7020
          mark_label |= lfix->dw2_mark_labels;
7021
        }
7022
      for (lfix = md.slot[curr].tag_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
7023
        {
7024
          S_SET_VALUE (lfix->sym, frag_now_fix () - 16 + i);
7025
          symbol_set_frag (lfix->sym, frag_now);
7026
        }
7027
 
7028
      if (debug_type == DEBUG_DWARF2
7029
          || md.slot[curr].loc_directive_seen
7030
          || mark_label)
7031
        {
7032
          bfd_vma addr = frag_now->fr_address + frag_now_fix () - 16 + i;
7033
 
7034
          md.slot[curr].loc_directive_seen = 0;
7035
          if (mark_label)
7036
            md.slot[curr].debug_line.flags |= DWARF2_FLAG_BASIC_BLOCK;
7037
 
7038
          dwarf2_gen_line_info (addr, &md.slot[curr].debug_line);
7039
        }
7040
 
7041
      build_insn (md.slot + curr, insn + i);
7042
 
7043
      ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record;
7044
      if (ptr)
7045
        {
7046
          /* Set slot numbers for all remaining unwind records belonging to the
7047
             current insn.  There can not be any prologue/body unwind records
7048
             here.  */
7049
          for (; ptr != end_ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
7050
            {
7051
              ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) f + i;
7052
              ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
7053
            }
7054
          md.slot[curr].unwind_record = NULL;
7055
        }
7056
 
7057
      if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_L)
7058
        {
7059
          know (i == 1);
7060
          /* skip one slot for long/X-unit instructions */
7061
          ++i;
7062
        }
7063
      --md.num_slots_in_use;
7064
      last_slot = i;
7065
 
7066
      for (j = 0; j < md.slot[curr].num_fixups; ++j)
7067
        {
7068
          ifix = md.slot[curr].fixup + j;
7069
          fix = fix_new_exp (frag_now, frag_now_fix () - 16 + i, 8,
7070
                             &ifix->expr, ifix->is_pcrel, ifix->code);
7071
          fix->tc_fix_data.opnd = ifix->opnd;
7072
          fix->fx_file = md.slot[curr].src_file;
7073
          fix->fx_line = md.slot[curr].src_line;
7074
        }
7075
 
7076
      end_of_insn_group = md.slot[curr].end_of_insn_group;
7077
 
7078
      /* clear slot:  */
7079
      ia64_free_opcode (md.slot[curr].idesc);
7080
      memset (md.slot + curr, 0, sizeof (md.slot[curr]));
7081
      md.slot[curr].user_template = -1;
7082
 
7083
      if (manual_bundling_off)
7084
        {
7085
          manual_bundling = 0;
7086
          break;
7087
        }
7088
      curr = (curr + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
7089
      idesc = md.slot[curr].idesc;
7090
    }
7091
 
7092
  /* A user template was specified, but the first following instruction did
7093
     not fit.  This can happen with or without manual bundling.  */
7094
  if (md.num_slots_in_use > 0 && last_slot < 0)
7095
    {
7096
      as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
7097
                    _("`%s' does not fit into %s template"),
7098
                    idesc->name, ia64_templ_desc[template].name);
7099
      /* Drop first insn so we don't livelock.  */
7100
      --md.num_slots_in_use;
7101
      know (curr == first);
7102
      ia64_free_opcode (md.slot[curr].idesc);
7103
      memset (md.slot + curr, 0, sizeof (md.slot[curr]));
7104
      md.slot[curr].user_template = -1;
7105
    }
7106
  else if (manual_bundling > 0)
7107
    {
7108
      if (md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
7109
        {
7110
          if (last_slot >= 2)
7111
            as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
7112
                          _("`%s' does not fit into bundle"), idesc->name);
7113
          else
7114
            {
7115
              const char *where;
7116
 
7117
              if (template == 2)
7118
                where = "X slot";
7119
              else if (last_slot == 0)
7120
                where = "slots 2 or 3";
7121
              else
7122
                where = "slot 3";
7123
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
7124
                            _("`%s' can't go in %s of %s template"),
7125
                            idesc->name, where, ia64_templ_desc[template].name);
7126
            }
7127
        }
7128
      else
7129
        as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
7130
                      _("Missing '}' at end of file"));
7131
    }
7132
 
7133
  know (md.num_slots_in_use < NUM_SLOTS);
7134
 
7135
  t0 = end_of_insn_group | (template << 1) | (insn[0] << 5) | (insn[1] << 46);
7136
  t1 = ((insn[1] >> 18) & 0x7fffff) | (insn[2] << 23);
7137
 
7138
  number_to_chars_littleendian (f + 0, t0, 8);
7139
  number_to_chars_littleendian (f + 8, t1, 8);
7140
}
7141
 
7142
int
7143
md_parse_option (c, arg)
7144
     int c;
7145
     char *arg;
7146
{
7147
 
7148
  switch (c)
7149
    {
7150
    /* Switches from the Intel assembler.  */
7151
    case 'm':
7152
      if (strcmp (arg, "ilp64") == 0
7153
          || strcmp (arg, "lp64") == 0
7154
          || strcmp (arg, "p64") == 0)
7155
        {
7156
          md.flags |= EF_IA_64_ABI64;
7157
        }
7158
      else if (strcmp (arg, "ilp32") == 0)
7159
        {
7160
          md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_ABI64;
7161
        }
7162
      else if (strcmp (arg, "le") == 0)
7163
        {
7164
          md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_BE;
7165
          default_big_endian = 0;
7166
        }
7167
      else if (strcmp (arg, "be") == 0)
7168
        {
7169
          md.flags |= EF_IA_64_BE;
7170
          default_big_endian = 1;
7171
        }
7172
      else if (strncmp (arg, "unwind-check=", 13) == 0)
7173
        {
7174
          arg += 13;
7175
          if (strcmp (arg, "warning") == 0)
7176
            md.unwind_check = unwind_check_warning;
7177
          else if (strcmp (arg, "error") == 0)
7178
            md.unwind_check = unwind_check_error;
7179
          else
7180
            return 0;
7181
        }
7182
      else if (strncmp (arg, "hint.b=", 7) == 0)
7183
        {
7184
          arg += 7;
7185
          if (strcmp (arg, "ok") == 0)
7186
            md.hint_b = hint_b_ok;
7187
          else if (strcmp (arg, "warning") == 0)
7188
            md.hint_b = hint_b_warning;
7189
          else if (strcmp (arg, "error") == 0)
7190
            md.hint_b = hint_b_error;
7191
          else
7192
            return 0;
7193
        }
7194
      else if (strncmp (arg, "tune=", 5) == 0)
7195
        {
7196
          arg += 5;
7197
          if (strcmp (arg, "itanium1") == 0)
7198
            md.tune = itanium1;
7199
          else if (strcmp (arg, "itanium2") == 0)
7200
            md.tune = itanium2;
7201
          else
7202
            return 0;
7203
        }
7204
      else
7205
        return 0;
7206
      break;
7207
 
7208
    case 'N':
7209
      if (strcmp (arg, "so") == 0)
7210
        {
7211
          /* Suppress signon message.  */
7212
        }
7213
      else if (strcmp (arg, "pi") == 0)
7214
        {
7215
          /* Reject privileged instructions.  FIXME */
7216
        }
7217
      else if (strcmp (arg, "us") == 0)
7218
        {
7219
          /* Allow union of signed and unsigned range.  FIXME */
7220
        }
7221
      else if (strcmp (arg, "close_fcalls") == 0)
7222
        {
7223
          /* Do not resolve global function calls.  */
7224
        }
7225
      else
7226
        return 0;
7227
      break;
7228
 
7229
    case 'C':
7230
      /* temp[="prefix"]  Insert temporary labels into the object file
7231
                          symbol table prefixed by "prefix".
7232
                          Default prefix is ":temp:".
7233
       */
7234
      break;
7235
 
7236
    case 'a':
7237
      /* indirect=<tgt> Assume unannotated indirect branches behavior
7238
                        according to <tgt> --
7239
                        exit:   branch out from the current context (default)
7240
                        labels: all labels in context may be branch targets
7241
       */
7242
      if (strncmp (arg, "indirect=", 9) != 0)
7243
        return 0;
7244
      break;
7245
 
7246
    case 'x':
7247
      /* -X conflicts with an ignored option, use -x instead */
7248
      md.detect_dv = 1;
7249
      if (!arg || strcmp (arg, "explicit") == 0)
7250
        {
7251
          /* set default mode to explicit */
7252
          md.default_explicit_mode = 1;
7253
          break;
7254
        }
7255
      else if (strcmp (arg, "auto") == 0)
7256
        {
7257
          md.default_explicit_mode = 0;
7258
        }
7259
      else if (strcmp (arg, "none") == 0)
7260
        {
7261
          md.detect_dv = 0;
7262
        }
7263
      else if (strcmp (arg, "debug") == 0)
7264
        {
7265
          md.debug_dv = 1;
7266
        }
7267
      else if (strcmp (arg, "debugx") == 0)
7268
        {
7269
          md.default_explicit_mode = 1;
7270
          md.debug_dv = 1;
7271
        }
7272
      else if (strcmp (arg, "debugn") == 0)
7273
        {
7274
          md.debug_dv = 1;
7275
          md.detect_dv = 0;
7276
        }
7277
      else
7278
        {
7279
          as_bad (_("Unrecognized option '-x%s'"), arg);
7280
        }
7281
      break;
7282
 
7283
    case 'S':
7284
      /* nops           Print nops statistics.  */
7285
      break;
7286
 
7287
    /* GNU specific switches for gcc.  */
7288
    case OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP:
7289
      md.flags |= EF_IA_64_CONS_GP;
7290
      break;
7291
 
7292
    case OPTION_MAUTO_PIC:
7293
      md.flags |= EF_IA_64_NOFUNCDESC_CONS_GP;
7294
      break;
7295
 
7296
    default:
7297
      return 0;
7298
    }
7299
 
7300
  return 1;
7301
}
7302
 
7303
void
7304
md_show_usage (stream)
7305
     FILE *stream;
7306
{
7307
  fputs (_("\
7308
IA-64 options:\n\
7309
  --mconstant-gp          mark output file as using the constant-GP model\n\
7310
                          (sets ELF header flag EF_IA_64_CONS_GP)\n\
7311
  --mauto-pic             mark output file as using the constant-GP model\n\
7312
                          without function descriptors (sets ELF header flag\n\
7313
                          EF_IA_64_NOFUNCDESC_CONS_GP)\n\
7314
  -milp32|-milp64|-mlp64|-mp64  select data model (default -mlp64)\n\
7315
  -mle | -mbe             select little- or big-endian byte order (default -mle)\n\
7316
  -mtune=[itanium1|itanium2]\n\
7317
                          tune for a specific CPU (default -mtune=itanium2)\n\
7318
  -munwind-check=[warning|error]\n\
7319
                          unwind directive check (default -munwind-check=warning)\n\
7320
  -mhint.b=[ok|warning|error]\n\
7321
                          hint.b check (default -mhint.b=error)\n\
7322
  -x | -xexplicit         turn on dependency violation checking\n\
7323
  -xauto                  automagically remove dependency violations (default)\n\
7324
  -xnone                  turn off dependency violation checking\n\
7325
  -xdebug                 debug dependency violation checker\n\
7326
  -xdebugn                debug dependency violation checker but turn off\n\
7327
                          dependency violation checking\n\
7328
  -xdebugx                debug dependency violation checker and turn on\n\
7329
                          dependency violation checking\n"),
7330
        stream);
7331
}
7332
 
7333
void
7334
ia64_after_parse_args ()
7335
{
7336
  if (debug_type == DEBUG_STABS)
7337
    as_fatal (_("--gstabs is not supported for ia64"));
7338
}
7339
 
7340
/* Return true if TYPE fits in TEMPL at SLOT.  */
7341
 
7342
static int
7343
match (int templ, int type, int slot)
7344
{
7345
  enum ia64_unit unit;
7346
  int result;
7347
 
7348
  unit = ia64_templ_desc[templ].exec_unit[slot];
7349
  switch (type)
7350
    {
7351
    case IA64_TYPE_DYN: result = 1; break; /* for nop and break */
7352
    case IA64_TYPE_A:
7353
      result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_I || unit == IA64_UNIT_M);
7354
      break;
7355
    case IA64_TYPE_X:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_L); break;
7356
    case IA64_TYPE_I:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_I); break;
7357
    case IA64_TYPE_M:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_M); break;
7358
    case IA64_TYPE_B:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_B); break;
7359
    case IA64_TYPE_F:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_F); break;
7360
    default:            result = 0; break;
7361
    }
7362
  return result;
7363
}
7364
 
7365
/* For Itanium 1, add a bit of extra goodness if a nop of type F or B would fit
7366
   in TEMPL at SLOT.  For Itanium 2, add a bit of extra goodness if a nop of
7367
   type M or I would fit in TEMPL at SLOT.  */
7368
 
7369
static inline int
7370
extra_goodness (int templ, int slot)
7371
{
7372
  switch (md.tune)
7373
    {
7374
    case itanium1:
7375
      if (slot == 1 && match (templ, IA64_TYPE_F, slot))
7376
        return 2;
7377
      else if (slot == 2 && match (templ, IA64_TYPE_B, slot))
7378
        return 1;
7379
      else
7380
        return 0;
7381
      break;
7382
    case itanium2:
7383
      if (match (templ, IA64_TYPE_M, slot)
7384
          || match (templ, IA64_TYPE_I, slot))
7385
        /* Favor M- and I-unit NOPs.  We definitely want to avoid
7386
           F-unit and B-unit may cause split-issue or less-than-optimal
7387
           branch-prediction.  */
7388
        return 2;
7389
      else
7390
        return 0;
7391
      break;
7392
    default:
7393
      abort ();
7394
      return 0;
7395
    }
7396
}
7397
 
7398
/* This function is called once, at assembler startup time.  It sets
7399
   up all the tables, etc. that the MD part of the assembler will need
7400
   that can be determined before arguments are parsed.  */
7401
void
7402
md_begin ()
7403
{
7404
  int i, j, k, t, goodness, best, ok;
7405
  const char *err;
7406
  char name[8];
7407
 
7408
  md.auto_align = 1;
7409
  md.explicit_mode = md.default_explicit_mode;
7410
 
7411
  bfd_set_section_alignment (stdoutput, text_section, 4);
7412
 
7413
  /* Make sure function pointers get initialized.  */
7414
  target_big_endian = -1;
7415
  dot_byteorder (default_big_endian);
7416
 
7417
  alias_hash = hash_new ();
7418
  alias_name_hash = hash_new ();
7419
  secalias_hash = hash_new ();
7420
  secalias_name_hash = hash_new ();
7421
 
7422
  pseudo_func[FUNC_DTP_MODULE].u.sym =
7423
    symbol_new (".<dtpmod>", undefined_section, FUNC_DTP_MODULE,
7424
                &zero_address_frag);
7425
 
7426
  pseudo_func[FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7427
    symbol_new (".<dtprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE,
7428
                &zero_address_frag);
7429
 
7430
  pseudo_func[FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7431
    symbol_new (".<fptr>", undefined_section, FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE,
7432
                &zero_address_frag);
7433
 
7434
  pseudo_func[FUNC_GP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7435
    symbol_new (".<gprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_GP_RELATIVE,
7436
                &zero_address_frag);
7437
 
7438
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7439
    symbol_new (".<ltoff>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_RELATIVE,
7440
                &zero_address_frag);
7441
 
7442
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X].u.sym =
7443
    symbol_new (".<ltoffx>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X,
7444
                &zero_address_frag);
7445
 
7446
  pseudo_func[FUNC_PC_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7447
    symbol_new (".<pcrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_PC_RELATIVE,
7448
                &zero_address_frag);
7449
 
7450
  pseudo_func[FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7451
    symbol_new (".<pltoff>", undefined_section, FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE,
7452
                &zero_address_frag);
7453
 
7454
  pseudo_func[FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7455
    symbol_new (".<secrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE,
7456
                &zero_address_frag);
7457
 
7458
  pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7459
    symbol_new (".<segrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE,
7460
                &zero_address_frag);
7461
 
7462
  pseudo_func[FUNC_TP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7463
    symbol_new (".<tprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_TP_RELATIVE,
7464
                &zero_address_frag);
7465
 
7466
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7467
    symbol_new (".<ltv>", undefined_section, FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE,
7468
                &zero_address_frag);
7469
 
7470
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7471
    symbol_new (".<ltoff.fptr>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE,
7472
                &zero_address_frag);
7473
 
7474
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE].u.sym =
7475
    symbol_new (".<ltoff.dtpmod>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE,
7476
                &zero_address_frag);
7477
 
7478
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7479
    symbol_new (".<ltoff.dptrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE,
7480
                &zero_address_frag);
7481
 
7482
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7483
    symbol_new (".<ltoff.tprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE,
7484
                &zero_address_frag);
7485
 
7486
  pseudo_func[FUNC_IPLT_RELOC].u.sym =
7487
    symbol_new (".<iplt>", undefined_section, FUNC_IPLT_RELOC,
7488
                &zero_address_frag);
7489
 
7490
 if (md.tune != itanium1)
7491
   {
7492
     /* Convert MFI NOPs bundles into MMI NOPs bundles.  */
7493
     le_nop[0] = 0x8;
7494
     le_nop_stop[0] = 0x9;
7495
   }
7496
 
7497
  /* Compute the table of best templates.  We compute goodness as a
7498
     base 4 value, in which each match counts for 3.  Match-failures
7499
     result in NOPs and we use extra_goodness() to pick the execution
7500
     units that are best suited for issuing the NOP.  */
7501
  for (i = 0; i < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++i)
7502
    for (j = 0; j < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++j)
7503
      for (k = 0; k < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++k)
7504
        {
7505
          best = 0;
7506
          for (t = 0; t < NELEMS (ia64_templ_desc); ++t)
7507
            {
7508
              goodness = 0;
7509
              if (match (t, i, 0))
7510
                {
7511
                  if (match (t, j, 1))
7512
                    {
7513
                      if ((t == 2 && j == IA64_TYPE_X) || match (t, k, 2))
7514
                        goodness = 3 + 3 + 3;
7515
                      else
7516
                        goodness = 3 + 3 + extra_goodness (t, 2);
7517
                    }
7518
                  else if (match (t, j, 2))
7519
                    goodness = 3 + 3 + extra_goodness (t, 1);
7520
                  else
7521
                    {
7522
                      goodness = 3;
7523
                      goodness += extra_goodness (t, 1);
7524
                      goodness += extra_goodness (t, 2);
7525
                    }
7526
                }
7527
              else if (match (t, i, 1))
7528
                {
7529
                  if ((t == 2 && i == IA64_TYPE_X) || match (t, j, 2))
7530
                    goodness = 3 + 3;
7531
                  else
7532
                    goodness = 3 + extra_goodness (t, 2);
7533
                }
7534
              else if (match (t, i, 2))
7535
                goodness = 3 + extra_goodness (t, 1);
7536
 
7537
              if (goodness > best)
7538
                {
7539
                  best = goodness;
7540
                  best_template[i][j][k] = t;
7541
                }
7542
            }
7543
        }
7544
 
7545
#ifdef DEBUG_TEMPLATES
7546
  /* For debugging changes to the best_template calculations.  We don't care
7547
     about combinations with invalid instructions, so start the loops at 1.  */
7548
  for (i = 0; i < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++i)
7549
    for (j = 0; j < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++j)
7550
      for (k = 0; k < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++k)
7551
        {
7552
          char type_letter[IA64_NUM_TYPES] = { 'n', 'a', 'i', 'm', 'b', 'f',
7553
                                               'x', 'd' };
7554
          fprintf (stderr, "%c%c%c %s\n", type_letter[i], type_letter[j],
7555
                   type_letter[k],
7556
                   ia64_templ_desc[best_template[i][j][k]].name);
7557
        }
7558
#endif
7559
 
7560
  for (i = 0; i < NUM_SLOTS; ++i)
7561
    md.slot[i].user_template = -1;
7562
 
7563
  md.pseudo_hash = hash_new ();
7564
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (pseudo_opcode); ++i)
7565
    {
7566
      err = hash_insert (md.pseudo_hash, pseudo_opcode[i].name,
7567
                         (void *) (pseudo_opcode + i));
7568
      if (err)
7569
        as_fatal (_("ia64.md_begin: can't hash `%s': %s"),
7570
                  pseudo_opcode[i].name, err);
7571
    }
7572
 
7573
  md.reg_hash = hash_new ();
7574
  md.dynreg_hash = hash_new ();
7575
  md.const_hash = hash_new ();
7576
  md.entry_hash = hash_new ();
7577
 
7578
  /* general registers:  */
7579
  declare_register_set ("r", 128, REG_GR);
7580
  declare_register ("gp", REG_GR +  1);
7581
  declare_register ("sp", REG_GR + 12);
7582
  declare_register ("tp", REG_GR + 13);
7583
  declare_register_set ("ret", 4, REG_GR + 8);
7584
 
7585
  /* floating point registers:  */
7586
  declare_register_set ("f", 128, REG_FR);
7587
  declare_register_set ("farg", 8, REG_FR + 8);
7588
  declare_register_set ("fret", 8, REG_FR + 8);
7589
 
7590
  /* branch registers:  */
7591
  declare_register_set ("b", 8, REG_BR);
7592
  declare_register ("rp", REG_BR + 0);
7593
 
7594
  /* predicate registers:  */
7595
  declare_register_set ("p", 64, REG_P);
7596
  declare_register ("pr", REG_PR);
7597
  declare_register ("pr.rot", REG_PR_ROT);
7598
 
7599
  /* application registers:  */
7600
  declare_register_set ("ar", 128, REG_AR);
7601
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (ar); ++i)
7602
    declare_register (ar[i].name, REG_AR + ar[i].regnum);
7603
 
7604
  /* control registers:  */
7605
  declare_register_set ("cr", 128, REG_CR);
7606
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (cr); ++i)
7607
    declare_register (cr[i].name, REG_CR + cr[i].regnum);
7608
 
7609
  declare_register ("ip", REG_IP);
7610
  declare_register ("cfm", REG_CFM);
7611
  declare_register ("psr", REG_PSR);
7612
  declare_register ("psr.l", REG_PSR_L);
7613
  declare_register ("psr.um", REG_PSR_UM);
7614
 
7615
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (indirect_reg); ++i)
7616
    {
7617
      unsigned int regnum = indirect_reg[i].regnum;
7618
 
7619
      md.indregsym[regnum - IND_CPUID] = declare_register (indirect_reg[i].name, regnum);
7620
    }
7621
 
7622
  /* pseudo-registers used to specify unwind info:  */
7623
  declare_register ("psp", REG_PSP);
7624
 
7625
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (const_bits); ++i)
7626
    {
7627
      err = hash_insert (md.const_hash, const_bits[i].name,
7628
                         (PTR) (const_bits + i));
7629
      if (err)
7630
        as_fatal (_("Inserting \"%s\" into constant hash table failed: %s"),
7631
                  name, err);
7632
    }
7633
 
7634
  /* Set the architecture and machine depending on defaults and command line
7635
     options.  */
7636
  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7637
    ok = bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_ia64, bfd_mach_ia64_elf64);
7638
  else
7639
    ok = bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_ia64, bfd_mach_ia64_elf32);
7640
 
7641
  if (! ok)
7642
     as_warn (_("Could not set architecture and machine"));
7643
 
7644
  /* Set the pointer size and pointer shift size depending on md.flags */
7645
 
7646
  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7647
    {
7648
      md.pointer_size = 8;         /* pointers are 8 bytes */
7649
      md.pointer_size_shift = 3;   /* alignment is 8 bytes = 2^2 */
7650
    }
7651
  else
7652
    {
7653
      md.pointer_size = 4;         /* pointers are 4 bytes */
7654
      md.pointer_size_shift = 2;   /* alignment is 4 bytes = 2^2 */
7655
    }
7656
 
7657
  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
7658
  md.path = 0;
7659
  md.maxpaths = 0;
7660
  md.entry_labels = NULL;
7661
}
7662
 
7663
/* Set the default options in md.  Cannot do this in md_begin because
7664
   that is called after md_parse_option which is where we set the
7665
   options in md based on command line options.  */
7666
 
7667
void
7668
ia64_init (argc, argv)
7669
     int argc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
7670
     char **argv ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
7671
{
7672
  md.flags = MD_FLAGS_DEFAULT;
7673
  md.detect_dv = 1;
7674
  /* FIXME: We should change it to unwind_check_error someday.  */
7675
  md.unwind_check = unwind_check_warning;
7676
  md.hint_b = hint_b_error;
7677
  md.tune = itanium2;
7678
}
7679
 
7680
/* Return a string for the target object file format.  */
7681
 
7682
const char *
7683
ia64_target_format ()
7684
{
7685
  if (OUTPUT_FLAVOR == bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7686
    {
7687
      if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_BE)
7688
        {
7689
          if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7690
#if defined(TE_AIX50)
7691
            return "elf64-ia64-aix-big";
7692
#elif defined(TE_HPUX)
7693
            return "elf64-ia64-hpux-big";
7694
#else
7695
            return "elf64-ia64-big";
7696
#endif
7697
          else
7698
#if defined(TE_AIX50)
7699
            return "elf32-ia64-aix-big";
7700
#elif defined(TE_HPUX)
7701
            return "elf32-ia64-hpux-big";
7702
#else
7703
            return "elf32-ia64-big";
7704
#endif
7705
        }
7706
      else
7707
        {
7708
          if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7709
#ifdef TE_AIX50
7710
            return "elf64-ia64-aix-little";
7711
#else
7712
            return "elf64-ia64-little";
7713
#endif
7714
          else
7715
#ifdef TE_AIX50
7716
            return "elf32-ia64-aix-little";
7717
#else
7718
            return "elf32-ia64-little";
7719
#endif
7720
        }
7721
    }
7722
  else
7723
    return "unknown-format";
7724
}
7725
 
7726
void
7727
ia64_end_of_source ()
7728
{
7729
  /* terminate insn group upon reaching end of file:  */
7730
  insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7731
 
7732
  /* emits slots we haven't written yet:  */
7733
  ia64_flush_insns ();
7734
 
7735
  bfd_set_private_flags (stdoutput, md.flags);
7736
 
7737
  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
7738
}
7739
 
7740
void
7741
ia64_start_line ()
7742
{
7743
  static int first;
7744
 
7745
  if (!first) {
7746
    /* Make sure we don't reference input_line_pointer[-1] when that's
7747
       not valid.  */
7748
    first = 1;
7749
    return;
7750
  }
7751
 
7752
  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
7753
    as_bad (_("qualifying predicate not followed by instruction"));
7754
  md.qp.X_op = O_absent;
7755
 
7756
  if (ignore_input ())
7757
    return;
7758
 
7759
  if (input_line_pointer[0] == ';' && input_line_pointer[-1] == ';')
7760
    {
7761
      if (md.detect_dv && !md.explicit_mode)
7762
        {
7763
          static int warned;
7764
 
7765
          if (!warned)
7766
            {
7767
              warned = 1;
7768
              as_warn (_("Explicit stops are ignored in auto mode"));
7769
            }
7770
        }
7771
      else
7772
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7773
    }
7774
  else if (input_line_pointer[-1] == '{')
7775
    {
7776
      if (md.manual_bundling)
7777
        as_warn (_("Found '{' when manual bundling is already turned on"));
7778
      else
7779
        CURR_SLOT.manual_bundling_on = 1;
7780
      md.manual_bundling = 1;
7781
 
7782
      /* Bundling is only acceptable in explicit mode
7783
         or when in default automatic mode.  */
7784
      if (md.detect_dv && !md.explicit_mode)
7785
        {
7786
          if (!md.mode_explicitly_set
7787
              && !md.default_explicit_mode)
7788
            dot_dv_mode ('E');
7789
          else
7790
            as_warn (_("Found '{' after explicit switch to automatic mode"));
7791
        }
7792
    }
7793
  else if (input_line_pointer[-1] == '}')
7794
    {
7795
      if (!md.manual_bundling)
7796
        as_warn (_("Found '}' when manual bundling is off"));
7797
      else
7798
        PREV_SLOT.manual_bundling_off = 1;
7799
      md.manual_bundling = 0;
7800
 
7801
      /* switch back to automatic mode, if applicable */
7802
      if (md.detect_dv
7803
          && md.explicit_mode
7804
          && !md.mode_explicitly_set
7805
          && !md.default_explicit_mode)
7806
        dot_dv_mode ('A');
7807
    }
7808
}
7809
 
7810
/* This is a hook for ia64_frob_label, so that it can distinguish tags from
7811
   labels.  */
7812
static int defining_tag = 0;
7813
 
7814
int
7815
ia64_unrecognized_line (ch)
7816
     int ch;
7817
{
7818
  switch (ch)
7819
    {
7820
    case '(':
7821
      expression_and_evaluate (&md.qp);
7822
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ')')
7823
        {
7824
          as_bad (_("Expected ')'"));
7825
          return 0;
7826
        }
7827
      if (md.qp.X_op != O_register)
7828
        {
7829
          as_bad (_("Qualifying predicate expected"));
7830
          return 0;
7831
        }
7832
      if (md.qp.X_add_number < REG_P || md.qp.X_add_number >= REG_P + 64)
7833
        {
7834
          as_bad (_("Predicate register expected"));
7835
          return 0;
7836
        }
7837
      return 1;
7838
 
7839
    case '[':
7840
      {
7841
        char *s;
7842
        char c;
7843
        symbolS *tag;
7844
        int temp;
7845
 
7846
        if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
7847
          {
7848
            as_bad (_("Tag must come before qualifying predicate."));
7849
            return 0;
7850
          }
7851
 
7852
        /* This implements just enough of read_a_source_file in read.c to
7853
           recognize labels.  */
7854
        if (is_name_beginner (*input_line_pointer))
7855
          {
7856
            s = input_line_pointer;
7857
            c = get_symbol_end ();
7858
          }
7859
        else if (LOCAL_LABELS_FB
7860
                 && ISDIGIT (*input_line_pointer))
7861
          {
7862
            temp = 0;
7863
            while (ISDIGIT (*input_line_pointer))
7864
              temp = (temp * 10) + *input_line_pointer++ - '0';
7865
            fb_label_instance_inc (temp);
7866
            s = fb_label_name (temp, 0);
7867
            c = *input_line_pointer;
7868
          }
7869
        else
7870
          {
7871
            s = NULL;
7872
            c = '\0';
7873
          }
7874
        if (c != ':')
7875
          {
7876
            /* Put ':' back for error messages' sake.  */
7877
            *input_line_pointer++ = ':';
7878
            as_bad (_("Expected ':'"));
7879
            return 0;
7880
          }
7881
 
7882
        defining_tag = 1;
7883
        tag = colon (s);
7884
        defining_tag = 0;
7885
        /* Put ':' back for error messages' sake.  */
7886
        *input_line_pointer++ = ':';
7887
        if (*input_line_pointer++ != ']')
7888
          {
7889
            as_bad (_("Expected ']'"));
7890
            return 0;
7891
          }
7892
        if (! tag)
7893
          {
7894
            as_bad (_("Tag name expected"));
7895
            return 0;
7896
          }
7897
        return 1;
7898
      }
7899
 
7900
    default:
7901
      break;
7902
    }
7903
 
7904
  /* Not a valid line.  */
7905
  return 0;
7906
}
7907
 
7908
void
7909
ia64_frob_label (sym)
7910
     struct symbol *sym;
7911
{
7912
  struct label_fix *fix;
7913
 
7914
  /* Tags need special handling since they are not bundle breaks like
7915
     labels.  */
7916
  if (defining_tag)
7917
    {
7918
      fix = obstack_alloc (&notes, sizeof (*fix));
7919
      fix->sym = sym;
7920
      fix->next = CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups;
7921
      fix->dw2_mark_labels = FALSE;
7922
      CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups = fix;
7923
 
7924
      return;
7925
    }
7926
 
7927
  if (bfd_get_section_flags (stdoutput, now_seg) & SEC_CODE)
7928
    {
7929
      md.last_text_seg = now_seg;
7930
      fix = obstack_alloc (&notes, sizeof (*fix));
7931
      fix->sym = sym;
7932
      fix->next = CURR_SLOT.label_fixups;
7933
      fix->dw2_mark_labels = dwarf2_loc_mark_labels;
7934
      CURR_SLOT.label_fixups = fix;
7935
 
7936
      /* Keep track of how many code entry points we've seen.  */
7937
      if (md.path == md.maxpaths)
7938
        {
7939
          md.maxpaths += 20;
7940
          md.entry_labels = (const char **)
7941
            xrealloc ((void *) md.entry_labels,
7942
                      md.maxpaths * sizeof (char *));
7943
        }
7944
      md.entry_labels[md.path++] = S_GET_NAME (sym);
7945
    }
7946
}
7947
 
7948
#ifdef TE_HPUX
7949
/* The HP-UX linker will give unresolved symbol errors for symbols
7950
   that are declared but unused.  This routine removes declared,
7951
   unused symbols from an object.  */
7952
int
7953
ia64_frob_symbol (sym)
7954
     struct symbol *sym;
7955
{
7956
  if ((S_GET_SEGMENT (sym) == &bfd_und_section && ! symbol_used_p (sym) &&
7957
       ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (S_GET_OTHER (sym)) == STV_DEFAULT)
7958
      || (S_GET_SEGMENT (sym) == &bfd_abs_section
7959
          && ! S_IS_EXTERNAL (sym)))
7960
    return 1;
7961
  return 0;
7962
}
7963
#endif
7964
 
7965
void
7966
ia64_flush_pending_output ()
7967
{
7968
  if (!md.keep_pending_output
7969
      && bfd_get_section_flags (stdoutput, now_seg) & SEC_CODE)
7970
    {
7971
      /* ??? This causes many unnecessary stop bits to be emitted.
7972
         Unfortunately, it isn't clear if it is safe to remove this.  */
7973
      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7974
      ia64_flush_insns ();
7975
    }
7976
}
7977
 
7978
/* Do ia64-specific expression optimization.  All that's done here is
7979
   to transform index expressions that are either due to the indexing
7980
   of rotating registers or due to the indexing of indirect register
7981
   sets.  */
7982
int
7983
ia64_optimize_expr (l, op, r)
7984
     expressionS *l;
7985
     operatorT op;
7986
     expressionS *r;
7987
{
7988
  if (op != O_index)
7989
    return 0;
7990
  resolve_expression (l);
7991
  if (l->X_op == O_register)
7992
    {
7993
      unsigned num_regs = l->X_add_number >> 16;
7994
 
7995
      resolve_expression (r);
7996
      if (num_regs)
7997
        {
7998
          /* Left side is a .rotX-allocated register.  */
7999
          if (r->X_op != O_constant)
8000
            {
8001
              as_bad (_("Rotating register index must be a non-negative constant"));
8002
              r->X_add_number = 0;
8003
            }
8004
          else if ((valueT) r->X_add_number >= num_regs)
8005
            {
8006
              as_bad (_("Index out of range 0..%u"), num_regs - 1);
8007
              r->X_add_number = 0;
8008
            }
8009
          l->X_add_number = (l->X_add_number & 0xffff) + r->X_add_number;
8010
          return 1;
8011
        }
8012
      else if (l->X_add_number >= IND_CPUID && l->X_add_number <= IND_RR)
8013
        {
8014
          if (r->X_op != O_register
8015
              || r->X_add_number < REG_GR
8016
              || r->X_add_number > REG_GR + 127)
8017
            {
8018
              as_bad (_("Indirect register index must be a general register"));
8019
              r->X_add_number = REG_GR;
8020
            }
8021
          l->X_op = O_index;
8022
          l->X_op_symbol = md.indregsym[l->X_add_number - IND_CPUID];
8023
          l->X_add_number = r->X_add_number;
8024
          return 1;
8025
        }
8026
    }
8027
  as_bad (_("Index can only be applied to rotating or indirect registers"));
8028
  /* Fall back to some register use of which has as little as possible
8029
     side effects, to minimize subsequent error messages.  */
8030
  l->X_op = O_register;
8031
  l->X_add_number = REG_GR + 3;
8032
  return 1;
8033
}
8034
 
8035
int
8036
ia64_parse_name (name, e, nextcharP)
8037
     char *name;
8038
     expressionS *e;
8039
     char *nextcharP;
8040
{
8041
  struct const_desc *cdesc;
8042
  struct dynreg *dr = 0;
8043
  unsigned int idx;
8044
  struct symbol *sym;
8045
  char *end;
8046
 
8047
  if (*name == '@')
8048
    {
8049
      enum pseudo_type pseudo_type = PSEUDO_FUNC_NONE;
8050
 
8051
      /* Find what relocation pseudo-function we're dealing with.  */
8052
      for (idx = 0; idx < NELEMS (pseudo_func); ++idx)
8053
        if (pseudo_func[idx].name
8054
            && pseudo_func[idx].name[0] == name[1]
8055
            && strcmp (pseudo_func[idx].name + 1, name + 2) == 0)
8056
          {
8057
            pseudo_type = pseudo_func[idx].type;
8058
            break;
8059
          }
8060
      switch (pseudo_type)
8061
        {
8062
        case PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC:
8063
          end = input_line_pointer;
8064
          if (*nextcharP != '(')
8065
            {
8066
              as_bad (_("Expected '('"));
8067
              break;
8068
            }
8069
          /* Skip '('.  */
8070
          ++input_line_pointer;
8071
          expression (e);
8072
          if (*input_line_pointer != ')')
8073
            {
8074
              as_bad (_("Missing ')'"));
8075
              goto done;
8076
            }
8077
          /* Skip ')'.  */
8078
          ++input_line_pointer;
8079
          if (e->X_op != O_symbol)
8080
            {
8081
              if (e->X_op != O_pseudo_fixup)
8082
                {
8083
                  as_bad (_("Not a symbolic expression"));
8084
                  goto done;
8085
                }
8086
              if (idx != FUNC_LT_RELATIVE)
8087
                {
8088
                  as_bad (_("Illegal combination of relocation functions"));
8089
                  goto done;
8090
                }
8091
              switch (S_GET_VALUE (e->X_op_symbol))
8092
                {
8093
                case FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE:
8094
                  idx = FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE; break;
8095
                case FUNC_DTP_MODULE:
8096
                  idx = FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE; break;
8097
                case FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE:
8098
                  idx = FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE; break;
8099
                case FUNC_TP_RELATIVE:
8100
                  idx = FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE; break;
8101
                default:
8102
                  as_bad (_("Illegal combination of relocation functions"));
8103
                  goto done;
8104
                }
8105
            }
8106
          /* Make sure gas doesn't get rid of local symbols that are used
8107
             in relocs.  */
8108
          e->X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
8109
          e->X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[idx].u.sym;
8110
        done:
8111
          *nextcharP = *input_line_pointer;
8112
          break;
8113
 
8114
        case PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST:
8115
          e->X_op = O_constant;
8116
          e->X_add_number = pseudo_func[idx].u.ival;
8117
          break;
8118
 
8119
        case PSEUDO_FUNC_REG:
8120
          e->X_op = O_register;
8121
          e->X_add_number = pseudo_func[idx].u.ival;
8122
          break;
8123
 
8124
        default:
8125
          return 0;
8126
        }
8127
      return 1;
8128
    }
8129
 
8130
  /* first see if NAME is a known register name:  */
8131
  sym = hash_find (md.reg_hash, name);
8132
  if (sym)
8133
    {
8134
      e->X_op = O_register;
8135
      e->X_add_number = S_GET_VALUE (sym);
8136
      return 1;
8137
    }
8138
 
8139
  cdesc = hash_find (md.const_hash, name);
8140
  if (cdesc)
8141
    {
8142
      e->X_op = O_constant;
8143
      e->X_add_number = cdesc->value;
8144
      return 1;
8145
    }
8146
 
8147
  /* check for inN, locN, or outN:  */
8148
  idx = 0;
8149
  switch (name[0])
8150
    {
8151
    case 'i':
8152
      if (name[1] == 'n' && ISDIGIT (name[2]))
8153
        {
8154
          dr = &md.in;
8155
          idx = 2;
8156
        }
8157
      break;
8158
 
8159
    case 'l':
8160
      if (name[1] == 'o' && name[2] == 'c' && ISDIGIT (name[3]))
8161
        {
8162
          dr = &md.loc;
8163
          idx = 3;
8164
        }
8165
      break;
8166
 
8167
    case 'o':
8168
      if (name[1] == 'u' && name[2] == 't' && ISDIGIT (name[3]))
8169
        {
8170
          dr = &md.out;
8171
          idx = 3;
8172
        }
8173
      break;
8174
 
8175
    default:
8176
      break;
8177
    }
8178
 
8179
  /* Ignore register numbers with leading zeroes, except zero itself.  */
8180
  if (dr && (name[idx] != '0' || name[idx + 1] == '\0'))
8181
    {
8182
      unsigned long regnum;
8183
 
8184
      /* The name is inN, locN, or outN; parse the register number.  */
8185
      regnum = strtoul (name + idx, &end, 10);
8186
      if (end > name + idx && *end == '\0' && regnum < 96)
8187
        {
8188
          if (regnum >= dr->num_regs)
8189
            {
8190
              if (!dr->num_regs)
8191
                as_bad (_("No current frame"));
8192
              else
8193
                as_bad (_("Register number out of range 0..%u"),
8194
                        dr->num_regs - 1);
8195
              regnum = 0;
8196
            }
8197
          e->X_op = O_register;
8198
          e->X_add_number = dr->base + regnum;
8199
          return 1;
8200
        }
8201
    }
8202
 
8203
  end = alloca (strlen (name) + 1);
8204
  strcpy (end, name);
8205
  name = ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (end);
8206
  if ((dr = hash_find (md.dynreg_hash, name)))
8207
    {
8208
      /* We've got ourselves the name of a rotating register set.
8209
         Store the base register number in the low 16 bits of
8210
         X_add_number and the size of the register set in the top 16
8211
         bits.  */
8212
      e->X_op = O_register;
8213
      e->X_add_number = dr->base | (dr->num_regs << 16);
8214
      return 1;
8215
    }
8216
  return 0;
8217
}
8218
 
8219
/* Remove the '#' suffix that indicates a symbol as opposed to a register.  */
8220
 
8221
char *
8222
ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (name)
8223
     char *name;
8224
{
8225
  size_t len = strlen (name), full = len;
8226
 
8227
  while (len > 0 && name[len - 1] == '#')
8228
    --len;
8229
  if (len <= 0)
8230
    {
8231
      if (full > 0)
8232
        as_bad (_("Standalone `#' is illegal"));
8233
    }
8234
  else if (len < full - 1)
8235
    as_warn (_("Redundant `#' suffix operators"));
8236
  name[len] = '\0';
8237
  return name;
8238
}
8239
 
8240
/* Return true if idesc is a conditional branch instruction.  This excludes
8241
   the modulo scheduled branches, and br.ia.  Mod-sched branches are excluded
8242
   because they always read/write resources regardless of the value of the
8243
   qualifying predicate.  br.ia must always use p0, and hence is always
8244
   taken.  Thus this function returns true for branches which can fall
8245
   through, and which use no resources if they do fall through.  */
8246
 
8247
static int
8248
is_conditional_branch (idesc)
8249
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
8250
{
8251
  /* br is a conditional branch.  Everything that starts with br. except
8252
     br.ia, br.c{loop,top,exit}, and br.w{top,exit} is a conditional branch.
8253
     Everything that starts with brl is a conditional branch.  */
8254
  return (idesc->name[0] == 'b' && idesc->name[1] == 'r'
8255
          && (idesc->name[2] == '\0'
8256
              || (idesc->name[2] == '.' && idesc->name[3] != 'i'
8257
                  && idesc->name[3] != 'c' && idesc->name[3] != 'w')
8258
              || idesc->name[2] == 'l'
8259
              /* br.cond, br.call, br.clr  */
8260
              || (idesc->name[2] == '.' && idesc->name[3] == 'c'
8261
                  && (idesc->name[4] == 'a' || idesc->name[4] == 'o'
8262
                      || (idesc->name[4] == 'l' && idesc->name[5] == 'r')))));
8263
}
8264
 
8265
/* Return whether the given opcode is a taken branch.  If there's any doubt,
8266
   returns zero.  */
8267
 
8268
static int
8269
is_taken_branch (idesc)
8270
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
8271
{
8272
  return ((is_conditional_branch (idesc) && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0)
8273
          || strncmp (idesc->name, "br.ia", 5) == 0);
8274
}
8275
 
8276
/* Return whether the given opcode is an interruption or rfi.  If there's any
8277
   doubt, returns zero.  */
8278
 
8279
static int
8280
is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc)
8281
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
8282
{
8283
  if (strcmp (idesc->name, "rfi") == 0)
8284
    return 1;
8285
  return 0;
8286
}
8287
 
8288
/* Returns the index of the given dependency in the opcode's list of chks, or
8289
   -1 if there is no dependency.  */
8290
 
8291
static int
8292
depends_on (depind, idesc)
8293
     int depind;
8294
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
8295
{
8296
  int i;
8297
  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *dep = idesc->dependencies;
8298
  for (i = 0; i < dep->nchks; i++)
8299
    {
8300
      if (depind == DEP (dep->chks[i]))
8301
        return i;
8302
    }
8303
  return -1;
8304
}
8305
 
8306
/* Determine a set of specific resources used for a particular resource
8307
   class.  Returns the number of specific resources identified  For those
8308
   cases which are not determinable statically, the resource returned is
8309
   marked nonspecific.
8310
 
8311
   Meanings of value in 'NOTE':
8312
   1) only read/write when the register number is explicitly encoded in the
8313
   insn.
8314
   2) only read CFM when accessing a rotating GR, FR, or PR.  mov pr only
8315
   accesses CFM when qualifying predicate is in the rotating region.
8316
   3) general register value is used to specify an indirect register; not
8317
   determinable statically.
8318
   4) only read the given resource when bits 7:0 of the indirect index
8319
   register value does not match the register number of the resource; not
8320
   determinable statically.
8321
   5) all rules are implementation specific.
8322
   6) only when both the index specified by the reader and the index specified
8323
   by the writer have the same value in bits 63:61; not determinable
8324
   statically.
8325
   7) only access the specified resource when the corresponding mask bit is
8326
   set
8327
   8) PSR.dfh is only read when these insns reference FR32-127.  PSR.dfl is
8328
   only read when these insns reference FR2-31
8329
   9) PSR.mfl is only written when these insns write FR2-31.  PSR.mfh is only
8330
   written when these insns write FR32-127
8331
   10) The PSR.bn bit is only accessed when one of GR16-31 is specified in the
8332
   instruction
8333
   11) The target predicates are written independently of PR[qp], but source
8334
   registers are only read if PR[qp] is true.  Since the state of PR[qp]
8335
   cannot statically be determined, all source registers are marked used.
8336
   12) This insn only reads the specified predicate register when that
8337
   register is the PR[qp].
8338
   13) This reference to ld-c only applies to the GR whose value is loaded
8339
   with data returned from memory, not the post-incremented address register.
8340
   14) The RSE resource includes the implementation-specific RSE internal
8341
   state resources.  At least one (and possibly more) of these resources are
8342
   read by each instruction listed in IC:rse-readers.  At least one (and
8343
   possibly more) of these resources are written by each insn listed in
8344
   IC:rse-writers.
8345
   15+16) Represents reserved instructions, which the assembler does not
8346
   generate.
8347
   17) CR[TPR] has a RAW dependency only between mov-to-CR-TPR and
8348
   mov-to-PSR-l or ssm instructions that set PSR.i, PSR.pp or PSR.up.
8349
 
8350
   Memory resources (i.e. locations in memory) are *not* marked or tracked by
8351
   this code; there are no dependency violations based on memory access.
8352
*/
8353
 
8354
#define MAX_SPECS 256
8355
#define DV_CHK 1
8356
#define DV_REG 0
8357
 
8358
static int
8359
specify_resource (dep, idesc, type, specs, note, path)
8360
     const struct ia64_dependency *dep;
8361
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
8362
     int type;                         /* is this a DV chk or a DV reg? */
8363
     struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS];     /* returned specific resources */
8364
     int note;                         /* resource note for this insn's usage */
8365
     int path;                         /* which execution path to examine */
8366
{
8367
  int count = 0;
8368
  int i;
8369
  int rsrc_write = 0;
8370
  struct rsrc tmpl;
8371
 
8372
  if (dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAW
8373
      || (dep->mode == IA64_DV_RAW && type == DV_REG)
8374
      || (dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAR && type == DV_CHK))
8375
    rsrc_write = 1;
8376
 
8377
  /* template for any resources we identify */
8378
  tmpl.dependency = dep;
8379
  tmpl.note = note;
8380
  tmpl.insn_srlz = tmpl.data_srlz = 0;
8381
  tmpl.qp_regno = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8382
  tmpl.link_to_qp_branch = 1;
8383
  tmpl.mem_offset.hint = 0;
8384
  tmpl.mem_offset.offset = 0;
8385
  tmpl.mem_offset.base = 0;
8386
  tmpl.specific = 1;
8387
  tmpl.index = -1;
8388
  tmpl.cmp_type = CMP_NONE;
8389
  tmpl.depind = 0;
8390
  tmpl.file = NULL;
8391
  tmpl.line = 0;
8392
  tmpl.path = 0;
8393
 
8394
#define UNHANDLED \
8395
as_warn (_("Unhandled dependency %s for %s (%s), note %d"), \
8396
dep->name, idesc->name, (rsrc_write?"write":"read"), note)
8397
#define KNOWN(REG) (gr_values[REG].known && gr_values[REG].path >= path)
8398
 
8399
  /* we don't need to track these */
8400
  if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_NONE)
8401
    return 0;
8402
 
8403
  switch (dep->specifier)
8404
    {
8405
    case IA64_RS_AR_K:
8406
      if (note == 1)
8407
        {
8408
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8409
            {
8410
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8411
              if (regno >= 0 && regno <= 7)
8412
                {
8413
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8414
                  specs[count++].index = regno;
8415
                }
8416
            }
8417
        }
8418
      else if (note == 0)
8419
        {
8420
          for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
8421
            {
8422
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8423
              specs[count++].index = i;
8424
            }
8425
        }
8426
      else
8427
        {
8428
          UNHANDLED;
8429
        }
8430
      break;
8431
 
8432
    case IA64_RS_AR_UNAT:
8433
      /* This is a mov =AR or mov AR= instruction.  */
8434
      if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8435
        {
8436
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8437
          if (regno == AR_UNAT)
8438
            {
8439
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
8440
            }
8441
        }
8442
      else
8443
        {
8444
          /* This is a spill/fill, or other instruction that modifies the
8445
             unat register.  */
8446
 
8447
          /* Unless we can determine the specific bits used, mark the whole
8448
             thing; bits 8:3 of the memory address indicate the bit used in
8449
             UNAT.  The .mem.offset hint may be used to eliminate a small
8450
             subset of conflicts.  */
8451
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8452
          if (md.mem_offset.hint)
8453
            {
8454
              if (md.debug_dv)
8455
                fprintf (stderr, "  Using hint for spill/fill\n");
8456
              /* The index isn't actually used, just set it to something
8457
                 approximating the bit index.  */
8458
              specs[count].index = (md.mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F;
8459
              specs[count].mem_offset.hint = 1;
8460
              specs[count].mem_offset.offset = md.mem_offset.offset;
8461
              specs[count++].mem_offset.base = md.mem_offset.base;
8462
            }
8463
          else
8464
            {
8465
              specs[count++].specific = 0;
8466
            }
8467
        }
8468
      break;
8469
 
8470
    case IA64_RS_AR:
8471
      if (note == 1)
8472
        {
8473
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8474
            {
8475
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8476
              if ((regno >= 8 && regno <= 15)
8477
                  || (regno >= 20 && regno <= 23)
8478
                  || (regno >= 31 && regno <= 39)
8479
                  || (regno >= 41 && regno <= 47)
8480
                  || (regno >= 67 && regno <= 111))
8481
                {
8482
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8483
                  specs[count++].index = regno;
8484
                }
8485
            }
8486
        }
8487
      else
8488
        {
8489
          UNHANDLED;
8490
        }
8491
      break;
8492
 
8493
    case IA64_RS_ARb:
8494
      if (note == 1)
8495
        {
8496
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8497
            {
8498
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8499
              if ((regno >= 48 && regno <= 63)
8500
                  || (regno >= 112 && regno <= 127))
8501
                {
8502
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8503
                  specs[count++].index = regno;
8504
                }
8505
            }
8506
        }
8507
      else if (note == 0)
8508
        {
8509
          for (i = 48; i < 64; i++)
8510
            {
8511
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8512
              specs[count++].index = i;
8513
            }
8514
          for (i = 112; i < 128; i++)
8515
            {
8516
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8517
              specs[count++].index = i;
8518
            }
8519
        }
8520
      else
8521
        {
8522
          UNHANDLED;
8523
        }
8524
      break;
8525
 
8526
    case IA64_RS_BR:
8527
      if (note != 1)
8528
        {
8529
          UNHANDLED;
8530
        }
8531
      else
8532
        {
8533
          if (rsrc_write)
8534
            {
8535
              for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8536
                if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B1
8537
                    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B2)
8538
                  {
8539
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8540
                    specs[count++].index =
8541
                      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_BR;
8542
                  }
8543
            }
8544
          else
8545
            {
8546
              for (i = idesc->num_outputs; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8547
                if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B1
8548
                    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B2)
8549
                  {
8550
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8551
                    specs[count++].index =
8552
                      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_BR;
8553
                  }
8554
            }
8555
        }
8556
      break;
8557
 
8558
    case IA64_RS_CPUID: /* four or more registers */
8559
      if (note == 3)
8560
        {
8561
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3)
8562
            {
8563
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8564
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8565
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8566
                {
8567
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8568
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8569
                }
8570
              else
8571
                {
8572
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8573
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8574
                }
8575
            }
8576
        }
8577
      else
8578
        {
8579
          UNHANDLED;
8580
        }
8581
      break;
8582
 
8583
    case IA64_RS_DBR: /* four or more registers */
8584
      if (note == 3)
8585
        {
8586
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_DBR_R3)
8587
            {
8588
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8589
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8590
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8591
                {
8592
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8593
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8594
                }
8595
              else
8596
                {
8597
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8598
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8599
                }
8600
            }
8601
        }
8602
      else if (note == 0 && !rsrc_write)
8603
        {
8604
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8605
          specs[count++].specific = 0;
8606
        }
8607
      else
8608
        {
8609
          UNHANDLED;
8610
        }
8611
      break;
8612
 
8613
    case IA64_RS_IBR: /* four or more registers */
8614
      if (note == 3)
8615
        {
8616
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_IBR_R3)
8617
            {
8618
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8619
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8620
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8621
                {
8622
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8623
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8624
                }
8625
              else
8626
                {
8627
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8628
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8629
                }
8630
            }
8631
        }
8632
      else
8633
        {
8634
          UNHANDLED;
8635
        }
8636
      break;
8637
 
8638
    case IA64_RS_MSR:
8639
      if (note == 5)
8640
        {
8641
          /* These are implementation specific.  Force all references to
8642
             conflict with all other references.  */
8643
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8644
          specs[count++].specific = 0;
8645
        }
8646
      else
8647
        {
8648
          UNHANDLED;
8649
        }
8650
      break;
8651
 
8652
    case IA64_RS_PKR: /* 16 or more registers */
8653
      if (note == 3 || note == 4)
8654
        {
8655
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PKR_R3)
8656
            {
8657
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8658
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8659
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8660
                {
8661
                  if (note == 3)
8662
                    {
8663
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
8664
                      specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8665
                    }
8666
                  else
8667
                    for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (gr_values); i++)
8668
                      {
8669
                        /* Uses all registers *except* the one in R3.  */
8670
                        if ((unsigned)i != (gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF))
8671
                          {
8672
                            specs[count] = tmpl;
8673
                            specs[count++].index = i;
8674
                          }
8675
                      }
8676
                }
8677
              else
8678
                {
8679
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8680
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8681
                }
8682
            }
8683
        }
8684
      else if (note == 0)
8685
        {
8686
          /* probe et al.  */
8687
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8688
          specs[count++].specific = 0;
8689
        }
8690
      break;
8691
 
8692
    case IA64_RS_PMC: /* four or more registers */
8693
      if (note == 3)
8694
        {
8695
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PMC_R3
8696
              || (!rsrc_write && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3))
8697
 
8698
            {
8699
              int index = ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_R3 && !rsrc_write)
8700
                           ? 1 : !rsrc_write);
8701
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[index].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8702
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8703
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8704
                {
8705
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8706
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8707
                }
8708
              else
8709
                {
8710
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8711
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8712
                }
8713
            }
8714
        }
8715
      else
8716
        {
8717
          UNHANDLED;
8718
        }
8719
      break;
8720
 
8721
    case IA64_RS_PMD: /* four or more registers */
8722
      if (note == 3)
8723
        {
8724
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3)
8725
            {
8726
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8727
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8728
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8729
                {
8730
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8731
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8732
                }
8733
              else
8734
                {
8735
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8736
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8737
                }
8738
            }
8739
        }
8740
      else
8741
        {
8742
          UNHANDLED;
8743
        }
8744
      break;
8745
 
8746
    case IA64_RS_RR: /* eight registers */
8747
      if (note == 6)
8748
        {
8749
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_RR_R3)
8750
            {
8751
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8752
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8753
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8754
                {
8755
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8756
                  specs[count++].index = (gr_values[regno].value >> 61) & 0x7;
8757
                }
8758
              else
8759
                {
8760
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8761
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8762
                }
8763
            }
8764
        }
8765
      else if (note == 0 && !rsrc_write)
8766
        {
8767
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8768
          specs[count++].specific = 0;
8769
        }
8770
      else
8771
        {
8772
          UNHANDLED;
8773
        }
8774
      break;
8775
 
8776
    case IA64_RS_CR_IRR:
8777
      if (note == 0)
8778
        {
8779
          /* handle mov-from-CR-IVR; it's a read that writes CR[IRR] */
8780
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8781
          if (rsrc_write
8782
              && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8783
              && regno == CR_IVR)
8784
            {
8785
              for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
8786
                {
8787
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8788
                  specs[count++].index = CR_IRR0 + i;
8789
                }
8790
            }
8791
        }
8792
      else if (note == 1)
8793
        {
8794
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8795
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8796
              && regno >= CR_IRR0
8797
              && regno <= CR_IRR3)
8798
            {
8799
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8800
              specs[count++].index = regno;
8801
            }
8802
        }
8803
      else
8804
        {
8805
          UNHANDLED;
8806
        }
8807
      break;
8808
 
8809
    case IA64_RS_CR_LRR:
8810
      if (note != 1)
8811
        {
8812
          UNHANDLED;
8813
        }
8814
      else
8815
        {
8816
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8817
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8818
              && (regno == CR_LRR0 || regno == CR_LRR1))
8819
            {
8820
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8821
              specs[count++].index = regno;
8822
            }
8823
        }
8824
      break;
8825
 
8826
    case IA64_RS_CR:
8827
      if (note == 1)
8828
        {
8829
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
8830
            {
8831
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8832
              specs[count++].index =
8833
                CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8834
            }
8835
        }
8836
      else
8837
        {
8838
          UNHANDLED;
8839
        }
8840
      break;
8841
 
8842
    case IA64_RS_FR:
8843
    case IA64_RS_FRb:
8844
      if (note != 1)
8845
        {
8846
          UNHANDLED;
8847
        }
8848
      else if (rsrc_write)
8849
        {
8850
          if (dep->specifier == IA64_RS_FRb
8851
              && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_F1)
8852
            {
8853
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8854
              specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_FR;
8855
            }
8856
        }
8857
      else
8858
        {
8859
          for (i = idesc->num_outputs; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8860
            {
8861
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
8862
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
8863
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
8864
                {
8865
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8866
                  specs[count++].index =
8867
                    CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
8868
                }
8869
            }
8870
        }
8871
      break;
8872
 
8873
    case IA64_RS_GR:
8874
      if (note == 13)
8875
        {
8876
          /* This reference applies only to the GR whose value is loaded with
8877
             data returned from memory.  */
8878
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8879
          specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8880
        }
8881
      else if (note == 1)
8882
        {
8883
          if (rsrc_write)
8884
            {
8885
              for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8886
                if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
8887
                    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
8888
                    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
8889
                  {
8890
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8891
                    specs[count++].index =
8892
                      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8893
                  }
8894
              if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_POSTINC)
8895
                for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8896
                  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MR3)
8897
                    {
8898
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
8899
                      specs[count++].index =
8900
                        CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8901
                    }
8902
            }
8903
          else
8904
            {
8905
              /* Look for anything that reads a GR.  */
8906
              for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8907
                {
8908
                  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MR3
8909
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3
8910
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_DBR_R3
8911
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_IBR_R3
8912
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MSR_R3
8913
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PKR_R3
8914
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PMC_R3
8915
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3
8916
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_RR_R3
8917
                      || ((i >= idesc->num_outputs)
8918
                          && (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
8919
                              || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
8920
                              || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3
8921
                              /* addl source register.  */
8922
                              || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3_2)))
8923
                    {
8924
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
8925
                      specs[count++].index =
8926
                        CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8927
                    }
8928
                }
8929
            }
8930
        }
8931
      else
8932
        {
8933
          UNHANDLED;
8934
        }
8935
      break;
8936
 
8937
      /* This is the same as IA64_RS_PRr, except that the register range is
8938
         from 1 - 15, and there are no rotating register reads/writes here.  */
8939
    case IA64_RS_PR:
8940
      if (note == 0)
8941
        {
8942
          for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
8943
            {
8944
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8945
              specs[count++].index = i;
8946
            }
8947
        }
8948
      else if (note == 7)
8949
        {
8950
          valueT mask = 0;
8951
          /* Mark only those registers indicated by the mask.  */
8952
          if (rsrc_write)
8953
            {
8954
              mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
8955
              for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
8956
                if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << i))
8957
                  {
8958
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8959
                    specs[count++].index = i;
8960
                  }
8961
            }
8962
          else
8963
            {
8964
              UNHANDLED;
8965
            }
8966
        }
8967
      else if (note == 11) /* note 11 implies note 1 as well */
8968
        {
8969
          if (rsrc_write)
8970
            {
8971
              for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8972
                {
8973
                  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
8974
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8975
                    {
8976
                      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
8977
                      if (regno >= 1 && regno < 16)
8978
                        {
8979
                          specs[count] = tmpl;
8980
                          specs[count++].index = regno;
8981
                        }
8982
                    }
8983
                }
8984
            }
8985
          else
8986
            {
8987
              UNHANDLED;
8988
            }
8989
        }
8990
      else if (note == 12)
8991
        {
8992
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 16)
8993
            {
8994
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8995
              specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8996
            }
8997
        }
8998
      else if (note == 1)
8999
        {
9000
          if (rsrc_write)
9001
            {
9002
              int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
9003
              int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
9004
              int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
9005
              int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
9006
 
9007
              if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9008
                   || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9009
                  && p1 >= 1 && p1 < 16)
9010
                {
9011
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9012
                  specs[count].cmp_type =
9013
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
9014
                  specs[count++].index = p1;
9015
                }
9016
              if ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
9017
                   || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9018
                  && p2 >= 1 && p2 < 16)
9019
                {
9020
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9021
                  specs[count].cmp_type =
9022
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
9023
                  specs[count++].index = p2;
9024
                }
9025
            }
9026
          else
9027
            {
9028
              if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 16)
9029
                {
9030
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9031
                  specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
9032
                }
9033
              if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PR)
9034
                {
9035
                  for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
9036
                    {
9037
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
9038
                      specs[count++].index = i;
9039
                    }
9040
                }
9041
            }
9042
        }
9043
      else
9044
        {
9045
          UNHANDLED;
9046
        }
9047
      break;
9048
 
9049
      /* This is the general case for PRs.  IA64_RS_PR and IA64_RS_PR63 are
9050
         simplified cases of this.  */
9051
    case IA64_RS_PRr:
9052
      if (note == 0)
9053
        {
9054
          for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
9055
            {
9056
              specs[count] = tmpl;
9057
              specs[count++].index = i;
9058
            }
9059
        }
9060
      else if (note == 7)
9061
        {
9062
          valueT mask = 0;
9063
          /* Mark only those registers indicated by the mask.  */
9064
          if (rsrc_write
9065
              && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_PR)
9066
            {
9067
              mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
9068
              if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << 16))
9069
                for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
9070
                  {
9071
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
9072
                    specs[count++].index = i;
9073
                  }
9074
            }
9075
          else if (rsrc_write
9076
                   && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_PR_ROT)
9077
            {
9078
              for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
9079
                {
9080
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9081
                  specs[count++].index = i;
9082
                }
9083
            }
9084
          else
9085
            {
9086
              UNHANDLED;
9087
            }
9088
        }
9089
      else if (note == 11) /* note 11 implies note 1 as well */
9090
        {
9091
          if (rsrc_write)
9092
            {
9093
              for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
9094
                {
9095
                  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
9096
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9097
                    {
9098
                      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
9099
                      if (regno >= 16 && regno < 63)
9100
                        {
9101
                          specs[count] = tmpl;
9102
                          specs[count++].index = regno;
9103
                        }
9104
                    }
9105
                }
9106
            }
9107
          else
9108
            {
9109
              UNHANDLED;
9110
            }
9111
        }
9112
      else if (note == 12)
9113
        {
9114
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 16 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 63)
9115
            {
9116
              specs[count] = tmpl;
9117
              specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
9118
            }
9119
        }
9120
      else if (note == 1)
9121
        {
9122
          if (rsrc_write)
9123
            {
9124
              int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
9125
              int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
9126
              int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
9127
              int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
9128
 
9129
              if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9130
                   || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9131
                  && p1 >= 16 && p1 < 63)
9132
                {
9133
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9134
                  specs[count].cmp_type =
9135
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
9136
                  specs[count++].index = p1;
9137
                }
9138
              if ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
9139
                   || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9140
                  && p2 >= 16 && p2 < 63)
9141
                {
9142
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9143
                  specs[count].cmp_type =
9144
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
9145
                  specs[count++].index = p2;
9146
                }
9147
            }
9148
          else
9149
            {
9150
              if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 16 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 63)
9151
                {
9152
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9153
                  specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
9154
                }
9155
              if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PR)
9156
                {
9157
                  for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
9158
                    {
9159
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
9160
                      specs[count++].index = i;
9161
                    }
9162
                }
9163
            }
9164
        }
9165
      else
9166
        {
9167
          UNHANDLED;
9168
        }
9169
      break;
9170
 
9171
    case IA64_RS_PSR:
9172
      /* Verify that the instruction is using the PSR bit indicated in
9173
         dep->regindex.  */
9174
      if (note == 0)
9175
        {
9176
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR_UM)
9177
            {
9178
              if (dep->regindex < 6)
9179
                {
9180
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9181
                }
9182
            }
9183
          else if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR)
9184
            {
9185
              if (dep->regindex < 32
9186
                  || dep->regindex == 35
9187
                  || dep->regindex == 36
9188
                  || (!rsrc_write && dep->regindex == PSR_CPL))
9189
                {
9190
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9191
                }
9192
            }
9193
          else if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR_L)
9194
            {
9195
              if (dep->regindex < 32
9196
                  || dep->regindex == 35
9197
                  || dep->regindex == 36
9198
                  || (rsrc_write && dep->regindex == PSR_CPL))
9199
                {
9200
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9201
                }
9202
            }
9203
          else
9204
            {
9205
              /* Several PSR bits have very specific dependencies.  */
9206
              switch (dep->regindex)
9207
                {
9208
                default:
9209
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9210
                  break;
9211
                case PSR_IC:
9212
                  if (rsrc_write)
9213
                    {
9214
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9215
                    }
9216
                  else
9217
                    {
9218
                      /* Only certain CR accesses use PSR.ic */
9219
                      if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3
9220
                          || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
9221
                        {
9222
                          int index =
9223
                            ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
9224
                             ? 0 : 1);
9225
                          int regno =
9226
                            CURR_SLOT.opnd[index].X_add_number - REG_CR;
9227
 
9228
                          switch (regno)
9229
                            {
9230
                            default:
9231
                              break;
9232
                            case CR_ITIR:
9233
                            case CR_IFS:
9234
                            case CR_IIM:
9235
                            case CR_IIP:
9236
                            case CR_IPSR:
9237
                            case CR_ISR:
9238
                            case CR_IFA:
9239
                            case CR_IHA:
9240
                            case CR_IIPA:
9241
                              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9242
                              break;
9243
                            }
9244
                        }
9245
                    }
9246
                  break;
9247
                case PSR_CPL:
9248
                  if (rsrc_write)
9249
                    {
9250
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9251
                    }
9252
                  else
9253
                    {
9254
                      /* Only some AR accesses use cpl */
9255
                      if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3
9256
                          || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9257
                        {
9258
                          int index =
9259
                            ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9260
                             ? 0 : 1);
9261
                          int regno =
9262
                            CURR_SLOT.opnd[index].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9263
 
9264
                          if (regno == AR_ITC
9265
                              || regno == AR_RUC
9266
                              || (index == 0
9267
                                  && (regno == AR_RSC
9268
                                      || (regno >= AR_K0
9269
                                          && regno <= AR_K7))))
9270
                            {
9271
                              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9272
                            }
9273
                        }
9274
                      else
9275
                        {
9276
                          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9277
                        }
9278
                      break;
9279
                    }
9280
                }
9281
            }
9282
        }
9283
      else if (note == 7)
9284
        {
9285
          valueT mask = 0;
9286
          if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_IMMU24)
9287
            {
9288
              mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number;
9289
            }
9290
          else
9291
            {
9292
              UNHANDLED;
9293
            }
9294
          if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << dep->regindex))
9295
            {
9296
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9297
            }
9298
        }
9299
      else if (note == 8)
9300
        {
9301
          int min = dep->regindex == PSR_DFL ? 2 : 32;
9302
          int max = dep->regindex == PSR_DFL ? 31 : 127;
9303
          /* dfh is read on FR32-127; dfl is read on FR2-31 */
9304
          for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9305
            {
9306
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1
9307
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
9308
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
9309
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
9310
                {
9311
                  int reg = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9312
                  if (reg >= min && reg <= max)
9313
                    {
9314
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9315
                    }
9316
                }
9317
            }
9318
        }
9319
      else if (note == 9)
9320
        {
9321
          int min = dep->regindex == PSR_MFL ? 2 : 32;
9322
          int max = dep->regindex == PSR_MFL ? 31 : 127;
9323
          /* mfh is read on writes to FR32-127; mfl is read on writes to
9324
             FR2-31 */
9325
          for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
9326
            {
9327
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1)
9328
                {
9329
                  int reg = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9330
                  if (reg >= min && reg <= max)
9331
                    {
9332
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9333
                    }
9334
                }
9335
            }
9336
        }
9337
      else if (note == 10)
9338
        {
9339
          for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9340
            {
9341
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9342
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9343
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9344
                {
9345
                  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9346
                  if (regno >= 16 && regno <= 31)
9347
                    {
9348
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9349
                    }
9350
                }
9351
            }
9352
        }
9353
      else
9354
        {
9355
          UNHANDLED;
9356
        }
9357
      break;
9358
 
9359
    case IA64_RS_AR_FPSR:
9360
      if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9361
        {
9362
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9363
          if (regno == AR_FPSR)
9364
            {
9365
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9366
            }
9367
        }
9368
      else
9369
        {
9370
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9371
        }
9372
      break;
9373
 
9374
    case IA64_RS_ARX:
9375
      /* Handle all AR[REG] resources */
9376
      if (note == 0 || note == 1)
9377
        {
9378
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9379
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3
9380
              && regno == dep->regindex)
9381
            {
9382
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9383
            }
9384
          /* other AR[REG] resources may be affected by AR accesses */
9385
          else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9386
            {
9387
              /* AR[] writes */
9388
              regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9389
              switch (dep->regindex)
9390
                {
9391
                default:
9392
                  break;
9393
                case AR_BSP:
9394
                case AR_RNAT:
9395
                  if (regno == AR_BSPSTORE)
9396
                    {
9397
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9398
                    }
9399
                case AR_RSC:
9400
                  if (!rsrc_write &&
9401
                      (regno == AR_BSPSTORE
9402
                       || regno == AR_RNAT))
9403
                    {
9404
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9405
                    }
9406
                  break;
9407
                }
9408
            }
9409
          else if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9410
            {
9411
              /* AR[] reads */
9412
              regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9413
              switch (dep->regindex)
9414
                {
9415
                default:
9416
                  break;
9417
                case AR_RSC:
9418
                  if (regno == AR_BSPSTORE || regno == AR_RNAT)
9419
                    {
9420
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9421
                    }
9422
                  break;
9423
                }
9424
            }
9425
          else
9426
            {
9427
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9428
            }
9429
        }
9430
      else
9431
        {
9432
          UNHANDLED;
9433
        }
9434
      break;
9435
 
9436
    case IA64_RS_CRX:
9437
      /* Handle all CR[REG] resources.
9438
         ??? FIXME: The rule 17 isn't really handled correctly.   */
9439
      if (note == 0 || note == 1 || note == 17)
9440
        {
9441
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
9442
            {
9443
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
9444
              if (regno == dep->regindex)
9445
                {
9446
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9447
                }
9448
              else if (!rsrc_write)
9449
                {
9450
                  /* Reads from CR[IVR] affect other resources.  */
9451
                  if (regno == CR_IVR)
9452
                    {
9453
                      if ((dep->regindex >= CR_IRR0
9454
                           && dep->regindex <= CR_IRR3)
9455
                          || dep->regindex == CR_TPR)
9456
                        {
9457
                          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9458
                        }
9459
                    }
9460
                }
9461
            }
9462
          else
9463
            {
9464
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9465
            }
9466
        }
9467
      else
9468
        {
9469
          UNHANDLED;
9470
        }
9471
      break;
9472
 
9473
    case IA64_RS_INSERVICE:
9474
      /* look for write of EOI (67) or read of IVR (65) */
9475
      if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3
9476
           && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_CR == CR_EOI)
9477
          || (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3
9478
              && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_CR == CR_IVR))
9479
        {
9480
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9481
        }
9482
      break;
9483
 
9484
    case IA64_RS_GR0:
9485
      if (note == 1)
9486
        {
9487
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9488
        }
9489
      else
9490
        {
9491
          UNHANDLED;
9492
        }
9493
      break;
9494
 
9495
    case IA64_RS_CFM:
9496
      if (note != 2)
9497
        {
9498
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9499
        }
9500
      else
9501
        {
9502
          /* Check if any of the registers accessed are in the rotating region.
9503
             mov to/from pr accesses CFM only when qp_regno is in the rotating
9504
             region */
9505
          for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9506
            {
9507
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9508
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9509
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9510
                {
9511
                  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9512
                  /* Assumes that md.rot.num_regs is always valid */
9513
                  if (md.rot.num_regs > 0
9514
                      && num > 31
9515
                      && num < 31 + md.rot.num_regs)
9516
                    {
9517
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
9518
                      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9519
                    }
9520
                }
9521
              else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1
9522
                       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
9523
                       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
9524
                       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
9525
                {
9526
                  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9527
                  if (num > 31)
9528
                    {
9529
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
9530
                      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9531
                    }
9532
                }
9533
              else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
9534
                       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9535
                {
9536
                  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
9537
                  if (num > 15)
9538
                    {
9539
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
9540
                      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9541
                    }
9542
                }
9543
            }
9544
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno > 15)
9545
            {
9546
              specs[count] = tmpl;
9547
              specs[count++].specific = 0;
9548
            }
9549
        }
9550
      break;
9551
 
9552
      /* This is the same as IA64_RS_PRr, except simplified to account for
9553
         the fact that there is only one register.  */
9554
    case IA64_RS_PR63:
9555
      if (note == 0)
9556
        {
9557
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9558
        }
9559
      else if (note == 7)
9560
        {
9561
          valueT mask = 0;
9562
          if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_IMM17)
9563
            mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
9564
          if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << 63))
9565
            specs[count++] = tmpl;
9566
        }
9567
      else if (note == 11)
9568
        {
9569
          if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9570
               && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P == 63)
9571
              || (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2
9572
                  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P == 63))
9573
            {
9574
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9575
            }
9576
        }
9577
      else if (note == 12)
9578
        {
9579
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 63)
9580
            {
9581
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9582
            }
9583
        }
9584
      else if (note == 1)
9585
        {
9586
          if (rsrc_write)
9587
            {
9588
              int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
9589
              int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
9590
              int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
9591
              int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
9592
 
9593
              if (p1 == 63
9594
                  && (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9595
                      || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2))
9596
                {
9597
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9598
                  specs[count++].cmp_type =
9599
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
9600
                }
9601
              if (p2 == 63
9602
                  && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
9603
                      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2))
9604
                {
9605
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9606
                  specs[count++].cmp_type =
9607
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
9608
                }
9609
            }
9610
          else
9611
            {
9612
              if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 63)
9613
                {
9614
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9615
                }
9616
            }
9617
        }
9618
      else
9619
        {
9620
          UNHANDLED;
9621
        }
9622
      break;
9623
 
9624
    case IA64_RS_RSE:
9625
      /* FIXME we can identify some individual RSE written resources, but RSE
9626
         read resources have not yet been completely identified, so for now
9627
         treat RSE as a single resource */
9628
      if (strncmp (idesc->name, "mov", 3) == 0)
9629
        {
9630
          if (rsrc_write)
9631
            {
9632
              if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3
9633
                  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE)
9634
                {
9635
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9636
                }
9637
            }
9638
          else
9639
            {
9640
              if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9641
                {
9642
                  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE
9643
                      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_RNAT)
9644
                    {
9645
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9646
                    }
9647
                }
9648
              else if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9649
                {
9650
                  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSP
9651
                      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE
9652
                      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_RNAT)
9653
                    {
9654
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9655
                    }
9656
                }
9657
            }
9658
        }
9659
      else
9660
        {
9661
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9662
        }
9663
      break;
9664
 
9665
    case IA64_RS_ANY:
9666
      /* FIXME -- do any of these need to be non-specific? */
9667
      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9668
      break;
9669
 
9670
    default:
9671
      as_bad (_("Unrecognized dependency specifier %d\n"), dep->specifier);
9672
      break;
9673
    }
9674
 
9675
  return count;
9676
}
9677
 
9678
/* Clear branch flags on marked resources.  This breaks the link between the
9679
   QP of the marking instruction and a subsequent branch on the same QP.  */
9680
 
9681
static void
9682
clear_qp_branch_flag (mask)
9683
     valueT mask;
9684
{
9685
  int i;
9686
  for (i = 0; i < regdepslen; i++)
9687
    {
9688
      valueT bit = ((valueT) 1 << regdeps[i].qp_regno);
9689
      if ((bit & mask) != 0)
9690
        {
9691
          regdeps[i].link_to_qp_branch = 0;
9692
        }
9693
    }
9694
}
9695
 
9696
/* MASK contains 2 and only 2 PRs which are mutually exclusive.  Remove
9697
   any mutexes which contain one of the PRs and create new ones when
9698
   needed.  */
9699
 
9700
static int
9701
update_qp_mutex (valueT mask)
9702
{
9703
  int i;
9704
  int add = 0;
9705
 
9706
  i = 0;
9707
  while (i < qp_mutexeslen)
9708
    {
9709
      if ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) != 0)
9710
        {
9711
          /* If it destroys and creates the same mutex, do nothing.  */
9712
          if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask == mask
9713
              && qp_mutexes[i].path == md.path)
9714
            {
9715
              i++;
9716
              add = -1;
9717
            }
9718
          else
9719
            {
9720
              int keep = 0;
9721
 
9722
              if (md.debug_dv)
9723
                {
9724
                  fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing mutex relation");
9725
                  print_prmask (qp_mutexes[i].prmask);
9726
                  fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9727
                }
9728
 
9729
              /* Deal with the old mutex with more than 3+ PRs only if
9730
                 the new mutex on the same execution path with it.
9731
 
9732
                 FIXME: The 3+ mutex support is incomplete.
9733
                 dot_pred_rel () may be a better place to fix it.  */
9734
              if (qp_mutexes[i].path == md.path)
9735
                {
9736
                  /* If it is a proper subset of the mutex, create a
9737
                     new mutex.  */
9738
                  if (add == 0
9739
                      && (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) == mask)
9740
                    add = 1;
9741
 
9742
                  qp_mutexes[i].prmask &= ~mask;
9743
                  if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & (qp_mutexes[i].prmask - 1))
9744
                    {
9745
                      /* Modify the mutex if there are more than one
9746
                         PR left.  */
9747
                      keep = 1;
9748
                      i++;
9749
                    }
9750
                }
9751
 
9752
              if (keep == 0)
9753
                /* Remove the mutex.  */
9754
                qp_mutexes[i] = qp_mutexes[--qp_mutexeslen];
9755
            }
9756
        }
9757
      else
9758
        ++i;
9759
    }
9760
 
9761
  if (add == 1)
9762
    add_qp_mutex (mask);
9763
 
9764
  return add;
9765
}
9766
 
9767
/* Remove any mutexes which contain any of the PRs indicated in the mask.
9768
 
9769
   Any changes to a PR clears the mutex relations which include that PR.  */
9770
 
9771
static void
9772
clear_qp_mutex (mask)
9773
     valueT mask;
9774
{
9775
  int i;
9776
 
9777
  i = 0;
9778
  while (i < qp_mutexeslen)
9779
    {
9780
      if ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) != 0)
9781
        {
9782
          if (md.debug_dv)
9783
            {
9784
              fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing mutex relation");
9785
              print_prmask (qp_mutexes[i].prmask);
9786
              fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9787
            }
9788
          qp_mutexes[i] = qp_mutexes[--qp_mutexeslen];
9789
        }
9790
      else
9791
        ++i;
9792
    }
9793
}
9794
 
9795
/* Clear implies relations which contain PRs in the given masks.
9796
   P1_MASK indicates the source of the implies relation, while P2_MASK
9797
   indicates the implied PR.  */
9798
 
9799
static void
9800
clear_qp_implies (p1_mask, p2_mask)
9801
     valueT p1_mask;
9802
     valueT p2_mask;
9803
{
9804
  int i;
9805
 
9806
  i = 0;
9807
  while (i < qp_implieslen)
9808
    {
9809
      if ((((valueT) 1 << qp_implies[i].p1) & p1_mask) != 0
9810
          || (((valueT) 1 << qp_implies[i].p2) & p2_mask) != 0)
9811
        {
9812
          if (md.debug_dv)
9813
            fprintf (stderr, "Clearing implied relation PR%d->PR%d\n",
9814
                     qp_implies[i].p1, qp_implies[i].p2);
9815
          qp_implies[i] = qp_implies[--qp_implieslen];
9816
        }
9817
      else
9818
        ++i;
9819
    }
9820
}
9821
 
9822
/* Add the PRs specified to the list of implied relations.  */
9823
 
9824
static void
9825
add_qp_imply (p1, p2)
9826
     int p1, p2;
9827
{
9828
  valueT mask;
9829
  valueT bit;
9830
  int i;
9831
 
9832
  /* p0 is not meaningful here.  */
9833
  if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
9834
    abort ();
9835
 
9836
  if (p1 == p2)
9837
    return;
9838
 
9839
  /* If it exists already, ignore it.  */
9840
  for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
9841
    {
9842
      if (qp_implies[i].p1 == p1
9843
          && qp_implies[i].p2 == p2
9844
          && qp_implies[i].path == md.path
9845
          && !qp_implies[i].p2_branched)
9846
        return;
9847
    }
9848
 
9849
  if (qp_implieslen == qp_impliestotlen)
9850
    {
9851
      qp_impliestotlen += 20;
9852
      qp_implies = (struct qp_imply *)
9853
        xrealloc ((void *) qp_implies,
9854
                  qp_impliestotlen * sizeof (struct qp_imply));
9855
    }
9856
  if (md.debug_dv)
9857
    fprintf (stderr, "  Registering PR%d implies PR%d\n", p1, p2);
9858
  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].p1 = p1;
9859
  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].p2 = p2;
9860
  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].path = md.path;
9861
  qp_implies[qp_implieslen++].p2_branched = 0;
9862
 
9863
  /* Add in the implied transitive relations; for everything that p2 implies,
9864
     make p1 imply that, too; for everything that implies p1, make it imply p2
9865
     as well.  */
9866
  for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
9867
    {
9868
      if (qp_implies[i].p1 == p2)
9869
        add_qp_imply (p1, qp_implies[i].p2);
9870
      if (qp_implies[i].p2 == p1)
9871
        add_qp_imply (qp_implies[i].p1, p2);
9872
    }
9873
  /* Add in mutex relations implied by this implies relation; for each mutex
9874
     relation containing p2, duplicate it and replace p2 with p1.  */
9875
  bit = (valueT) 1 << p1;
9876
  mask = (valueT) 1 << p2;
9877
  for (i = 0; i < qp_mutexeslen; i++)
9878
    {
9879
      if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask)
9880
        add_qp_mutex ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & ~mask) | bit);
9881
    }
9882
}
9883
 
9884
/* Add the PRs specified in the mask to the mutex list; this means that only
9885
   one of the PRs can be true at any time.  PR0 should never be included in
9886
   the mask.  */
9887
 
9888
static void
9889
add_qp_mutex (mask)
9890
     valueT mask;
9891
{
9892
  if (mask & 0x1)
9893
    abort ();
9894
 
9895
  if (qp_mutexeslen == qp_mutexestotlen)
9896
    {
9897
      qp_mutexestotlen += 20;
9898
      qp_mutexes = (struct qpmutex *)
9899
        xrealloc ((void *) qp_mutexes,
9900
                  qp_mutexestotlen * sizeof (struct qpmutex));
9901
    }
9902
  if (md.debug_dv)
9903
    {
9904
      fprintf (stderr, "  Registering mutex on");
9905
      print_prmask (mask);
9906
      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9907
    }
9908
  qp_mutexes[qp_mutexeslen].path = md.path;
9909
  qp_mutexes[qp_mutexeslen++].prmask = mask;
9910
}
9911
 
9912
static int
9913
has_suffix_p (name, suffix)
9914
     const char *name;
9915
     const char *suffix;
9916
{
9917
  size_t namelen = strlen (name);
9918
  size_t sufflen = strlen (suffix);
9919
 
9920
  if (namelen <= sufflen)
9921
    return 0;
9922
  return strcmp (name + namelen - sufflen, suffix) == 0;
9923
}
9924
 
9925
static void
9926
clear_register_values ()
9927
{
9928
  int i;
9929
  if (md.debug_dv)
9930
    fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing register values\n");
9931
  for (i = 1; i < NELEMS (gr_values); i++)
9932
    gr_values[i].known = 0;
9933
}
9934
 
9935
/* Keep track of register values/changes which affect DV tracking.
9936
 
9937
   optimization note: should add a flag to classes of insns where otherwise we
9938
   have to examine a group of strings to identify them.  */
9939
 
9940
static void
9941
note_register_values (idesc)
9942
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
9943
{
9944
  valueT qp_changemask = 0;
9945
  int i;
9946
 
9947
  /* Invalidate values for registers being written to.  */
9948
  for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
9949
    {
9950
      if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9951
          || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9952
          || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9953
        {
9954
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9955
          if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
9956
            gr_values[regno].known = 0;
9957
        }
9958
      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3_2)
9959
        {
9960
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9961
          if (regno > 0 && regno < 4)
9962
            gr_values[regno].known = 0;
9963
        }
9964
      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
9965
               || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9966
        {
9967
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
9968
          qp_changemask |= (valueT) 1 << regno;
9969
        }
9970
      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PR)
9971
        {
9972
          if (idesc->operands[2] & (valueT) 0x10000)
9973
            qp_changemask = ~(valueT) 0x1FFFF | idesc->operands[2];
9974
          else
9975
            qp_changemask = idesc->operands[2];
9976
          break;
9977
        }
9978
      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PR_ROT)
9979
        {
9980
          if (idesc->operands[1] & ((valueT) 1 << 43))
9981
            qp_changemask = -((valueT) 1 << 44) | idesc->operands[1];
9982
          else
9983
            qp_changemask = idesc->operands[1];
9984
          qp_changemask &= ~(valueT) 0xFFFF;
9985
          break;
9986
        }
9987
    }
9988
 
9989
  /* Always clear qp branch flags on any PR change.  */
9990
  /* FIXME there may be exceptions for certain compares.  */
9991
  clear_qp_branch_flag (qp_changemask);
9992
 
9993
  /* Invalidate rotating registers on insns which affect RRBs in CFM.  */
9994
  if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_MOD_RRBS)
9995
    {
9996
      qp_changemask |= ~(valueT) 0xFFFF;
9997
      if (strcmp (idesc->name, "clrrrb.pr") != 0)
9998
        {
9999
          for (i = 32; i < 32 + md.rot.num_regs; i++)
10000
            gr_values[i].known = 0;
10001
        }
10002
      clear_qp_mutex (qp_changemask);
10003
      clear_qp_implies (qp_changemask, qp_changemask);
10004
    }
10005
  /* After a call, all register values are undefined, except those marked
10006
     as "safe".  */
10007
  else if (strncmp (idesc->name, "br.call", 6) == 0
10008
           || strncmp (idesc->name, "brl.call", 7) == 0)
10009
    {
10010
      /* FIXME keep GR values which are marked as "safe_across_calls"  */
10011
      clear_register_values ();
10012
      clear_qp_mutex (~qp_safe_across_calls);
10013
      clear_qp_implies (~qp_safe_across_calls, ~qp_safe_across_calls);
10014
      clear_qp_branch_flag (~qp_safe_across_calls);
10015
    }
10016
  else if (is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc)
10017
           || is_taken_branch (idesc))
10018
    {
10019
      clear_register_values ();
10020
      clear_qp_mutex (~(valueT) 0);
10021
      clear_qp_implies (~(valueT) 0, ~(valueT) 0);
10022
    }
10023
  /* Look for mutex and implies relations.  */
10024
  else if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
10025
            || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
10026
           && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
10027
               || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2))
10028
    {
10029
      int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
10030
      int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
10031
      valueT p1mask = (p1 != 0) ? (valueT) 1 << p1 : 0;
10032
      valueT p2mask = (p2 != 0) ? (valueT) 1 << p2 : 0;
10033
 
10034
      /* If both PRs are PR0, we can't really do anything.  */
10035
      if (p1 == 0 && p2 == 0)
10036
        {
10037
          if (md.debug_dv)
10038
            fprintf (stderr, "  Ignoring PRs due to inclusion of p0\n");
10039
        }
10040
      /* In general, clear mutexes and implies which include P1 or P2,
10041
         with the following exceptions.  */
10042
      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".or.andcm")
10043
               || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".and.orcm"))
10044
        {
10045
          clear_qp_implies (p2mask, p1mask);
10046
        }
10047
      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".andcm")
10048
               || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".and"))
10049
        {
10050
          clear_qp_implies (0, p1mask | p2mask);
10051
        }
10052
      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".orcm")
10053
               || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".or"))
10054
        {
10055
          clear_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
10056
          clear_qp_implies (p1mask | p2mask, 0);
10057
        }
10058
      else
10059
        {
10060
          int added = 0;
10061
 
10062
          clear_qp_implies (p1mask | p2mask, p1mask | p2mask);
10063
 
10064
          /* If one of the PRs is PR0, we call clear_qp_mutex.  */
10065
          if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
10066
            clear_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
10067
          else
10068
            added = update_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
10069
 
10070
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0
10071
              || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".unc"))
10072
            {
10073
              if (added == 0 && p1 && p2)
10074
                add_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
10075
              if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
10076
                {
10077
                  if (p1)
10078
                    add_qp_imply (p1, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno);
10079
                  if (p2)
10080
                    add_qp_imply (p2, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno);
10081
                }
10082
            }
10083
        }
10084
    }
10085
  /* Look for mov imm insns into GRs.  */
10086
  else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_R1
10087
           && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMM22
10088
               || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMMU64)
10089
           && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_op == O_constant
10090
           && (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0
10091
               || strcmp (idesc->name, "movl") == 0))
10092
    {
10093
      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
10094
      if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
10095
        {
10096
          gr_values[regno].known = 1;
10097
          gr_values[regno].value = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number;
10098
          gr_values[regno].path = md.path;
10099
          if (md.debug_dv)
10100
            {
10101
              fprintf (stderr, "  Know gr%d = ", regno);
10102
              fprintf_vma (stderr, gr_values[regno].value);
10103
              fputs ("\n", stderr);
10104
            }
10105
        }
10106
    }
10107
  /* Look for dep.z imm insns.  */
10108
  else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_R1
10109
           && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMM8
10110
           && strcmp (idesc->name, "dep.z") == 0)
10111
    {
10112
      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
10113
      if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
10114
        {
10115
          valueT value = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number;
10116
 
10117
          if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[3].X_add_number < 64)
10118
            value &= ((valueT)1 << CURR_SLOT.opnd[3].X_add_number) - 1;
10119
          value <<= CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
10120
          gr_values[regno].known = 1;
10121
          gr_values[regno].value = value;
10122
          gr_values[regno].path = md.path;
10123
          if (md.debug_dv)
10124
            {
10125
              fprintf (stderr, "  Know gr%d = ", regno);
10126
              fprintf_vma (stderr, gr_values[regno].value);
10127
              fputs ("\n", stderr);
10128
            }
10129
        }
10130
    }
10131
  else
10132
    {
10133
      clear_qp_mutex (qp_changemask);
10134
      clear_qp_implies (qp_changemask, qp_changemask);
10135
    }
10136
}
10137
 
10138
/* Return whether the given predicate registers are currently mutex.  */
10139
 
10140
static int
10141
qp_mutex (p1, p2, path)
10142
     int p1;
10143
     int p2;
10144
     int path;
10145
{
10146
  int i;
10147
  valueT mask;
10148
 
10149
  if (p1 != p2)
10150
    {
10151
      mask = ((valueT) 1 << p1) | (valueT) 1 << p2;
10152
      for (i = 0; i < qp_mutexeslen; i++)
10153
        {
10154
          if (qp_mutexes[i].path >= path
10155
              && (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) == mask)
10156
            return 1;
10157
        }
10158
    }
10159
  return 0;
10160
}
10161
 
10162
/* Return whether the given resource is in the given insn's list of chks
10163
   Return 1 if the conflict is absolutely determined, 2 if it's a potential
10164
   conflict.  */
10165
 
10166
static int
10167
resources_match (rs, idesc, note, qp_regno, path)
10168
     struct rsrc *rs;
10169
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
10170
     int note;
10171
     int qp_regno;
10172
     int path;
10173
{
10174
  struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS];
10175
  int count;
10176
 
10177
  /* If the marked resource's qp_regno and the given qp_regno are mutex,
10178
     we don't need to check.  One exception is note 11, which indicates that
10179
     target predicates are written regardless of PR[qp].  */
10180
  if (qp_mutex (rs->qp_regno, qp_regno, path)
10181
      && note != 11)
10182
    return 0;
10183
 
10184
  count = specify_resource (rs->dependency, idesc, DV_CHK, specs, note, path);
10185
  while (count-- > 0)
10186
    {
10187
      /* UNAT checking is a bit more specific than other resources */
10188
      if (rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_AR_UNAT
10189
          && specs[count].mem_offset.hint
10190
          && rs->mem_offset.hint)
10191
        {
10192
          if (rs->mem_offset.base == specs[count].mem_offset.base)
10193
            {
10194
              if (((rs->mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F) ==
10195
                  ((specs[count].mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F))
10196
                return 1;
10197
              else
10198
                continue;
10199
            }
10200
        }
10201
 
10202
      /* Skip apparent PR write conflicts where both writes are an AND or both
10203
         writes are an OR.  */
10204
      if (rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PR
10205
          || rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PRr
10206
          || rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PR63)
10207
        {
10208
          if (specs[count].cmp_type != CMP_NONE
10209
              && specs[count].cmp_type == rs->cmp_type)
10210
            {
10211
              if (md.debug_dv)
10212
                fprintf (stderr, "  %s on parallel compare allowed (PR%d)\n",
10213
                         dv_mode[rs->dependency->mode],
10214
                         rs->dependency->specifier != IA64_RS_PR63 ?
10215
                         specs[count].index : 63);
10216
              continue;
10217
            }
10218
          if (md.debug_dv)
10219
            fprintf (stderr,
10220
                     "  %s on parallel compare conflict %s vs %s on PR%d\n",
10221
                     dv_mode[rs->dependency->mode],
10222
                     dv_cmp_type[rs->cmp_type],
10223
                     dv_cmp_type[specs[count].cmp_type],
10224
                     rs->dependency->specifier != IA64_RS_PR63 ?
10225
                     specs[count].index : 63);
10226
 
10227
        }
10228
 
10229
      /* If either resource is not specific, conservatively assume a conflict
10230
       */
10231
      if (!specs[count].specific || !rs->specific)
10232
        return 2;
10233
      else if (specs[count].index == rs->index)
10234
        return 1;
10235
    }
10236
 
10237
  return 0;
10238
}
10239
 
10240
/* Indicate an instruction group break; if INSERT_STOP is non-zero, then
10241
   insert a stop to create the break.  Update all resource dependencies
10242
   appropriately.  If QP_REGNO is non-zero, only apply the break to resources
10243
   which use the same QP_REGNO and have the link_to_qp_branch flag set.
10244
   If SAVE_CURRENT is non-zero, don't affect resources marked by the current
10245
   instruction.  */
10246
 
10247
static void
10248
insn_group_break (insert_stop, qp_regno, save_current)
10249
     int insert_stop;
10250
     int qp_regno;
10251
     int save_current;
10252
{
10253
  int i;
10254
 
10255
  if (insert_stop && md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
10256
    PREV_SLOT.end_of_insn_group = 1;
10257
 
10258
  if (md.debug_dv)
10259
    {
10260
      fprintf (stderr, "  Insn group break%s",
10261
               (insert_stop ? " (w/stop)" : ""));
10262
      if (qp_regno != 0)
10263
        fprintf (stderr, " effective for QP=%d", qp_regno);
10264
      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
10265
    }
10266
 
10267
  i = 0;
10268
  while (i < regdepslen)
10269
    {
10270
      const struct ia64_dependency *dep = regdeps[i].dependency;
10271
 
10272
      if (qp_regno != 0
10273
          && regdeps[i].qp_regno != qp_regno)
10274
        {
10275
          ++i;
10276
          continue;
10277
        }
10278
 
10279
      if (save_current
10280
          && CURR_SLOT.src_file == regdeps[i].file
10281
          && CURR_SLOT.src_line == regdeps[i].line)
10282
        {
10283
          ++i;
10284
          continue;
10285
        }
10286
 
10287
      /* clear dependencies which are automatically cleared by a stop, or
10288
         those that have reached the appropriate state of insn serialization */
10289
      if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_IMPLIED
10290
          || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_IMPLIEDF
10291
          || regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_SRLZ)
10292
        {
10293
          print_dependency ("Removing", i);
10294
          regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10295
        }
10296
      else
10297
        {
10298
          if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_DATA
10299
              || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_INSTR
10300
              || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_SPECIFIC)
10301
            {
10302
              if (regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_NONE)
10303
                regdeps[i].insn_srlz = STATE_STOP;
10304
              if (regdeps[i].data_srlz == STATE_NONE)
10305
                regdeps[i].data_srlz = STATE_STOP;
10306
            }
10307
          ++i;
10308
        }
10309
    }
10310
}
10311
 
10312
/* Add the given resource usage spec to the list of active dependencies.  */
10313
 
10314
static void
10315
mark_resource (idesc, dep, spec, depind, path)
10316
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
10317
     const struct ia64_dependency *dep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
10318
     struct rsrc *spec;
10319
     int depind;
10320
     int path;
10321
{
10322
  if (regdepslen == regdepstotlen)
10323
    {
10324
      regdepstotlen += 20;
10325
      regdeps = (struct rsrc *)
10326
        xrealloc ((void *) regdeps,
10327
                  regdepstotlen * sizeof (struct rsrc));
10328
    }
10329
 
10330
  regdeps[regdepslen] = *spec;
10331
  regdeps[regdepslen].depind = depind;
10332
  regdeps[regdepslen].path = path;
10333
  regdeps[regdepslen].file = CURR_SLOT.src_file;
10334
  regdeps[regdepslen].line = CURR_SLOT.src_line;
10335
 
10336
  print_dependency ("Adding", regdepslen);
10337
 
10338
  ++regdepslen;
10339
}
10340
 
10341
static void
10342
print_dependency (action, depind)
10343
     const char *action;
10344
     int depind;
10345
{
10346
  if (md.debug_dv)
10347
    {
10348
      fprintf (stderr, "  %s %s '%s'",
10349
               action, dv_mode[(regdeps[depind].dependency)->mode],
10350
               (regdeps[depind].dependency)->name);
10351
      if (regdeps[depind].specific && regdeps[depind].index >= 0)
10352
        fprintf (stderr, " (%d)", regdeps[depind].index);
10353
      if (regdeps[depind].mem_offset.hint)
10354
        {
10355
          fputs (" ", stderr);
10356
          fprintf_vma (stderr, regdeps[depind].mem_offset.base);
10357
          fputs ("+", stderr);
10358
          fprintf_vma (stderr, regdeps[depind].mem_offset.offset);
10359
        }
10360
      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
10361
    }
10362
}
10363
 
10364
static void
10365
instruction_serialization ()
10366
{
10367
  int i;
10368
  if (md.debug_dv)
10369
    fprintf (stderr, "  Instruction serialization\n");
10370
  for (i = 0; i < regdepslen; i++)
10371
    if (regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_STOP)
10372
      regdeps[i].insn_srlz = STATE_SRLZ;
10373
}
10374
 
10375
static void
10376
data_serialization ()
10377
{
10378
  int i = 0;
10379
  if (md.debug_dv)
10380
    fprintf (stderr, "  Data serialization\n");
10381
  while (i < regdepslen)
10382
    {
10383
      if (regdeps[i].data_srlz == STATE_STOP
10384
          /* Note: as of 991210, all "other" dependencies are cleared by a
10385
             data serialization.  This might change with new tables */
10386
          || (regdeps[i].dependency)->semantics == IA64_DVS_OTHER)
10387
        {
10388
          print_dependency ("Removing", i);
10389
          regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10390
        }
10391
      else
10392
        ++i;
10393
    }
10394
}
10395
 
10396
/* Insert stops and serializations as needed to avoid DVs.  */
10397
 
10398
static void
10399
remove_marked_resource (rs)
10400
     struct rsrc *rs;
10401
{
10402
  switch (rs->dependency->semantics)
10403
    {
10404
    case IA64_DVS_SPECIFIC:
10405
      if (md.debug_dv)
10406
        fprintf (stderr, "Implementation-specific, assume worst case...\n");
10407
      /* ...fall through...  */
10408
    case IA64_DVS_INSTR:
10409
      if (md.debug_dv)
10410
        fprintf (stderr, "Inserting instr serialization\n");
10411
      if (rs->insn_srlz < STATE_STOP)
10412
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10413
      if (rs->insn_srlz < STATE_SRLZ)
10414
        {
10415
          struct slot oldslot = CURR_SLOT;
10416
          /* Manually jam a srlz.i insn into the stream */
10417
          memset (&CURR_SLOT, 0, sizeof (CURR_SLOT));
10418
          CURR_SLOT.user_template = -1;
10419
          CURR_SLOT.idesc = ia64_find_opcode ("srlz.i");
10420
          instruction_serialization ();
10421
          md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
10422
          if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
10423
            emit_one_bundle ();
10424
          CURR_SLOT = oldslot;
10425
        }
10426
      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10427
      break;
10428
    case IA64_DVS_OTHER: /* as of rev2 (991220) of the DV tables, all
10429
                            "other" types of DV are eliminated
10430
                            by a data serialization */
10431
    case IA64_DVS_DATA:
10432
      if (md.debug_dv)
10433
        fprintf (stderr, "Inserting data serialization\n");
10434
      if (rs->data_srlz < STATE_STOP)
10435
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10436
      {
10437
        struct slot oldslot = CURR_SLOT;
10438
        /* Manually jam a srlz.d insn into the stream */
10439
        memset (&CURR_SLOT, 0, sizeof (CURR_SLOT));
10440
        CURR_SLOT.user_template = -1;
10441
        CURR_SLOT.idesc = ia64_find_opcode ("srlz.d");
10442
        data_serialization ();
10443
        md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
10444
        if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
10445
          emit_one_bundle ();
10446
        CURR_SLOT = oldslot;
10447
      }
10448
      break;
10449
    case IA64_DVS_IMPLIED:
10450
    case IA64_DVS_IMPLIEDF:
10451
      if (md.debug_dv)
10452
        fprintf (stderr, "Inserting stop\n");
10453
      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10454
      break;
10455
    default:
10456
      break;
10457
    }
10458
}
10459
 
10460
/* Check the resources used by the given opcode against the current dependency
10461
   list.
10462
 
10463
   The check is run once for each execution path encountered.  In this case,
10464
   a unique execution path is the sequence of instructions following a code
10465
   entry point, e.g. the following has three execution paths, one starting
10466
   at L0, one at L1, and one at L2.
10467
 
10468
   L0:     nop
10469
   L1:     add
10470
   L2:     add
10471
   br.ret
10472
*/
10473
 
10474
static void
10475
check_dependencies (idesc)
10476
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
10477
{
10478
  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *opdeps = idesc->dependencies;
10479
  int path;
10480
  int i;
10481
 
10482
  /* Note that the number of marked resources may change within the
10483
     loop if in auto mode.  */
10484
  i = 0;
10485
  while (i < regdepslen)
10486
    {
10487
      struct rsrc *rs = &regdeps[i];
10488
      const struct ia64_dependency *dep = rs->dependency;
10489
      int chkind;
10490
      int note;
10491
      int start_over = 0;
10492
 
10493
      if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_NONE
10494
          || (chkind = depends_on (rs->depind, idesc)) == -1)
10495
        {
10496
          ++i;
10497
          continue;
10498
        }
10499
 
10500
      note = NOTE (opdeps->chks[chkind]);
10501
 
10502
      /* Check this resource against each execution path seen thus far.  */
10503
      for (path = 0; path <= md.path; path++)
10504
        {
10505
          int matchtype;
10506
 
10507
          /* If the dependency wasn't on the path being checked, ignore it.  */
10508
          if (rs->path < path)
10509
            continue;
10510
 
10511
          /* If the QP for this insn implies a QP which has branched, don't
10512
             bother checking.  Ed. NOTE: I don't think this check is terribly
10513
             useful; what's the point of generating code which will only be
10514
             reached if its QP is zero?
10515
             This code was specifically inserted to handle the following code,
10516
             based on notes from Intel's DV checking code, where p1 implies p2.
10517
 
10518
                  mov r4 = 2
10519
             (p2) br.cond L
10520
             (p1) mov r4 = 7
10521
          */
10522
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
10523
            {
10524
              int skip = 0;
10525
              int implies;
10526
              for (implies = 0; implies < qp_implieslen; implies++)
10527
                {
10528
                  if (qp_implies[implies].path >= path
10529
                      && qp_implies[implies].p1 == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno
10530
                      && qp_implies[implies].p2_branched)
10531
                    {
10532
                      skip = 1;
10533
                      break;
10534
                    }
10535
                }
10536
              if (skip)
10537
                continue;
10538
            }
10539
 
10540
          if ((matchtype = resources_match (rs, idesc, note,
10541
                                            CURR_SLOT.qp_regno, path)) != 0)
10542
            {
10543
              char msg[1024];
10544
              char pathmsg[256] = "";
10545
              char indexmsg[256] = "";
10546
              int certain = (matchtype == 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0);
10547
 
10548
              if (path != 0)
10549
                snprintf (pathmsg, sizeof (pathmsg),
10550
                          " when entry is at label '%s'",
10551
                         md.entry_labels[path - 1]);
10552
              if (matchtype == 1 && rs->index >= 0)
10553
                snprintf (indexmsg, sizeof (indexmsg),
10554
                          ", specific resource number is %d",
10555
                         rs->index);
10556
              snprintf (msg, sizeof (msg),
10557
                        "Use of '%s' %s %s dependency '%s' (%s)%s%s",
10558
                       idesc->name,
10559
                       (certain ? "violates" : "may violate"),
10560
                       dv_mode[dep->mode], dep->name,
10561
                       dv_sem[dep->semantics],
10562
                       pathmsg, indexmsg);
10563
 
10564
              if (md.explicit_mode)
10565
                {
10566
                  as_warn ("%s", msg);
10567
                  if (path < md.path)
10568
                    as_warn (_("Only the first path encountering the conflict is reported"));
10569
                  as_warn_where (rs->file, rs->line,
10570
                                 _("This is the location of the conflicting usage"));
10571
                  /* Don't bother checking other paths, to avoid duplicating
10572
                     the same warning */
10573
                  break;
10574
                }
10575
              else
10576
                {
10577
                  if (md.debug_dv)
10578
                    fprintf (stderr, "%s @ %s:%d\n", msg, rs->file, rs->line);
10579
 
10580
                  remove_marked_resource (rs);
10581
 
10582
                  /* since the set of dependencies has changed, start over */
10583
                  /* FIXME -- since we're removing dvs as we go, we
10584
                     probably don't really need to start over...  */
10585
                  start_over = 1;
10586
                  break;
10587
                }
10588
            }
10589
        }
10590
      if (start_over)
10591
        i = 0;
10592
      else
10593
        ++i;
10594
    }
10595
}
10596
 
10597
/* Register new dependencies based on the given opcode.  */
10598
 
10599
static void
10600
mark_resources (idesc)
10601
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
10602
{
10603
  int i;
10604
  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *opdeps = idesc->dependencies;
10605
  int add_only_qp_reads = 0;
10606
 
10607
  /* A conditional branch only uses its resources if it is taken; if it is
10608
     taken, we stop following that path.  The other branch types effectively
10609
     *always* write their resources.  If it's not taken, register only QP
10610
     reads.  */
10611
  if (is_conditional_branch (idesc) || is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc))
10612
    {
10613
      add_only_qp_reads = 1;
10614
    }
10615
 
10616
  if (md.debug_dv)
10617
    fprintf (stderr, "Registering '%s' resource usage\n", idesc->name);
10618
 
10619
  for (i = 0; i < opdeps->nregs; i++)
10620
    {
10621
      const struct ia64_dependency *dep;
10622
      struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS];
10623
      int note;
10624
      int path;
10625
      int count;
10626
 
10627
      dep = ia64_find_dependency (opdeps->regs[i]);
10628
      note = NOTE (opdeps->regs[i]);
10629
 
10630
      if (add_only_qp_reads
10631
          && !(dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAR
10632
               && (dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PR
10633
                   || dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PRr
10634
                   || dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PR63)))
10635
        continue;
10636
 
10637
      count = specify_resource (dep, idesc, DV_REG, specs, note, md.path);
10638
 
10639
      while (count-- > 0)
10640
        {
10641
          mark_resource (idesc, dep, &specs[count],
10642
                         DEP (opdeps->regs[i]), md.path);
10643
        }
10644
 
10645
      /* The execution path may affect register values, which may in turn
10646
         affect which indirect-access resources are accessed.  */
10647
      switch (dep->specifier)
10648
        {
10649
        default:
10650
          break;
10651
        case IA64_RS_CPUID:
10652
        case IA64_RS_DBR:
10653
        case IA64_RS_IBR:
10654
        case IA64_RS_MSR:
10655
        case IA64_RS_PKR:
10656
        case IA64_RS_PMC:
10657
        case IA64_RS_PMD:
10658
        case IA64_RS_RR:
10659
          for (path = 0; path < md.path; path++)
10660
            {
10661
              count = specify_resource (dep, idesc, DV_REG, specs, note, path);
10662
              while (count-- > 0)
10663
                mark_resource (idesc, dep, &specs[count],
10664
                               DEP (opdeps->regs[i]), path);
10665
            }
10666
          break;
10667
        }
10668
    }
10669
}
10670
 
10671
/* Remove dependencies when they no longer apply.  */
10672
 
10673
static void
10674
update_dependencies (idesc)
10675
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
10676
{
10677
  int i;
10678
 
10679
  if (strcmp (idesc->name, "srlz.i") == 0)
10680
    {
10681
      instruction_serialization ();
10682
    }
10683
  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "srlz.d") == 0)
10684
    {
10685
      data_serialization ();
10686
    }
10687
  else if (is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc)
10688
           || is_taken_branch (idesc))
10689
    {
10690
      /* Although technically the taken branch doesn't clear dependencies
10691
         which require a srlz.[id], we don't follow the branch; the next
10692
         instruction is assumed to start with a clean slate.  */
10693
      regdepslen = 0;
10694
      md.path = 0;
10695
    }
10696
  else if (is_conditional_branch (idesc)
10697
           && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
10698
    {
10699
      int is_call = strstr (idesc->name, ".call") != NULL;
10700
 
10701
      for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
10702
        {
10703
          /* If the conditional branch's predicate is implied by the predicate
10704
             in an existing dependency, remove that dependency.  */
10705
          if (qp_implies[i].p2 == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno)
10706
            {
10707
              int depind = 0;
10708
              /* Note that this implied predicate takes a branch so that if
10709
                 a later insn generates a DV but its predicate implies this
10710
                 one, we can avoid the false DV warning.  */
10711
              qp_implies[i].p2_branched = 1;
10712
              while (depind < regdepslen)
10713
                {
10714
                  if (regdeps[depind].qp_regno == qp_implies[i].p1)
10715
                    {
10716
                      print_dependency ("Removing", depind);
10717
                      regdeps[depind] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10718
                    }
10719
                  else
10720
                    ++depind;
10721
                }
10722
            }
10723
        }
10724
      /* Any marked resources which have this same predicate should be
10725
         cleared, provided that the QP hasn't been modified between the
10726
         marking instruction and the branch.  */
10727
      if (is_call)
10728
        {
10729
          insn_group_break (0, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno, 1);
10730
        }
10731
      else
10732
        {
10733
          i = 0;
10734
          while (i < regdepslen)
10735
            {
10736
              if (regdeps[i].qp_regno == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno
10737
                  && regdeps[i].link_to_qp_branch
10738
                  && (regdeps[i].file != CURR_SLOT.src_file
10739
                      || regdeps[i].line != CURR_SLOT.src_line))
10740
                {
10741
                  /* Treat like a taken branch */
10742
                  print_dependency ("Removing", i);
10743
                  regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10744
                }
10745
              else
10746
                ++i;
10747
            }
10748
        }
10749
    }
10750
}
10751
 
10752
/* Examine the current instruction for dependency violations.  */
10753
 
10754
static int
10755
check_dv (idesc)
10756
     struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
10757
{
10758
  if (md.debug_dv)
10759
    {
10760
      fprintf (stderr, "Checking %s for violations (line %d, %d/%d)\n",
10761
               idesc->name, CURR_SLOT.src_line,
10762
               idesc->dependencies->nchks,
10763
               idesc->dependencies->nregs);
10764
    }
10765
 
10766
  /* Look through the list of currently marked resources; if the current
10767
     instruction has the dependency in its chks list which uses that resource,
10768
     check against the specific resources used.  */
10769
  check_dependencies (idesc);
10770
 
10771
  /* Look up the instruction's regdeps (RAW writes, WAW writes, and WAR reads),
10772
     then add them to the list of marked resources.  */
10773
  mark_resources (idesc);
10774
 
10775
  /* There are several types of dependency semantics, and each has its own
10776
     requirements for being cleared
10777
 
10778
     Instruction serialization (insns separated by interruption, rfi, or
10779
     writer + srlz.i + reader, all in separate groups) clears DVS_INSTR.
10780
 
10781
     Data serialization (instruction serialization, or writer + srlz.d +
10782
     reader, where writer and srlz.d are in separate groups) clears
10783
     DVS_DATA. (This also clears DVS_OTHER, but that is not guaranteed to
10784
     always be the case).
10785
 
10786
     Instruction group break (groups separated by stop, taken branch,
10787
     interruption or rfi) clears DVS_IMPLIED and DVS_IMPLIEDF.
10788
   */
10789
  update_dependencies (idesc);
10790
 
10791
  /* Sometimes, knowing a register value allows us to avoid giving a false DV
10792
     warning.  Keep track of as many as possible that are useful.  */
10793
  note_register_values (idesc);
10794
 
10795
  /* We don't need or want this anymore.  */
10796
  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
10797
 
10798
  return 0;
10799
}
10800
 
10801
/* Translate one line of assembly.  Pseudo ops and labels do not show
10802
   here.  */
10803
void
10804
md_assemble (str)
10805
     char *str;
10806
{
10807
  char *saved_input_line_pointer, *mnemonic;
10808
  const struct pseudo_opcode *pdesc;
10809
  struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
10810
  unsigned char qp_regno;
10811
  unsigned int flags;
10812
  int ch;
10813
 
10814
  saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
10815
  input_line_pointer = str;
10816
 
10817
  /* extract the opcode (mnemonic):  */
10818
 
10819
  mnemonic = input_line_pointer;
10820
  ch = get_symbol_end ();
10821
  pdesc = (struct pseudo_opcode *) hash_find (md.pseudo_hash, mnemonic);
10822
  if (pdesc)
10823
    {
10824
      *input_line_pointer = ch;
10825
      (*pdesc->handler) (pdesc->arg);
10826
      goto done;
10827
    }
10828
 
10829
  /* Find the instruction descriptor matching the arguments.  */
10830
 
10831
  idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10832
  *input_line_pointer = ch;
10833
  if (!idesc)
10834
    {
10835
      as_bad (_("Unknown opcode `%s'"), mnemonic);
10836
      goto done;
10837
    }
10838
 
10839
  idesc = parse_operands (idesc);
10840
  if (!idesc)
10841
    goto done;
10842
 
10843
  /* Handle the dynamic ops we can handle now:  */
10844
  if (idesc->type == IA64_TYPE_DYN)
10845
    {
10846
      if (strcmp (idesc->name, "add") == 0)
10847
        {
10848
          if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_op == O_register
10849
              && CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number < 4)
10850
            mnemonic = "addl";
10851
          else
10852
            mnemonic = "adds";
10853
          ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
10854
          idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10855
        }
10856
      else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0)
10857
        {
10858
          enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
10859
          int rop;
10860
 
10861
          opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
10862
          opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
10863
          if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10864
            rop = 0;
10865
          else if (opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10866
            rop = 1;
10867
          else
10868
            abort ();
10869
          if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_op == O_register)
10870
            {
10871
              if (ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10872
                mnemonic = "mov.i";
10873
              else if (ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10874
                mnemonic = "mov.m";
10875
              else
10876
                rop = -1;
10877
            }
10878
          else
10879
            abort ();
10880
          if (rop >= 0)
10881
            {
10882
              ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
10883
              idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10884
              while (idesc != NULL
10885
                     && (idesc->operands[0] != opnd1
10886
                         || idesc->operands[1] != opnd2))
10887
                idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc);
10888
            }
10889
        }
10890
    }
10891
  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov.i") == 0
10892
           || strcmp (idesc->name, "mov.m") == 0)
10893
    {
10894
      enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
10895
      int rop;
10896
 
10897
      opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
10898
      opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
10899
      if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10900
        rop = 0;
10901
      else if (opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10902
        rop = 1;
10903
      else
10904
        abort ();
10905
      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_op == O_register)
10906
        {
10907
          char unit = 'a';
10908
          if (ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10909
            unit = 'i';
10910
          else if (ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10911
            unit = 'm';
10912
          if (unit != 'a' && unit != idesc->name [4])
10913
            as_bad (_("AR %d can only be accessed by %c-unit"),
10914
                    (int) (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number - REG_AR),
10915
                    TOUPPER (unit));
10916
        }
10917
    }
10918
  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "hint.b") == 0)
10919
    {
10920
      switch (md.hint_b)
10921
        {
10922
        case hint_b_ok:
10923
          break;
10924
        case hint_b_warning:
10925
          as_warn (_("hint.b may be treated as nop"));
10926
          break;
10927
        case hint_b_error:
10928
          as_bad (_("hint.b shouldn't be used"));
10929
          break;
10930
        }
10931
    }
10932
 
10933
  qp_regno = 0;
10934
  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
10935
    {
10936
      qp_regno = md.qp.X_add_number - REG_P;
10937
      md.qp.X_op = O_absent;
10938
    }
10939
 
10940
  flags = idesc->flags;
10941
 
10942
  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST) != 0)
10943
    {
10944
      /* The alignment frag has to end with a stop bit only if the
10945
         next instruction after the alignment directive has to be
10946
         the first instruction in an instruction group.  */
10947
      if (align_frag)
10948
        {
10949
          while (align_frag->fr_type != rs_align_code)
10950
            {
10951
              align_frag = align_frag->fr_next;
10952
              if (!align_frag)
10953
                break;
10954
            }
10955
          /* align_frag can be NULL if there are directives in
10956
             between.  */
10957
          if (align_frag && align_frag->fr_next == frag_now)
10958
            align_frag->tc_frag_data = 1;
10959
        }
10960
 
10961
      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10962
    }
10963
  align_frag = NULL;
10964
 
10965
  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_NO_PRED) != 0 && qp_regno != 0)
10966
    {
10967
      as_bad (_("`%s' cannot be predicated"), idesc->name);
10968
      goto done;
10969
    }
10970
 
10971
  /* Build the instruction.  */
10972
  CURR_SLOT.qp_regno = qp_regno;
10973
  CURR_SLOT.idesc = idesc;
10974
  as_where (&CURR_SLOT.src_file, &CURR_SLOT.src_line);
10975
  dwarf2_where (&CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
10976
  dwarf2_consume_line_info ();
10977
 
10978
  /* Add unwind entries, if there are any.  */
10979
  if (unwind.current_entry)
10980
    {
10981
      CURR_SLOT.unwind_record = unwind.current_entry;
10982
      unwind.current_entry = NULL;
10983
    }
10984
  if (unwind.pending_saves)
10985
    {
10986
      if (unwind.pending_saves->next)
10987
        {
10988
          /* Attach the next pending save to the next slot so that its
10989
             slot number will get set correctly.  */
10990
          add_unwind_entry (unwind.pending_saves->next, NOT_A_CHAR);
10991
          unwind.pending_saves = &unwind.pending_saves->next->r.record.p;
10992
        }
10993
      else
10994
        unwind.pending_saves = NULL;
10995
    }
10996
  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym && S_IS_DEFINED (unwind.proc_pending.sym))
10997
    unwind.insn = 1;
10998
 
10999
  /* Check for dependency violations.  */
11000
  if (md.detect_dv)
11001
    check_dv (idesc);
11002
 
11003
  md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
11004
  if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
11005
    emit_one_bundle ();
11006
 
11007
  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_LAST) != 0)
11008
    insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
11009
 
11010
  md.last_text_seg = now_seg;
11011
 
11012
 done:
11013
  input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
11014
}
11015
 
11016
/* Called when symbol NAME cannot be found in the symbol table.
11017
   Should be used for dynamic valued symbols only.  */
11018
 
11019
symbolS *
11020
md_undefined_symbol (name)
11021
     char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11022
{
11023
  return 0;
11024
}
11025
 
11026
/* Called for any expression that can not be recognized.  When the
11027
   function is called, `input_line_pointer' will point to the start of
11028
   the expression.  */
11029
 
11030
void
11031
md_operand (e)
11032
     expressionS *e;
11033
{
11034
  switch (*input_line_pointer)
11035
    {
11036
    case '[':
11037
      ++input_line_pointer;
11038
      expression_and_evaluate (e);
11039
      if (*input_line_pointer != ']')
11040
        {
11041
          as_bad (_("Closing bracket missing"));
11042
          goto err;
11043
        }
11044
      else
11045
        {
11046
          if (e->X_op != O_register
11047
              || e->X_add_number < REG_GR
11048
              || e->X_add_number > REG_GR + 127)
11049
            {
11050
              as_bad (_("Index must be a general register"));
11051
              e->X_add_number = REG_GR;
11052
            }
11053
 
11054
          ++input_line_pointer;
11055
          e->X_op = O_index;
11056
        }
11057
      break;
11058
 
11059
    default:
11060
      break;
11061
    }
11062
  return;
11063
 
11064
 err:
11065
  ignore_rest_of_line ();
11066
}
11067
 
11068
/* Return 1 if it's OK to adjust a reloc by replacing the symbol with
11069
   a section symbol plus some offset.  For relocs involving @fptr(),
11070
   directives we don't want such adjustments since we need to have the
11071
   original symbol's name in the reloc.  */
11072
int
11073
ia64_fix_adjustable (fix)
11074
     fixS *fix;
11075
{
11076
  /* Prevent all adjustments to global symbols */
11077
  if (S_IS_EXTERNAL (fix->fx_addsy) || S_IS_WEAK (fix->fx_addsy))
11078
    return 0;
11079
 
11080
  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11081
    {
11082
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
11083
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
11084
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB:
11085
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB:
11086
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
11087
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
11088
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
11089
      return 0;
11090
    default:
11091
      break;
11092
    }
11093
 
11094
  return 1;
11095
}
11096
 
11097
int
11098
ia64_force_relocation (fix)
11099
     fixS *fix;
11100
{
11101
  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11102
    {
11103
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
11104
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
11105
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB:
11106
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB:
11107
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
11108
 
11109
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22:
11110
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF64I:
11111
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
11112
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
11113
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF22:
11114
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64I:
11115
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64MSB:
11116
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64LSB:
11117
 
11118
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22X:
11119
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LDXMOV:
11120
      return 1;
11121
 
11122
    default:
11123
      break;
11124
    }
11125
 
11126
  return generic_force_reloc (fix);
11127
}
11128
 
11129
/* Decide from what point a pc-relative relocation is relative to,
11130
   relative to the pc-relative fixup.  Er, relatively speaking.  */
11131
long
11132
ia64_pcrel_from_section (fix, sec)
11133
     fixS *fix;
11134
     segT sec;
11135
{
11136
  unsigned long off = fix->fx_frag->fr_address + fix->fx_where;
11137
 
11138
  if (bfd_get_section_flags (stdoutput, sec) & SEC_CODE)
11139
    off &= ~0xfUL;
11140
 
11141
  return off;
11142
}
11143
 
11144
 
11145
/* Used to emit section-relative relocs for the dwarf2 debug data.  */
11146
void
11147
ia64_dwarf2_emit_offset (symbolS *symbol, unsigned int size)
11148
{
11149
  expressionS expr;
11150
 
11151
  expr.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
11152
  expr.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE].u.sym;
11153
  expr.X_add_number = 0;
11154
  expr.X_add_symbol = symbol;
11155
  emit_expr (&expr, size);
11156
}
11157
 
11158
/* This is called whenever some data item (not an instruction) needs a
11159
   fixup.  We pick the right reloc code depending on the byteorder
11160
   currently in effect.  */
11161
void
11162
ia64_cons_fix_new (f, where, nbytes, exp)
11163
     fragS *f;
11164
     int where;
11165
     int nbytes;
11166
     expressionS *exp;
11167
{
11168
  bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
11169
  fixS *fix;
11170
 
11171
  switch (nbytes)
11172
    {
11173
      /* There are no reloc for 8 and 16 bit quantities, but we allow
11174
         them here since they will work fine as long as the expression
11175
         is fully defined at the end of the pass over the source file.  */
11176
    case 1: code = BFD_RELOC_8; break;
11177
    case 2: code = BFD_RELOC_16; break;
11178
    case 4:
11179
      if (target_big_endian)
11180
        code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB;
11181
      else
11182
        code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB;
11183
      break;
11184
 
11185
    case 8:
11186
      /* In 32-bit mode, data8 could mean function descriptors too.  */
11187
      if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
11188
          && exp->X_op_symbol
11189
          && S_GET_VALUE (exp->X_op_symbol) == FUNC_IPLT_RELOC
11190
          && !(md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64))
11191
        {
11192
          if (target_big_endian)
11193
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB;
11194
          else
11195
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB;
11196
          exp->X_op = O_symbol;
11197
          break;
11198
        }
11199
      else
11200
        {
11201
          if (target_big_endian)
11202
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB;
11203
          else
11204
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB;
11205
          break;
11206
        }
11207
 
11208
    case 16:
11209
      if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
11210
          && exp->X_op_symbol
11211
          && S_GET_VALUE (exp->X_op_symbol) == FUNC_IPLT_RELOC)
11212
        {
11213
          if (target_big_endian)
11214
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB;
11215
          else
11216
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB;
11217
          exp->X_op = O_symbol;
11218
          break;
11219
        }
11220
      /* FALLTHRU */
11221
 
11222
    default:
11223
      as_bad (_("Unsupported fixup size %d"), nbytes);
11224
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11225
      return;
11226
    }
11227
 
11228
  if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
11229
    {
11230
      exp->X_op = O_symbol;
11231
      code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (exp->X_op_symbol, code);
11232
      /* ??? If code unchanged, unsupported.  */
11233
    }
11234
 
11235
  fix = fix_new_exp (f, where, nbytes, exp, 0, code);
11236
  /* We need to store the byte order in effect in case we're going
11237
     to fix an 8 or 16 bit relocation (for which there no real
11238
     relocs available).  See md_apply_fix().  */
11239
  fix->tc_fix_data.bigendian = target_big_endian;
11240
}
11241
 
11242
/* Return the actual relocation we wish to associate with the pseudo
11243
   reloc described by SYM and R_TYPE.  SYM should be one of the
11244
   symbols in the pseudo_func array, or NULL.  */
11245
 
11246
static bfd_reloc_code_real_type
11247
ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (sym, r_type)
11248
     struct symbol *sym;
11249
     bfd_reloc_code_real_type r_type;
11250
{
11251
  bfd_reloc_code_real_type new = 0;
11252
  const char *type = NULL, *suffix = "";
11253
 
11254
  if (sym == NULL)
11255
    {
11256
      return r_type;
11257
    }
11258
 
11259
  switch (S_GET_VALUE (sym))
11260
    {
11261
    case FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE:
11262
      switch (r_type)
11263
        {
11264
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I; break;
11265
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB; break;
11266
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB; break;
11267
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB; break;
11268
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB; break;
11269
        default:                        type = "FPTR"; break;
11270
        }
11271
      break;
11272
 
11273
    case FUNC_GP_RELATIVE:
11274
      switch (r_type)
11275
        {
11276
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL22; break;
11277
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64I; break;
11278
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL32MSB; break;
11279
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL32LSB; break;
11280
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64MSB; break;
11281
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64LSB; break;
11282
        default:                        type = "GPREL"; break;
11283
        }
11284
      break;
11285
 
11286
    case FUNC_LT_RELATIVE:
11287
      switch (r_type)
11288
        {
11289
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22; break;
11290
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF64I; break;
11291
        default:                        type = "LTOFF"; break;
11292
        }
11293
      break;
11294
 
11295
    case FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X:
11296
      switch (r_type)
11297
        {
11298
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22X; break;
11299
        default:                        type = "LTOFF"; suffix = "X"; break;
11300
        }
11301
      break;
11302
 
11303
    case FUNC_PC_RELATIVE:
11304
      switch (r_type)
11305
        {
11306
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL22; break;
11307
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64I; break;
11308
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32MSB; break;
11309
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32LSB; break;
11310
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64MSB; break;
11311
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64LSB; break;
11312
        default:                        type = "PCREL"; break;
11313
        }
11314
      break;
11315
 
11316
    case FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE:
11317
      switch (r_type)
11318
        {
11319
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF22; break;
11320
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64I; break;
11321
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64MSB;break;
11322
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64LSB;break;
11323
        default:                        type = "PLTOFF"; break;
11324
        }
11325
      break;
11326
 
11327
    case FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE:
11328
      switch (r_type)
11329
        {
11330
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL32MSB;break;
11331
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL32LSB;break;
11332
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL64MSB;break;
11333
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL64LSB;break;
11334
        default:                        type = "SECREL"; break;
11335
        }
11336
      break;
11337
 
11338
    case FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE:
11339
      switch (r_type)
11340
        {
11341
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL32MSB;break;
11342
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL32LSB;break;
11343
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL64MSB;break;
11344
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL64LSB;break;
11345
        default:                        type = "SEGREL"; break;
11346
        }
11347
      break;
11348
 
11349
    case FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE:
11350
      switch (r_type)
11351
        {
11352
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV32MSB; break;
11353
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV32LSB; break;
11354
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV64MSB; break;
11355
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV64LSB; break;
11356
        default:                        type = "LTV"; break;
11357
        }
11358
      break;
11359
 
11360
    case FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE:
11361
      switch (r_type)
11362
        {
11363
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11364
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22; break;
11365
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:
11366
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I; break;
11367
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:
11368
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32MSB; break;
11369
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:
11370
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32LSB; break;
11371
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11372
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64MSB; break;
11373
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11374
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64LSB; break;
11375
        default:
11376
          type = "LTOFF_FPTR"; break;
11377
        }
11378
      break;
11379
 
11380
    case FUNC_TP_RELATIVE:
11381
      switch (r_type)
11382
        {
11383
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL14; break;
11384
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL22; break;
11385
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64I; break;
11386
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64MSB; break;
11387
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64LSB; break;
11388
        default:                        type = "TPREL"; break;
11389
        }
11390
      break;
11391
 
11392
    case FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE:
11393
      switch (r_type)
11394
        {
11395
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11396
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_TPREL22; break;
11397
        default:
11398
          type = "LTOFF_TPREL"; break;
11399
        }
11400
      break;
11401
 
11402
    case FUNC_DTP_MODULE:
11403
      switch (r_type)
11404
        {
11405
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11406
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPMOD64MSB; break;
11407
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11408
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPMOD64LSB; break;
11409
        default:
11410
          type = "DTPMOD"; break;
11411
        }
11412
      break;
11413
 
11414
    case FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE:
11415
      switch (r_type)
11416
        {
11417
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11418
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPMOD22; break;
11419
        default:
11420
          type = "LTOFF_DTPMOD"; break;
11421
        }
11422
      break;
11423
 
11424
    case FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE:
11425
      switch (r_type)
11426
        {
11427
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:
11428
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL32MSB; break;
11429
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:
11430
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL32LSB; break;
11431
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11432
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64MSB; break;
11433
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11434
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64LSB; break;
11435
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:
11436
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL14; break;
11437
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11438
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL22; break;
11439
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:
11440
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64I; break;
11441
        default:
11442
          type = "DTPREL"; break;
11443
        }
11444
      break;
11445
 
11446
    case FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE:
11447
      switch (r_type)
11448
        {
11449
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11450
          new = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPREL22; break;
11451
        default:
11452
          type = "LTOFF_DTPREL"; break;
11453
        }
11454
      break;
11455
 
11456
    case FUNC_IPLT_RELOC:
11457
      switch (r_type)
11458
        {
11459
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB:    return r_type;
11460
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB:    return r_type;
11461
        default:                        type = "IPLT"; break;
11462
        }
11463
      break;
11464
 
11465
    default:
11466
      abort ();
11467
    }
11468
 
11469
  if (new)
11470
    return new;
11471
  else
11472
    {
11473
      int width;
11474
 
11475
      if (!type)
11476
        abort ();
11477
      switch (r_type)
11478
        {
11479
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB: width = 32; suffix = "MSB"; break;
11480
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB: width = 32; suffix = "LSB"; break;
11481
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB: width = 64; suffix = "MSB"; break;
11482
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB: width = 64; suffix = "LSB"; break;
11483
        case BFD_RELOC_UNUSED:        width = 13; break;
11484
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:    width = 14; break;
11485
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:    width = 22; break;
11486
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:    width = 64; suffix = "I"; break;
11487
        default:                      abort ();
11488
        }
11489
 
11490
      /* This should be an error, but since previously there wasn't any
11491
         diagnostic here, don't make it fail because of this for now.  */
11492
      as_warn (_("Cannot express %s%d%s relocation"), type, width, suffix);
11493
      return r_type;
11494
    }
11495
}
11496
 
11497
/* Here is where generate the appropriate reloc for pseudo relocation
11498
   functions.  */
11499
void
11500
ia64_validate_fix (fix)
11501
     fixS *fix;
11502
{
11503
  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11504
    {
11505
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
11506
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
11507
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
11508
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
11509
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
11510
      if (fix->fx_offset != 0)
11511
        as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line,
11512
                      _("No addend allowed in @fptr() relocation"));
11513
      break;
11514
    default:
11515
      break;
11516
    }
11517
}
11518
 
11519
static void
11520
fix_insn (fix, odesc, value)
11521
     fixS *fix;
11522
     const struct ia64_operand *odesc;
11523
     valueT value;
11524
{
11525
  bfd_vma insn[3], t0, t1, control_bits;
11526
  const char *err;
11527
  char *fixpos;
11528
  long slot;
11529
 
11530
  slot = fix->fx_where & 0x3;
11531
  fixpos = fix->fx_frag->fr_literal + (fix->fx_where - slot);
11532
 
11533
  /* Bundles are always in little-endian byte order */
11534
  t0 = bfd_getl64 (fixpos);
11535
  t1 = bfd_getl64 (fixpos + 8);
11536
  control_bits = t0 & 0x1f;
11537
  insn[0] = (t0 >>  5) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11538
  insn[1] = ((t0 >> 46) & 0x3ffff) | ((t1 & 0x7fffff) << 18);
11539
  insn[2] = (t1 >> 23) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11540
 
11541
  err = NULL;
11542
  if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_IMMU64)
11543
    {
11544
      insn[1] = (value >> 22) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11545
      insn[2] |= (((value & 0x7f) << 13)
11546
                  | (((value >> 7) & 0x1ff) << 27)
11547
                  | (((value >> 16) & 0x1f) << 22)
11548
                  | (((value >> 21) & 0x1) << 21)
11549
                  | (((value >> 63) & 0x1) << 36));
11550
    }
11551
  else if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_IMMU62)
11552
    {
11553
      if (value & ~0x3fffffffffffffffULL)
11554
        err = "integer operand out of range";
11555
      insn[1] = (value >> 21) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11556
      insn[2] |= (((value & 0xfffff) << 6) | (((value >> 20) & 0x1) << 36));
11557
    }
11558
  else if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_TGT64)
11559
    {
11560
      value >>= 4;
11561
      insn[1] = ((value >> 20) & 0x7fffffffffLL) << 2;
11562
      insn[2] |= ((((value >> 59) & 0x1) << 36)
11563
                  | (((value >> 0) & 0xfffff) << 13));
11564
    }
11565
  else
11566
    err = (*odesc->insert) (odesc, value, insn + slot);
11567
 
11568
  if (err)
11569
    as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line, err);
11570
 
11571
  t0 = control_bits | (insn[0] << 5) | (insn[1] << 46);
11572
  t1 = ((insn[1] >> 18) & 0x7fffff) | (insn[2] << 23);
11573
  number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos + 0, t0, 8);
11574
  number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos + 8, t1, 8);
11575
}
11576
 
11577
/* Attempt to simplify or even eliminate a fixup.  The return value is
11578
   ignored; perhaps it was once meaningful, but now it is historical.
11579
   To indicate that a fixup has been eliminated, set FIXP->FX_DONE.
11580
 
11581
   If fixp->fx_addsy is non-NULL, we'll have to generate a reloc entry
11582
   (if possible).  */
11583
 
11584
void
11585
md_apply_fix (fix, valP, seg)
11586
     fixS *fix;
11587
     valueT *valP;
11588
     segT seg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11589
{
11590
  char *fixpos;
11591
  valueT value = *valP;
11592
 
11593
  fixpos = fix->fx_frag->fr_literal + fix->fx_where;
11594
 
11595
  if (fix->fx_pcrel)
11596
    {
11597
    switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11598
      {
11599
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21B: break;
11600
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21BI: break;
11601
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21F: break;
11602
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21M: break;
11603
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL60B: break;
11604
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL22: break;
11605
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64I: break;
11606
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32MSB: break;
11607
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32LSB: break;
11608
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64MSB: break;
11609
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64LSB: break;
11610
      default:
11611
        fix->fx_r_type = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (pseudo_func[FUNC_PC_RELATIVE].u.sym,
11612
                                               fix->fx_r_type);
11613
        break;
11614
      }
11615
    }
11616
  if (fix->fx_addsy)
11617
    {
11618
      switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11619
        {
11620
        case BFD_RELOC_UNUSED:
11621
          /* This must be a TAG13 or TAG13b operand.  There are no external
11622
             relocs defined for them, so we must give an error.  */
11623
          as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line,
11624
                        _("%s must have a constant value"),
11625
                        elf64_ia64_operands[fix->tc_fix_data.opnd].desc);
11626
          fix->fx_done = 1;
11627
          return;
11628
 
11629
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL14:
11630
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL22:
11631
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64I:
11632
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_TPREL22:
11633
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPMOD22:
11634
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL14:
11635
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL22:
11636
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64I:
11637
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPREL22:
11638
          S_SET_THREAD_LOCAL (fix->fx_addsy);
11639
          break;
11640
 
11641
        default:
11642
          break;
11643
        }
11644
    }
11645
  else if (fix->tc_fix_data.opnd == IA64_OPND_NIL)
11646
    {
11647
      if (fix->tc_fix_data.bigendian)
11648
        number_to_chars_bigendian (fixpos, value, fix->fx_size);
11649
      else
11650
        number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos, value, fix->fx_size);
11651
      fix->fx_done = 1;
11652
    }
11653
  else
11654
    {
11655
      fix_insn (fix, elf64_ia64_operands + fix->tc_fix_data.opnd, value);
11656
      fix->fx_done = 1;
11657
    }
11658
}
11659
 
11660
/* Generate the BFD reloc to be stuck in the object file from the
11661
   fixup used internally in the assembler.  */
11662
 
11663
arelent *
11664
tc_gen_reloc (sec, fixp)
11665
     asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11666
     fixS *fixp;
11667
{
11668
  arelent *reloc;
11669
 
11670
  reloc = xmalloc (sizeof (*reloc));
11671
  reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
11672
  *reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_addsy);
11673
  reloc->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
11674
  reloc->addend = fixp->fx_offset;
11675
  reloc->howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput, fixp->fx_r_type);
11676
 
11677
  if (!reloc->howto)
11678
    {
11679
      as_bad_where (fixp->fx_file, fixp->fx_line,
11680
                    _("Cannot represent %s relocation in object file"),
11681
                    bfd_get_reloc_code_name (fixp->fx_r_type));
11682
      free (reloc);
11683
      return NULL;
11684
    }
11685
  return reloc;
11686
}
11687
 
11688
/* Turn a string in input_line_pointer into a floating point constant
11689
   of type TYPE, and store the appropriate bytes in *LIT.  The number
11690
   of LITTLENUMS emitted is stored in *SIZE.  An error message is
11691
   returned, or NULL on OK.  */
11692
 
11693
#define MAX_LITTLENUMS 5
11694
 
11695
char *
11696
md_atof (int type, char *lit, int *size)
11697
{
11698
  LITTLENUM_TYPE words[MAX_LITTLENUMS];
11699
  char *t;
11700
  int prec;
11701
 
11702
  switch (type)
11703
    {
11704
      /* IEEE floats */
11705
    case 'f':
11706
    case 'F':
11707
    case 's':
11708
    case 'S':
11709
      prec = 2;
11710
      break;
11711
 
11712
    case 'd':
11713
    case 'D':
11714
    case 'r':
11715
    case 'R':
11716
      prec = 4;
11717
      break;
11718
 
11719
    case 'x':
11720
    case 'X':
11721
    case 'p':
11722
    case 'P':
11723
      prec = 5;
11724
      break;
11725
 
11726
    default:
11727
      *size = 0;
11728
      return _("Unrecognized or unsupported floating point constant");
11729
    }
11730
  t = atof_ieee (input_line_pointer, type, words);
11731
  if (t)
11732
    input_line_pointer = t;
11733
 
11734
  (*ia64_float_to_chars) (lit, words, prec);
11735
 
11736
  if (type == 'X')
11737
    {
11738
      /* It is 10 byte floating point with 6 byte padding.  */
11739
      memset (&lit [10], 0, 6);
11740
      *size = 8 * sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11741
    }
11742
  else
11743
    *size = prec * sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11744
 
11745
  return NULL;
11746
}
11747
 
11748
/* Handle ia64 specific semantics of the align directive.  */
11749
 
11750
void
11751
ia64_md_do_align (n, fill, len, max)
11752
     int n ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11753
     const char *fill ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11754
     int len ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11755
     int max ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11756
{
11757
  if (subseg_text_p (now_seg))
11758
    ia64_flush_insns ();
11759
}
11760
 
11761
/* This is called from HANDLE_ALIGN in write.c.  Fill in the contents
11762
   of an rs_align_code fragment.  */
11763
 
11764
void
11765
ia64_handle_align (fragp)
11766
     fragS *fragp;
11767
{
11768
  int bytes;
11769
  char *p;
11770
  const unsigned char *nop;
11771
 
11772
  if (fragp->fr_type != rs_align_code)
11773
    return;
11774
 
11775
  /* Check if this frag has to end with a stop bit.  */
11776
  nop = fragp->tc_frag_data ? le_nop_stop : le_nop;
11777
 
11778
  bytes = fragp->fr_next->fr_address - fragp->fr_address - fragp->fr_fix;
11779
  p = fragp->fr_literal + fragp->fr_fix;
11780
 
11781
  /* If no paddings are needed, we check if we need a stop bit.  */
11782
  if (!bytes && fragp->tc_frag_data)
11783
    {
11784
      if (fragp->fr_fix < 16)
11785
#if 1
11786
        /* FIXME: It won't work with
11787
           .align 16
11788
           alloc r32=ar.pfs,1,2,4,0
11789
         */
11790
        ;
11791
#else
11792
        as_bad_where (fragp->fr_file, fragp->fr_line,
11793
                      _("Can't add stop bit to mark end of instruction group"));
11794
#endif
11795
      else
11796
        /* Bundles are always in little-endian byte order. Make sure
11797
           the previous bundle has the stop bit.  */
11798
        *(p - 16) |= 1;
11799
    }
11800
 
11801
  /* Make sure we are on a 16-byte boundary, in case someone has been
11802
     putting data into a text section.  */
11803
  if (bytes & 15)
11804
    {
11805
      int fix = bytes & 15;
11806
      memset (p, 0, fix);
11807
      p += fix;
11808
      bytes -= fix;
11809
      fragp->fr_fix += fix;
11810
    }
11811
 
11812
  /* Instruction bundles are always little-endian.  */
11813
  memcpy (p, nop, 16);
11814
  fragp->fr_var = 16;
11815
}
11816
 
11817
static void
11818
ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian (char *lit, LITTLENUM_TYPE *words,
11819
                               int prec)
11820
{
11821
  while (prec--)
11822
    {
11823
      number_to_chars_bigendian (lit, (long) (*words++),
11824
                                 sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE));
11825
      lit += sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11826
    }
11827
}
11828
 
11829
static void
11830
ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian (char *lit, LITTLENUM_TYPE *words,
11831
                                  int prec)
11832
{
11833
  while (prec--)
11834
    {
11835
      number_to_chars_littleendian (lit, (long) (words[prec]),
11836
                                    sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE));
11837
      lit += sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11838
    }
11839
}
11840
 
11841
void
11842
ia64_elf_section_change_hook  (void)
11843
{
11844
  if (elf_section_type (now_seg) == SHT_IA_64_UNWIND
11845
      && elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) == NULL)
11846
    elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) = text_section;
11847
  dot_byteorder (-1);
11848
}
11849
 
11850
/* Check if a label should be made global.  */
11851
void
11852
ia64_check_label (symbolS *label)
11853
{
11854
  if (*input_line_pointer == ':')
11855
    {
11856
      S_SET_EXTERNAL (label);
11857
      input_line_pointer++;
11858
    }
11859
}
11860
 
11861
/* Used to remember where .alias and .secalias directives are seen. We
11862
   will rename symbol and section names when we are about to output
11863
   the relocatable file.  */
11864
struct alias
11865
{
11866
  char *file;           /* The file where the directive is seen.  */
11867
  unsigned int line;    /* The line number the directive is at.  */
11868
  const char *name;     /* The original name of the symbol.  */
11869
};
11870
 
11871
/* Called for .alias and .secalias directives. If SECTION is 1, it is
11872
   .secalias. Otherwise, it is .alias.  */
11873
static void
11874
dot_alias (int section)
11875
{
11876
  char *name, *alias;
11877
  char delim;
11878
  char *end_name;
11879
  int len;
11880
  const char *error_string;
11881
  struct alias *h;
11882
  const char *a;
11883
  struct hash_control *ahash, *nhash;
11884
  const char *kind;
11885
 
11886
  name = input_line_pointer;
11887
  delim = get_symbol_end ();
11888
  end_name = input_line_pointer;
11889
  *end_name = delim;
11890
 
11891
  if (name == end_name)
11892
    {
11893
      as_bad (_("expected symbol name"));
11894
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11895
      return;
11896
    }
11897
 
11898
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
11899
 
11900
  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
11901
    {
11902
      *end_name = 0;
11903
      as_bad (_("expected comma after \"%s\""), name);
11904
      *end_name = delim;
11905
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11906
      return;
11907
    }
11908
 
11909
  input_line_pointer++;
11910
  *end_name = 0;
11911
  ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (name);
11912
 
11913
  /* We call demand_copy_C_string to check if alias string is valid.
11914
     There should be a closing `"' and no `\0' in the string.  */
11915
  alias = demand_copy_C_string (&len);
11916
  if (alias == NULL)
11917
    {
11918
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11919
      return;
11920
    }
11921
 
11922
  /* Make a copy of name string.  */
11923
  len = strlen (name) + 1;
11924
  obstack_grow (&notes, name, len);
11925
  name = obstack_finish (&notes);
11926
 
11927
  if (section)
11928
    {
11929
      kind = "section";
11930
      ahash = secalias_hash;
11931
      nhash = secalias_name_hash;
11932
    }
11933
  else
11934
    {
11935
      kind = "symbol";
11936
      ahash = alias_hash;
11937
      nhash = alias_name_hash;
11938
    }
11939
 
11940
  /* Check if alias has been used before.  */
11941
  h = (struct alias *) hash_find (ahash, alias);
11942
  if (h)
11943
    {
11944
      if (strcmp (h->name, name))
11945
        as_bad (_("`%s' is already the alias of %s `%s'"),
11946
                alias, kind, h->name);
11947
      goto out;
11948
    }
11949
 
11950
  /* Check if name already has an alias.  */
11951
  a = (const char *) hash_find (nhash, name);
11952
  if (a)
11953
    {
11954
      if (strcmp (a, alias))
11955
        as_bad (_("%s `%s' already has an alias `%s'"), kind, name, a);
11956
      goto out;
11957
    }
11958
 
11959
  h = (struct alias *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct alias));
11960
  as_where (&h->file, &h->line);
11961
  h->name = name;
11962
 
11963
  error_string = hash_jam (ahash, alias, (PTR) h);
11964
  if (error_string)
11965
    {
11966
      as_fatal (_("inserting \"%s\" into %s alias hash table failed: %s"),
11967
                alias, kind, error_string);
11968
      goto out;
11969
    }
11970
 
11971
  error_string = hash_jam (nhash, name, (PTR) alias);
11972
  if (error_string)
11973
    {
11974
      as_fatal (_("inserting \"%s\" into %s name hash table failed: %s"),
11975
                alias, kind, error_string);
11976
out:
11977
      obstack_free (&notes, name);
11978
      obstack_free (&notes, alias);
11979
    }
11980
 
11981
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
11982
}
11983
 
11984
/* It renames the original symbol name to its alias.  */
11985
static void
11986
do_alias (const char *alias, PTR value)
11987
{
11988
  struct alias *h = (struct alias *) value;
11989
  symbolS *sym = symbol_find (h->name);
11990
 
11991
  if (sym == NULL)
11992
    as_warn_where (h->file, h->line,
11993
                   _("symbol `%s' aliased to `%s' is not used"),
11994
                   h->name, alias);
11995
    else
11996
      S_SET_NAME (sym, (char *) alias);
11997
}
11998
 
11999
/* Called from write_object_file.  */
12000
void
12001
ia64_adjust_symtab (void)
12002
{
12003
  hash_traverse (alias_hash, do_alias);
12004
}
12005
 
12006
/* It renames the original section name to its alias.  */
12007
static void
12008
do_secalias (const char *alias, PTR value)
12009
{
12010
  struct alias *h = (struct alias *) value;
12011
  segT sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (stdoutput, h->name);
12012
 
12013
  if (sec == NULL)
12014
    as_warn_where (h->file, h->line,
12015
                   _("section `%s' aliased to `%s' is not used"),
12016
                   h->name, alias);
12017
  else
12018
    sec->name = alias;
12019
}
12020
 
12021
/* Called from write_object_file.  */
12022
void
12023
ia64_frob_file (void)
12024
{
12025
  hash_traverse (secalias_hash, do_secalias);
12026
}

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.